2011-05-31 Doug Kwan <dougkwan@google.com>
[external/binutils.git] / gold / arm.cc
1 // arm.cc -- arm target support for gold.
2
3 // Copyright 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 // Written by Doug Kwan <dougkwan@google.com> based on the i386 code
5 // by Ian Lance Taylor <iant@google.com>.
6 // This file also contains borrowed and adapted code from
7 // bfd/elf32-arm.c.
8
9 // This file is part of gold.
10
11 // This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
12 // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
13 // the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
14 // (at your option) any later version.
15
16 // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
17 // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
18 // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
19 // GNU General Public License for more details.
20
21 // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
22 // along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
23 // Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
24 // MA 02110-1301, USA.
25
26 #include "gold.h"
27
28 #include <cstring>
29 #include <limits>
30 #include <cstdio>
31 #include <string>
32 #include <algorithm>
33 #include <map>
34 #include <utility>
35 #include <set>
36
37 #include "elfcpp.h"
38 #include "parameters.h"
39 #include "reloc.h"
40 #include "arm.h"
41 #include "object.h"
42 #include "symtab.h"
43 #include "layout.h"
44 #include "output.h"
45 #include "copy-relocs.h"
46 #include "target.h"
47 #include "target-reloc.h"
48 #include "target-select.h"
49 #include "tls.h"
50 #include "defstd.h"
51 #include "gc.h"
52 #include "attributes.h"
53 #include "arm-reloc-property.h"
54
55 namespace
56 {
57
58 using namespace gold;
59
60 template<bool big_endian>
61 class Output_data_plt_arm;
62
63 template<bool big_endian>
64 class Stub_table;
65
66 template<bool big_endian>
67 class Arm_input_section;
68
69 class Arm_exidx_cantunwind;
70
71 class Arm_exidx_merged_section;
72
73 class Arm_exidx_fixup;
74
75 template<bool big_endian>
76 class Arm_output_section;
77
78 class Arm_exidx_input_section;
79
80 template<bool big_endian>
81 class Arm_relobj;
82
83 template<bool big_endian>
84 class Arm_relocate_functions;
85
86 template<bool big_endian>
87 class Arm_output_data_got;
88
89 template<bool big_endian>
90 class Target_arm;
91
92 // For convenience.
93 typedef elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Addr Arm_address;
94
95 // Maximum branch offsets for ARM, THUMB and THUMB2.
96 const int32_t ARM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET = ((((1 << 23) - 1) << 2) + 8);
97 const int32_t ARM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET = ((-((1 << 23) << 2)) + 8);
98 const int32_t THM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET = ((1 << 22) -2 + 4);
99 const int32_t THM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET = (-(1 << 22) + 4);
100 const int32_t THM2_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET = (((1 << 24) - 2) + 4);
101 const int32_t THM2_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET = (-(1 << 24) + 4);
102
103 // Thread Control Block size.
104 const size_t ARM_TCB_SIZE = 8;
105
106 // The arm target class.
107 //
108 // This is a very simple port of gold for ARM-EABI.  It is intended for
109 // supporting Android only for the time being.
110 // 
111 // TODOs:
112 // - Implement all static relocation types documented in arm-reloc.def.
113 // - Make PLTs more flexible for different architecture features like
114 //   Thumb-2 and BE8.
115 // There are probably a lot more.
116
117 // Ideally we would like to avoid using global variables but this is used
118 // very in many places and sometimes in loops.  If we use a function
119 // returning a static instance of Arm_reloc_property_table, it will be very
120 // slow in an threaded environment since the static instance needs to be
121 // locked.  The pointer is below initialized in the
122 // Target::do_select_as_default_target() hook so that we do not spend time
123 // building the table if we are not linking ARM objects.
124 //
125 // An alternative is to to process the information in arm-reloc.def in
126 // compilation time and generate a representation of it in PODs only.  That
127 // way we can avoid initialization when the linker starts.
128
129 Arm_reloc_property_table* arm_reloc_property_table = NULL;
130
131 // Instruction template class.  This class is similar to the insn_sequence
132 // struct in bfd/elf32-arm.c.
133
134 class Insn_template
135 {
136  public:
137   // Types of instruction templates.
138   enum Type
139     {
140       THUMB16_TYPE = 1,
141       // THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE is used by sub-classes of Stub for instruction 
142       // templates with class-specific semantics.  Currently this is used
143       // only by the Cortex_a8_stub class for handling condition codes in
144       // conditional branches.
145       THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE,
146       THUMB32_TYPE,
147       ARM_TYPE,
148       DATA_TYPE
149     };
150
151   // Factory methods to create instruction templates in different formats.
152
153   static const Insn_template
154   thumb16_insn(uint32_t data)
155   { return Insn_template(data, THUMB16_TYPE, elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE, 0); } 
156
157   // A Thumb conditional branch, in which the proper condition is inserted
158   // when we build the stub.
159   static const Insn_template
160   thumb16_bcond_insn(uint32_t data)
161   { return Insn_template(data, THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE, elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE, 1); } 
162
163   static const Insn_template
164   thumb32_insn(uint32_t data)
165   { return Insn_template(data, THUMB32_TYPE, elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE, 0); } 
166
167   static const Insn_template
168   thumb32_b_insn(uint32_t data, int reloc_addend)
169   {
170     return Insn_template(data, THUMB32_TYPE, elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24,
171                          reloc_addend);
172   } 
173
174   static const Insn_template
175   arm_insn(uint32_t data)
176   { return Insn_template(data, ARM_TYPE, elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE, 0); }
177
178   static const Insn_template
179   arm_rel_insn(unsigned data, int reloc_addend)
180   { return Insn_template(data, ARM_TYPE, elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24, reloc_addend); }
181
182   static const Insn_template
183   data_word(unsigned data, unsigned int r_type, int reloc_addend)
184   { return Insn_template(data, DATA_TYPE, r_type, reloc_addend); } 
185
186   // Accessors.  This class is used for read-only objects so no modifiers
187   // are provided.
188
189   uint32_t
190   data() const
191   { return this->data_; }
192
193   // Return the instruction sequence type of this.
194   Type
195   type() const
196   { return this->type_; }
197
198   // Return the ARM relocation type of this.
199   unsigned int
200   r_type() const
201   { return this->r_type_; }
202
203   int32_t
204   reloc_addend() const
205   { return this->reloc_addend_; }
206
207   // Return size of instruction template in bytes.
208   size_t
209   size() const;
210
211   // Return byte-alignment of instruction template.
212   unsigned
213   alignment() const;
214
215  private:
216   // We make the constructor private to ensure that only the factory
217   // methods are used.
218   inline
219   Insn_template(unsigned data, Type type, unsigned int r_type, int reloc_addend)
220     : data_(data), type_(type), r_type_(r_type), reloc_addend_(reloc_addend)
221   { }
222
223   // Instruction specific data.  This is used to store information like
224   // some of the instruction bits.
225   uint32_t data_;
226   // Instruction template type.
227   Type type_;
228   // Relocation type if there is a relocation or R_ARM_NONE otherwise.
229   unsigned int r_type_;
230   // Relocation addend.
231   int32_t reloc_addend_;
232 };
233
234 // Macro for generating code to stub types. One entry per long/short
235 // branch stub
236
237 #define DEF_STUBS \
238   DEF_STUB(long_branch_any_any) \
239   DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb) \
240   DEF_STUB(long_branch_thumb_only) \
241   DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb) \
242   DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm) \
243   DEF_STUB(short_branch_v4t_thumb_arm) \
244   DEF_STUB(long_branch_any_arm_pic) \
245   DEF_STUB(long_branch_any_thumb_pic) \
246   DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb_pic) \
247   DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb_pic) \
248   DEF_STUB(long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm_pic) \
249   DEF_STUB(long_branch_thumb_only_pic) \
250   DEF_STUB(a8_veneer_b_cond) \
251   DEF_STUB(a8_veneer_b) \
252   DEF_STUB(a8_veneer_bl) \
253   DEF_STUB(a8_veneer_blx) \
254   DEF_STUB(v4_veneer_bx)
255
256 // Stub types.
257
258 #define DEF_STUB(x) arm_stub_##x,
259 typedef enum
260   {
261     arm_stub_none,
262     DEF_STUBS
263
264     // First reloc stub type.
265     arm_stub_reloc_first = arm_stub_long_branch_any_any,
266     // Last  reloc stub type.
267     arm_stub_reloc_last = arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only_pic,
268
269     // First Cortex-A8 stub type.
270     arm_stub_cortex_a8_first = arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond,
271     // Last Cortex-A8 stub type.
272     arm_stub_cortex_a8_last = arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx,
273     
274     // Last stub type.
275     arm_stub_type_last = arm_stub_v4_veneer_bx
276   } Stub_type;
277 #undef DEF_STUB
278
279 // Stub template class.  Templates are meant to be read-only objects.
280 // A stub template for a stub type contains all read-only attributes
281 // common to all stubs of the same type.
282
283 class Stub_template
284 {
285  public:
286   Stub_template(Stub_type, const Insn_template*, size_t);
287
288   ~Stub_template()
289   { }
290
291   // Return stub type.
292   Stub_type
293   type() const
294   { return this->type_; }
295
296   // Return an array of instruction templates.
297   const Insn_template*
298   insns() const
299   { return this->insns_; }
300
301   // Return size of template in number of instructions.
302   size_t
303   insn_count() const
304   { return this->insn_count_; }
305
306   // Return size of template in bytes.
307   size_t
308   size() const
309   { return this->size_; }
310
311   // Return alignment of the stub template.
312   unsigned
313   alignment() const
314   { return this->alignment_; }
315   
316   // Return whether entry point is in thumb mode.
317   bool
318   entry_in_thumb_mode() const
319   { return this->entry_in_thumb_mode_; }
320
321   // Return number of relocations in this template.
322   size_t
323   reloc_count() const
324   { return this->relocs_.size(); }
325
326   // Return index of the I-th instruction with relocation.
327   size_t
328   reloc_insn_index(size_t i) const
329   {
330     gold_assert(i < this->relocs_.size());
331     return this->relocs_[i].first;
332   }
333
334   // Return the offset of the I-th instruction with relocation from the
335   // beginning of the stub.
336   section_size_type
337   reloc_offset(size_t i) const
338   {
339     gold_assert(i < this->relocs_.size());
340     return this->relocs_[i].second;
341   }
342
343  private:
344   // This contains information about an instruction template with a relocation
345   // and its offset from start of stub.
346   typedef std::pair<size_t, section_size_type> Reloc;
347
348   // A Stub_template may not be copied.  We want to share templates as much
349   // as possible.
350   Stub_template(const Stub_template&);
351   Stub_template& operator=(const Stub_template&);
352   
353   // Stub type.
354   Stub_type type_;
355   // Points to an array of Insn_templates.
356   const Insn_template* insns_;
357   // Number of Insn_templates in insns_[].
358   size_t insn_count_;
359   // Size of templated instructions in bytes.
360   size_t size_;
361   // Alignment of templated instructions.
362   unsigned alignment_;
363   // Flag to indicate if entry is in thumb mode.
364   bool entry_in_thumb_mode_;
365   // A table of reloc instruction indices and offsets.  We can find these by
366   // looking at the instruction templates but we pre-compute and then stash
367   // them here for speed. 
368   std::vector<Reloc> relocs_;
369 };
370
371 //
372 // A class for code stubs.  This is a base class for different type of
373 // stubs used in the ARM target.
374 //
375
376 class Stub
377 {
378  private:
379   static const section_offset_type invalid_offset =
380     static_cast<section_offset_type>(-1);
381
382  public:
383   Stub(const Stub_template* stub_template)
384     : stub_template_(stub_template), offset_(invalid_offset)
385   { }
386
387   virtual
388    ~Stub()
389   { }
390
391   // Return the stub template.
392   const Stub_template*
393   stub_template() const
394   { return this->stub_template_; }
395
396   // Return offset of code stub from beginning of its containing stub table.
397   section_offset_type
398   offset() const
399   {
400     gold_assert(this->offset_ != invalid_offset);
401     return this->offset_;
402   }
403
404   // Set offset of code stub from beginning of its containing stub table.
405   void
406   set_offset(section_offset_type offset)
407   { this->offset_ = offset; }
408   
409   // Return the relocation target address of the i-th relocation in the
410   // stub.  This must be defined in a child class.
411   Arm_address
412   reloc_target(size_t i)
413   { return this->do_reloc_target(i); }
414
415   // Write a stub at output VIEW.  BIG_ENDIAN select how a stub is written.
416   void
417   write(unsigned char* view, section_size_type view_size, bool big_endian)
418   { this->do_write(view, view_size, big_endian); }
419
420   // Return the instruction for THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE instruction template
421   // for the i-th instruction.
422   uint16_t
423   thumb16_special(size_t i)
424   { return this->do_thumb16_special(i); }
425
426  protected:
427   // This must be defined in the child class.
428   virtual Arm_address
429   do_reloc_target(size_t) = 0;
430
431   // This may be overridden in the child class.
432   virtual void
433   do_write(unsigned char* view, section_size_type view_size, bool big_endian)
434   {
435     if (big_endian)
436       this->do_fixed_endian_write<true>(view, view_size);
437     else
438       this->do_fixed_endian_write<false>(view, view_size);
439   }
440   
441   // This must be overridden if a child class uses the THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE
442   // instruction template.
443   virtual uint16_t
444   do_thumb16_special(size_t)
445   { gold_unreachable(); }
446
447  private:
448   // A template to implement do_write.
449   template<bool big_endian>
450   void inline
451   do_fixed_endian_write(unsigned char*, section_size_type);
452
453   // Its template.
454   const Stub_template* stub_template_;
455   // Offset within the section of containing this stub.
456   section_offset_type offset_;
457 };
458
459 // Reloc stub class.  These are stubs we use to fix up relocation because
460 // of limited branch ranges.
461
462 class Reloc_stub : public Stub
463 {
464  public:
465   static const unsigned int invalid_index = static_cast<unsigned int>(-1);
466   // We assume we never jump to this address.
467   static const Arm_address invalid_address = static_cast<Arm_address>(-1);
468
469   // Return destination address.
470   Arm_address
471   destination_address() const
472   {
473     gold_assert(this->destination_address_ != this->invalid_address);
474     return this->destination_address_;
475   }
476
477   // Set destination address.
478   void
479   set_destination_address(Arm_address address)
480   {
481     gold_assert(address != this->invalid_address);
482     this->destination_address_ = address;
483   }
484
485   // Reset destination address.
486   void
487   reset_destination_address()
488   { this->destination_address_ = this->invalid_address; }
489
490   // Determine stub type for a branch of a relocation of R_TYPE going
491   // from BRANCH_ADDRESS to BRANCH_TARGET.  If TARGET_IS_THUMB is set,
492   // the branch target is a thumb instruction.  TARGET is used for look
493   // up ARM-specific linker settings.
494   static Stub_type
495   stub_type_for_reloc(unsigned int r_type, Arm_address branch_address,
496                       Arm_address branch_target, bool target_is_thumb);
497
498   // Reloc_stub key.  A key is logically a triplet of a stub type, a symbol
499   // and an addend.  Since we treat global and local symbol differently, we
500   // use a Symbol object for a global symbol and a object-index pair for
501   // a local symbol.
502   class Key
503   {
504    public:
505     // If SYMBOL is not null, this is a global symbol, we ignore RELOBJ and
506     // R_SYM.  Otherwise, this is a local symbol and RELOBJ must non-NULL
507     // and R_SYM must not be invalid_index.
508     Key(Stub_type stub_type, const Symbol* symbol, const Relobj* relobj,
509         unsigned int r_sym, int32_t addend)
510       : stub_type_(stub_type), addend_(addend)
511     {
512       if (symbol != NULL)
513         {
514           this->r_sym_ = Reloc_stub::invalid_index;
515           this->u_.symbol = symbol;
516         }
517       else
518         {
519           gold_assert(relobj != NULL && r_sym != invalid_index);
520           this->r_sym_ = r_sym;
521           this->u_.relobj = relobj;
522         }
523     }
524
525     ~Key()
526     { }
527
528     // Accessors: Keys are meant to be read-only object so no modifiers are
529     // provided.
530
531     // Return stub type.
532     Stub_type
533     stub_type() const
534     { return this->stub_type_; }
535
536     // Return the local symbol index or invalid_index.
537     unsigned int
538     r_sym() const
539     { return this->r_sym_; }
540
541     // Return the symbol if there is one.
542     const Symbol*
543     symbol() const
544     { return this->r_sym_ == invalid_index ? this->u_.symbol : NULL; }
545
546     // Return the relobj if there is one.
547     const Relobj*
548     relobj() const
549     { return this->r_sym_ != invalid_index ? this->u_.relobj : NULL; }
550
551     // Whether this equals to another key k.
552     bool
553     eq(const Key& k) const 
554     {
555       return ((this->stub_type_ == k.stub_type_)
556               && (this->r_sym_ == k.r_sym_)
557               && ((this->r_sym_ != Reloc_stub::invalid_index)
558                   ? (this->u_.relobj == k.u_.relobj)
559                   : (this->u_.symbol == k.u_.symbol))
560               && (this->addend_ == k.addend_));
561     }
562
563     // Return a hash value.
564     size_t
565     hash_value() const
566     {
567       return (this->stub_type_
568               ^ this->r_sym_
569               ^ gold::string_hash<char>(
570                     (this->r_sym_ != Reloc_stub::invalid_index)
571                     ? this->u_.relobj->name().c_str()
572                     : this->u_.symbol->name())
573               ^ this->addend_);
574     }
575
576     // Functors for STL associative containers.
577     struct hash
578     {
579       size_t
580       operator()(const Key& k) const
581       { return k.hash_value(); }
582     };
583
584     struct equal_to
585     {
586       bool
587       operator()(const Key& k1, const Key& k2) const
588       { return k1.eq(k2); }
589     };
590
591     // Name of key.  This is mainly for debugging.
592     std::string
593     name() const;
594
595    private:
596     // Stub type.
597     Stub_type stub_type_;
598     // If this is a local symbol, this is the index in the defining object.
599     // Otherwise, it is invalid_index for a global symbol.
600     unsigned int r_sym_;
601     // If r_sym_ is an invalid index, this points to a global symbol.
602     // Otherwise, it points to a relobj.  We used the unsized and target
603     // independent Symbol and Relobj classes instead of Sized_symbol<32> and  
604     // Arm_relobj, in order to avoid making the stub class a template
605     // as most of the stub machinery is endianness-neutral.  However, it
606     // may require a bit of casting done by users of this class.
607     union
608     {
609       const Symbol* symbol;
610       const Relobj* relobj;
611     } u_;
612     // Addend associated with a reloc.
613     int32_t addend_;
614   };
615
616  protected:
617   // Reloc_stubs are created via a stub factory.  So these are protected.
618   Reloc_stub(const Stub_template* stub_template)
619     : Stub(stub_template), destination_address_(invalid_address)
620   { }
621
622   ~Reloc_stub()
623   { }
624
625   friend class Stub_factory;
626
627   // Return the relocation target address of the i-th relocation in the
628   // stub.
629   Arm_address
630   do_reloc_target(size_t i)
631   {
632     // All reloc stub have only one relocation.
633     gold_assert(i == 0);
634     return this->destination_address_;
635   }
636
637  private:
638   // Address of destination.
639   Arm_address destination_address_;
640 };
641
642 // Cortex-A8 stub class.  We need a Cortex-A8 stub to redirect any 32-bit
643 // THUMB branch that meets the following conditions:
644 // 
645 // 1. The branch straddles across a page boundary. i.e. lower 12-bit of
646 //    branch address is 0xffe.
647 // 2. The branch target address is in the same page as the first word of the
648 //    branch.
649 // 3. The branch follows a 32-bit instruction which is not a branch.
650 //
651 // To do the fix up, we need to store the address of the branch instruction
652 // and its target at least.  We also need to store the original branch
653 // instruction bits for the condition code in a conditional branch.  The
654 // condition code is used in a special instruction template.  We also want
655 // to identify input sections needing Cortex-A8 workaround quickly.  We store
656 // extra information about object and section index of the code section
657 // containing a branch being fixed up.  The information is used to mark
658 // the code section when we finalize the Cortex-A8 stubs.
659 //
660
661 class Cortex_a8_stub : public Stub
662 {
663  public:
664   ~Cortex_a8_stub()
665   { }
666
667   // Return the object of the code section containing the branch being fixed
668   // up.
669   Relobj*
670   relobj() const
671   { return this->relobj_; }
672
673   // Return the section index of the code section containing the branch being
674   // fixed up.
675   unsigned int
676   shndx() const
677   { return this->shndx_; }
678
679   // Return the source address of stub.  This is the address of the original
680   // branch instruction.  LSB is 1 always set to indicate that it is a THUMB
681   // instruction.
682   Arm_address
683   source_address() const
684   { return this->source_address_; }
685
686   // Return the destination address of the stub.  This is the branch taken
687   // address of the original branch instruction.  LSB is 1 if it is a THUMB
688   // instruction address.
689   Arm_address
690   destination_address() const
691   { return this->destination_address_; }
692
693   // Return the instruction being fixed up.
694   uint32_t
695   original_insn() const
696   { return this->original_insn_; }
697
698  protected:
699   // Cortex_a8_stubs are created via a stub factory.  So these are protected.
700   Cortex_a8_stub(const Stub_template* stub_template, Relobj* relobj,
701                  unsigned int shndx, Arm_address source_address,
702                  Arm_address destination_address, uint32_t original_insn)
703     : Stub(stub_template), relobj_(relobj), shndx_(shndx),
704       source_address_(source_address | 1U),
705       destination_address_(destination_address),
706       original_insn_(original_insn)
707   { }
708
709   friend class Stub_factory;
710
711   // Return the relocation target address of the i-th relocation in the
712   // stub.
713   Arm_address
714   do_reloc_target(size_t i)
715   {
716     if (this->stub_template()->type() == arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond)
717       {
718         // The conditional branch veneer has two relocations.
719         gold_assert(i < 2);
720         return i == 0 ? this->source_address_ + 4 : this->destination_address_;
721       }
722     else
723       {
724         // All other Cortex-A8 stubs have only one relocation.
725         gold_assert(i == 0);
726         return this->destination_address_;
727       }
728   }
729
730   // Return an instruction for the THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE instruction template.
731   uint16_t
732   do_thumb16_special(size_t);
733
734  private:
735   // Object of the code section containing the branch being fixed up.
736   Relobj* relobj_;
737   // Section index of the code section containing the branch begin fixed up.
738   unsigned int shndx_;
739   // Source address of original branch.
740   Arm_address source_address_;
741   // Destination address of the original branch.
742   Arm_address destination_address_;
743   // Original branch instruction.  This is needed for copying the condition
744   // code from a condition branch to its stub.
745   uint32_t original_insn_;
746 };
747
748 // ARMv4 BX Rx branch relocation stub class.
749 class Arm_v4bx_stub : public Stub
750 {
751  public:
752   ~Arm_v4bx_stub()
753   { }
754
755   // Return the associated register.
756   uint32_t
757   reg() const
758   { return this->reg_; }
759
760  protected:
761   // Arm V4BX stubs are created via a stub factory.  So these are protected.
762   Arm_v4bx_stub(const Stub_template* stub_template, const uint32_t reg)
763     : Stub(stub_template), reg_(reg)
764   { }
765
766   friend class Stub_factory;
767
768   // Return the relocation target address of the i-th relocation in the
769   // stub.
770   Arm_address
771   do_reloc_target(size_t)
772   { gold_unreachable(); }
773
774   // This may be overridden in the child class.
775   virtual void
776   do_write(unsigned char* view, section_size_type view_size, bool big_endian)
777   {
778     if (big_endian)
779       this->do_fixed_endian_v4bx_write<true>(view, view_size);
780     else
781       this->do_fixed_endian_v4bx_write<false>(view, view_size);
782   }
783
784  private:
785   // A template to implement do_write.
786   template<bool big_endian>
787   void inline
788   do_fixed_endian_v4bx_write(unsigned char* view, section_size_type)
789   {
790     const Insn_template* insns = this->stub_template()->insns();
791     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(view,
792                                            (insns[0].data()
793                                            + (this->reg_ << 16)));
794     view += insns[0].size();
795     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(view,
796                                            (insns[1].data() + this->reg_));
797     view += insns[1].size();
798     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(view,
799                                            (insns[2].data() + this->reg_));
800   }
801
802   // A register index (r0-r14), which is associated with the stub.
803   uint32_t reg_;
804 };
805
806 // Stub factory class.
807
808 class Stub_factory
809 {
810  public:
811   // Return the unique instance of this class.
812   static const Stub_factory&
813   get_instance()
814   {
815     static Stub_factory singleton;
816     return singleton;
817   }
818
819   // Make a relocation stub.
820   Reloc_stub*
821   make_reloc_stub(Stub_type stub_type) const
822   {
823     gold_assert(stub_type >= arm_stub_reloc_first
824                 && stub_type <= arm_stub_reloc_last);
825     return new Reloc_stub(this->stub_templates_[stub_type]);
826   }
827
828   // Make a Cortex-A8 stub.
829   Cortex_a8_stub*
830   make_cortex_a8_stub(Stub_type stub_type, Relobj* relobj, unsigned int shndx,
831                       Arm_address source, Arm_address destination,
832                       uint32_t original_insn) const
833   {
834     gold_assert(stub_type >= arm_stub_cortex_a8_first
835                 && stub_type <= arm_stub_cortex_a8_last);
836     return new Cortex_a8_stub(this->stub_templates_[stub_type], relobj, shndx,
837                               source, destination, original_insn);
838   }
839
840   // Make an ARM V4BX relocation stub.
841   // This method creates a stub from the arm_stub_v4_veneer_bx template only.
842   Arm_v4bx_stub*
843   make_arm_v4bx_stub(uint32_t reg) const
844   {
845     gold_assert(reg < 0xf);
846     return new Arm_v4bx_stub(this->stub_templates_[arm_stub_v4_veneer_bx],
847                              reg);
848   }
849
850  private:
851   // Constructor and destructor are protected since we only return a single
852   // instance created in Stub_factory::get_instance().
853   
854   Stub_factory();
855
856   // A Stub_factory may not be copied since it is a singleton.
857   Stub_factory(const Stub_factory&);
858   Stub_factory& operator=(Stub_factory&);
859   
860   // Stub templates.  These are initialized in the constructor.
861   const Stub_template* stub_templates_[arm_stub_type_last+1];
862 };
863
864 // A class to hold stubs for the ARM target.
865
866 template<bool big_endian>
867 class Stub_table : public Output_data
868 {
869  public:
870   Stub_table(Arm_input_section<big_endian>* owner)
871     : Output_data(), owner_(owner), reloc_stubs_(), reloc_stubs_size_(0),
872       reloc_stubs_addralign_(1), cortex_a8_stubs_(), arm_v4bx_stubs_(0xf),
873       prev_data_size_(0), prev_addralign_(1)
874   { }
875
876   ~Stub_table()
877   { }
878
879   // Owner of this stub table.
880   Arm_input_section<big_endian>*
881   owner() const
882   { return this->owner_; }
883
884   // Whether this stub table is empty.
885   bool
886   empty() const
887   {
888     return (this->reloc_stubs_.empty()
889             && this->cortex_a8_stubs_.empty()
890             && this->arm_v4bx_stubs_.empty());
891   }
892
893   // Return the current data size.
894   off_t
895   current_data_size() const
896   { return this->current_data_size_for_child(); }
897
898   // Add a STUB using KEY.  The caller is responsible for avoiding addition
899   // if a STUB with the same key has already been added.
900   void
901   add_reloc_stub(Reloc_stub* stub, const Reloc_stub::Key& key)
902   {
903     const Stub_template* stub_template = stub->stub_template();
904     gold_assert(stub_template->type() == key.stub_type());
905     this->reloc_stubs_[key] = stub;
906
907     // Assign stub offset early.  We can do this because we never remove
908     // reloc stubs and they are in the beginning of the stub table.
909     uint64_t align = stub_template->alignment();
910     this->reloc_stubs_size_ = align_address(this->reloc_stubs_size_, align);
911     stub->set_offset(this->reloc_stubs_size_);
912     this->reloc_stubs_size_ += stub_template->size();
913     this->reloc_stubs_addralign_ =
914       std::max(this->reloc_stubs_addralign_, align);
915   }
916
917   // Add a Cortex-A8 STUB that fixes up a THUMB branch at ADDRESS.
918   // The caller is responsible for avoiding addition if a STUB with the same
919   // address has already been added.
920   void
921   add_cortex_a8_stub(Arm_address address, Cortex_a8_stub* stub)
922   {
923     std::pair<Arm_address, Cortex_a8_stub*> value(address, stub);
924     this->cortex_a8_stubs_.insert(value);
925   }
926
927   // Add an ARM V4BX relocation stub. A register index will be retrieved
928   // from the stub.
929   void
930   add_arm_v4bx_stub(Arm_v4bx_stub* stub)
931   {
932     gold_assert(stub != NULL && this->arm_v4bx_stubs_[stub->reg()] == NULL);
933     this->arm_v4bx_stubs_[stub->reg()] = stub;
934   }
935
936   // Remove all Cortex-A8 stubs.
937   void
938   remove_all_cortex_a8_stubs();
939
940   // Look up a relocation stub using KEY.  Return NULL if there is none.
941   Reloc_stub*
942   find_reloc_stub(const Reloc_stub::Key& key) const
943   {
944     typename Reloc_stub_map::const_iterator p = this->reloc_stubs_.find(key);
945     return (p != this->reloc_stubs_.end()) ? p->second : NULL;
946   }
947
948   // Look up an arm v4bx relocation stub using the register index.
949   // Return NULL if there is none.
950   Arm_v4bx_stub*
951   find_arm_v4bx_stub(const uint32_t reg) const
952   {
953     gold_assert(reg < 0xf);
954     return this->arm_v4bx_stubs_[reg];
955   }
956
957   // Relocate stubs in this stub table.
958   void
959   relocate_stubs(const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*,
960                  Target_arm<big_endian>*, Output_section*,
961                  unsigned char*, Arm_address, section_size_type);
962
963   // Update data size and alignment at the end of a relaxation pass.  Return
964   // true if either data size or alignment is different from that of the
965   // previous relaxation pass.
966   bool
967   update_data_size_and_addralign();
968
969   // Finalize stubs.  Set the offsets of all stubs and mark input sections
970   // needing the Cortex-A8 workaround.
971   void
972   finalize_stubs();
973   
974   // Apply Cortex-A8 workaround to an address range.
975   void
976   apply_cortex_a8_workaround_to_address_range(Target_arm<big_endian>*,
977                                               unsigned char*, Arm_address,
978                                               section_size_type);
979
980  protected:
981   // Write out section contents.
982   void
983   do_write(Output_file*);
984  
985   // Return the required alignment.
986   uint64_t
987   do_addralign() const
988   { return this->prev_addralign_; }
989
990   // Reset address and file offset.
991   void
992   do_reset_address_and_file_offset()
993   { this->set_current_data_size_for_child(this->prev_data_size_); }
994
995   // Set final data size.
996   void
997   set_final_data_size()
998   { this->set_data_size(this->current_data_size()); }
999   
1000  private:
1001   // Relocate one stub.
1002   void
1003   relocate_stub(Stub*, const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*,
1004                 Target_arm<big_endian>*, Output_section*,
1005                 unsigned char*, Arm_address, section_size_type);
1006
1007   // Unordered map of relocation stubs.
1008   typedef
1009     Unordered_map<Reloc_stub::Key, Reloc_stub*, Reloc_stub::Key::hash,
1010                   Reloc_stub::Key::equal_to>
1011     Reloc_stub_map;
1012
1013   // List of Cortex-A8 stubs ordered by addresses of branches being
1014   // fixed up in output.
1015   typedef std::map<Arm_address, Cortex_a8_stub*> Cortex_a8_stub_list;
1016   // List of Arm V4BX relocation stubs ordered by associated registers.
1017   typedef std::vector<Arm_v4bx_stub*> Arm_v4bx_stub_list;
1018
1019   // Owner of this stub table.
1020   Arm_input_section<big_endian>* owner_;
1021   // The relocation stubs.
1022   Reloc_stub_map reloc_stubs_;
1023   // Size of reloc stubs.
1024   off_t reloc_stubs_size_;
1025   // Maximum address alignment of reloc stubs.
1026   uint64_t reloc_stubs_addralign_;
1027   // The cortex_a8_stubs.
1028   Cortex_a8_stub_list cortex_a8_stubs_;
1029   // The Arm V4BX relocation stubs.
1030   Arm_v4bx_stub_list arm_v4bx_stubs_;
1031   // data size of this in the previous pass.
1032   off_t prev_data_size_;
1033   // address alignment of this in the previous pass.
1034   uint64_t prev_addralign_;
1035 };
1036
1037 // Arm_exidx_cantunwind class.  This represents an EXIDX_CANTUNWIND entry
1038 // we add to the end of an EXIDX input section that goes into the output.
1039
1040 class Arm_exidx_cantunwind : public Output_section_data
1041 {
1042  public:
1043   Arm_exidx_cantunwind(Relobj* relobj, unsigned int shndx)
1044     : Output_section_data(8, 4, true), relobj_(relobj), shndx_(shndx)
1045   { }
1046
1047   // Return the object containing the section pointed by this.
1048   Relobj*
1049   relobj() const
1050   { return this->relobj_; }
1051
1052   // Return the section index of the section pointed by this.
1053   unsigned int
1054   shndx() const
1055   { return this->shndx_; }
1056
1057  protected:
1058   void
1059   do_write(Output_file* of)
1060   {
1061     if (parameters->target().is_big_endian())
1062       this->do_fixed_endian_write<true>(of);
1063     else
1064       this->do_fixed_endian_write<false>(of);
1065   }
1066
1067   // Write to a map file.
1068   void
1069   do_print_to_mapfile(Mapfile* mapfile) const
1070   { mapfile->print_output_data(this, _("** ARM cantunwind")); }
1071
1072  private:
1073   // Implement do_write for a given endianness.
1074   template<bool big_endian>
1075   void inline
1076   do_fixed_endian_write(Output_file*);
1077   
1078   // The object containing the section pointed by this.
1079   Relobj* relobj_;
1080   // The section index of the section pointed by this.
1081   unsigned int shndx_;
1082 };
1083
1084 // During EXIDX coverage fix-up, we compact an EXIDX section.  The
1085 // Offset map is used to map input section offset within the EXIDX section
1086 // to the output offset from the start of this EXIDX section. 
1087
1088 typedef std::map<section_offset_type, section_offset_type>
1089         Arm_exidx_section_offset_map;
1090
1091 // Arm_exidx_merged_section class.  This represents an EXIDX input section
1092 // with some of its entries merged.
1093
1094 class Arm_exidx_merged_section : public Output_relaxed_input_section
1095 {
1096  public:
1097   // Constructor for Arm_exidx_merged_section.
1098   // EXIDX_INPUT_SECTION points to the unmodified EXIDX input section.
1099   // SECTION_OFFSET_MAP points to a section offset map describing how
1100   // parts of the input section are mapped to output.  DELETED_BYTES is
1101   // the number of bytes deleted from the EXIDX input section.
1102   Arm_exidx_merged_section(
1103       const Arm_exidx_input_section& exidx_input_section,
1104       const Arm_exidx_section_offset_map& section_offset_map,
1105       uint32_t deleted_bytes);
1106
1107   // Build output contents.
1108   void
1109   build_contents(const unsigned char*, section_size_type);
1110
1111   // Return the original EXIDX input section.
1112   const Arm_exidx_input_section&
1113   exidx_input_section() const
1114   { return this->exidx_input_section_; }
1115
1116   // Return the section offset map.
1117   const Arm_exidx_section_offset_map&
1118   section_offset_map() const
1119   { return this->section_offset_map_; }
1120
1121  protected:
1122   // Write merged section into file OF.
1123   void
1124   do_write(Output_file* of);
1125
1126   bool
1127   do_output_offset(const Relobj*, unsigned int, section_offset_type,
1128                   section_offset_type*) const;
1129
1130  private:
1131   // Original EXIDX input section.
1132   const Arm_exidx_input_section& exidx_input_section_;
1133   // Section offset map.
1134   const Arm_exidx_section_offset_map& section_offset_map_;
1135   // Merged section contents.  We need to keep build the merged section 
1136   // and save it here to avoid accessing the original EXIDX section when
1137   // we cannot lock the sections' object.
1138   unsigned char* section_contents_;
1139 };
1140
1141 // A class to wrap an ordinary input section containing executable code.
1142
1143 template<bool big_endian>
1144 class Arm_input_section : public Output_relaxed_input_section
1145 {
1146  public:
1147   Arm_input_section(Relobj* relobj, unsigned int shndx)
1148     : Output_relaxed_input_section(relobj, shndx, 1),
1149       original_addralign_(1), original_size_(0), stub_table_(NULL),
1150       original_contents_(NULL)
1151   { }
1152
1153   ~Arm_input_section()
1154   { delete[] this->original_contents_; }
1155
1156   // Initialize.
1157   void
1158   init();
1159   
1160   // Whether this is a stub table owner.
1161   bool
1162   is_stub_table_owner() const
1163   { return this->stub_table_ != NULL && this->stub_table_->owner() == this; }
1164
1165   // Return the stub table.
1166   Stub_table<big_endian>*
1167   stub_table() const
1168   { return this->stub_table_; }
1169
1170   // Set the stub_table.
1171   void
1172   set_stub_table(Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table)
1173   { this->stub_table_ = stub_table; }
1174
1175   // Downcast a base pointer to an Arm_input_section pointer.  This is
1176   // not type-safe but we only use Arm_input_section not the base class.
1177   static Arm_input_section<big_endian>*
1178   as_arm_input_section(Output_relaxed_input_section* poris)
1179   { return static_cast<Arm_input_section<big_endian>*>(poris); }
1180
1181   // Return the original size of the section.
1182   uint32_t
1183   original_size() const
1184   { return this->original_size_; }
1185
1186  protected:
1187   // Write data to output file.
1188   void
1189   do_write(Output_file*);
1190
1191   // Return required alignment of this.
1192   uint64_t
1193   do_addralign() const
1194   {
1195     if (this->is_stub_table_owner())
1196       return std::max(this->stub_table_->addralign(),
1197                       static_cast<uint64_t>(this->original_addralign_));
1198     else
1199       return this->original_addralign_;
1200   }
1201
1202   // Finalize data size.
1203   void
1204   set_final_data_size();
1205
1206   // Reset address and file offset.
1207   void
1208   do_reset_address_and_file_offset();
1209
1210   // Output offset.
1211   bool
1212   do_output_offset(const Relobj* object, unsigned int shndx,
1213                    section_offset_type offset,
1214                    section_offset_type* poutput) const
1215   {
1216     if ((object == this->relobj())
1217         && (shndx == this->shndx())
1218         && (offset >= 0)
1219         && (offset <=
1220             convert_types<section_offset_type, uint32_t>(this->original_size_)))
1221       {
1222         *poutput = offset;
1223         return true;
1224       }
1225     else
1226       return false;
1227   }
1228
1229  private:
1230   // Copying is not allowed.
1231   Arm_input_section(const Arm_input_section&);
1232   Arm_input_section& operator=(const Arm_input_section&);
1233
1234   // Address alignment of the original input section.
1235   uint32_t original_addralign_;
1236   // Section size of the original input section.
1237   uint32_t original_size_;
1238   // Stub table.
1239   Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table_;
1240   // Original section contents.  We have to make a copy here since the file
1241   // containing the original section may not be locked when we need to access
1242   // the contents.
1243   unsigned char* original_contents_;
1244 };
1245
1246 // Arm_exidx_fixup class.  This is used to define a number of methods
1247 // and keep states for fixing up EXIDX coverage.
1248
1249 class Arm_exidx_fixup
1250 {
1251  public:
1252   Arm_exidx_fixup(Output_section* exidx_output_section,
1253                   bool merge_exidx_entries = true)
1254     : exidx_output_section_(exidx_output_section), last_unwind_type_(UT_NONE),
1255       last_inlined_entry_(0), last_input_section_(NULL),
1256       section_offset_map_(NULL), first_output_text_section_(NULL),
1257       merge_exidx_entries_(merge_exidx_entries)
1258   { }
1259
1260   ~Arm_exidx_fixup()
1261   { delete this->section_offset_map_; }
1262
1263   // Process an EXIDX section for entry merging.  SECTION_CONTENTS points
1264   // to the EXIDX contents and SECTION_SIZE is the size of the contents. Return
1265   // number of bytes to be deleted in output.  If parts of the input EXIDX
1266   // section are merged a heap allocated Arm_exidx_section_offset_map is store
1267   // in the located PSECTION_OFFSET_MAP.   The caller owns the map and is
1268   // responsible for releasing it.
1269   template<bool big_endian>
1270   uint32_t
1271   process_exidx_section(const Arm_exidx_input_section* exidx_input_section,
1272                         const unsigned char* section_contents,
1273                         section_size_type section_size,
1274                         Arm_exidx_section_offset_map** psection_offset_map);
1275   
1276   // Append an EXIDX_CANTUNWIND entry pointing at the end of the last
1277   // input section, if there is not one already.
1278   void
1279   add_exidx_cantunwind_as_needed();
1280
1281   // Return the output section for the text section which is linked to the
1282   // first exidx input in output.
1283   Output_section*
1284   first_output_text_section() const
1285   { return this->first_output_text_section_; }
1286
1287  private:
1288   // Copying is not allowed.
1289   Arm_exidx_fixup(const Arm_exidx_fixup&);
1290   Arm_exidx_fixup& operator=(const Arm_exidx_fixup&);
1291
1292   // Type of EXIDX unwind entry.
1293   enum Unwind_type
1294   {
1295     // No type.
1296     UT_NONE,
1297     // EXIDX_CANTUNWIND.
1298     UT_EXIDX_CANTUNWIND,
1299     // Inlined entry.
1300     UT_INLINED_ENTRY,
1301     // Normal entry.
1302     UT_NORMAL_ENTRY,
1303   };
1304
1305   // Process an EXIDX entry.  We only care about the second word of the
1306   // entry.  Return true if the entry can be deleted.
1307   bool
1308   process_exidx_entry(uint32_t second_word);
1309
1310   // Update the current section offset map during EXIDX section fix-up.
1311   // If there is no map, create one.  INPUT_OFFSET is the offset of a
1312   // reference point, DELETED_BYTES is the number of deleted by in the
1313   // section so far.  If DELETE_ENTRY is true, the reference point and
1314   // all offsets after the previous reference point are discarded.
1315   void
1316   update_offset_map(section_offset_type input_offset,
1317                     section_size_type deleted_bytes, bool delete_entry);
1318
1319   // EXIDX output section.
1320   Output_section* exidx_output_section_;
1321   // Unwind type of the last EXIDX entry processed.
1322   Unwind_type last_unwind_type_;
1323   // Last seen inlined EXIDX entry.
1324   uint32_t last_inlined_entry_;
1325   // Last processed EXIDX input section.
1326   const Arm_exidx_input_section* last_input_section_;
1327   // Section offset map created in process_exidx_section.
1328   Arm_exidx_section_offset_map* section_offset_map_;
1329   // Output section for the text section which is linked to the first exidx
1330   // input in output.
1331   Output_section* first_output_text_section_;
1332
1333   bool merge_exidx_entries_;
1334 };
1335
1336 // Arm output section class.  This is defined mainly to add a number of
1337 // stub generation methods.
1338
1339 template<bool big_endian>
1340 class Arm_output_section : public Output_section
1341 {
1342  public:
1343   typedef std::vector<std::pair<Relobj*, unsigned int> > Text_section_list;
1344
1345   // We need to force SHF_LINK_ORDER in a SHT_ARM_EXIDX section.
1346   Arm_output_section(const char* name, elfcpp::Elf_Word type,
1347                      elfcpp::Elf_Xword flags)
1348     : Output_section(name, type,
1349                      (type == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_EXIDX
1350                       ? flags | elfcpp::SHF_LINK_ORDER
1351                       : flags))
1352   {
1353     if (type == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_EXIDX)
1354       this->set_always_keeps_input_sections();
1355   }
1356
1357   ~Arm_output_section()
1358   { }
1359   
1360   // Group input sections for stub generation.
1361   void
1362   group_sections(section_size_type, bool, Target_arm<big_endian>*, const Task*);
1363
1364   // Downcast a base pointer to an Arm_output_section pointer.  This is
1365   // not type-safe but we only use Arm_output_section not the base class.
1366   static Arm_output_section<big_endian>*
1367   as_arm_output_section(Output_section* os)
1368   { return static_cast<Arm_output_section<big_endian>*>(os); }
1369
1370   // Append all input text sections in this into LIST.
1371   void
1372   append_text_sections_to_list(Text_section_list* list);
1373
1374   // Fix EXIDX coverage of this EXIDX output section.  SORTED_TEXT_SECTION
1375   // is a list of text input sections sorted in ascending order of their
1376   // output addresses.
1377   void
1378   fix_exidx_coverage(Layout* layout,
1379                      const Text_section_list& sorted_text_section,
1380                      Symbol_table* symtab,
1381                      bool merge_exidx_entries,
1382                      const Task* task);
1383
1384   // Link an EXIDX section into its corresponding text section.
1385   void
1386   set_exidx_section_link();
1387
1388  private:
1389   // For convenience.
1390   typedef Output_section::Input_section Input_section;
1391   typedef Output_section::Input_section_list Input_section_list;
1392
1393   // Create a stub group.
1394   void create_stub_group(Input_section_list::const_iterator,
1395                          Input_section_list::const_iterator,
1396                          Input_section_list::const_iterator,
1397                          Target_arm<big_endian>*,
1398                          std::vector<Output_relaxed_input_section*>*,
1399                          const Task* task);
1400 };
1401
1402 // Arm_exidx_input_section class.  This represents an EXIDX input section.
1403
1404 class Arm_exidx_input_section
1405 {
1406  public:
1407   static const section_offset_type invalid_offset =
1408     static_cast<section_offset_type>(-1);
1409
1410   Arm_exidx_input_section(Relobj* relobj, unsigned int shndx,
1411                           unsigned int link, uint32_t size,
1412                           uint32_t addralign, uint32_t text_size)
1413     : relobj_(relobj), shndx_(shndx), link_(link), size_(size),
1414       addralign_(addralign), text_size_(text_size), has_errors_(false)
1415   { }
1416
1417   ~Arm_exidx_input_section()
1418   { }
1419         
1420   // Accessors:  This is a read-only class.
1421
1422   // Return the object containing this EXIDX input section.
1423   Relobj*
1424   relobj() const
1425   { return this->relobj_; }
1426
1427   // Return the section index of this EXIDX input section.
1428   unsigned int
1429   shndx() const
1430   { return this->shndx_; }
1431
1432   // Return the section index of linked text section in the same object.
1433   unsigned int
1434   link() const
1435   { return this->link_; }
1436
1437   // Return size of the EXIDX input section.
1438   uint32_t
1439   size() const
1440   { return this->size_; }
1441
1442   // Return address alignment of EXIDX input section.
1443   uint32_t
1444   addralign() const
1445   { return this->addralign_; }
1446
1447   // Return size of the associated text input section.
1448   uint32_t
1449   text_size() const
1450   { return this->text_size_; }
1451
1452   // Whether there are any errors in the EXIDX input section.
1453   bool
1454   has_errors() const
1455   { return this->has_errors_; }
1456
1457   // Set has-errors flag.
1458   void
1459   set_has_errors()
1460   { this->has_errors_ = true; }
1461
1462  private:
1463   // Object containing this.
1464   Relobj* relobj_;
1465   // Section index of this.
1466   unsigned int shndx_;
1467   // text section linked to this in the same object.
1468   unsigned int link_;
1469   // Size of this.  For ARM 32-bit is sufficient.
1470   uint32_t size_;
1471   // Address alignment of this.  For ARM 32-bit is sufficient.
1472   uint32_t addralign_;
1473   // Size of associated text section.
1474   uint32_t text_size_;
1475   // Whether this has any errors.
1476   bool has_errors_;
1477 };
1478
1479 // Arm_relobj class.
1480
1481 template<bool big_endian>
1482 class Arm_relobj : public Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>
1483 {
1484  public:
1485   static const Arm_address invalid_address = static_cast<Arm_address>(-1);
1486
1487   Arm_relobj(const std::string& name, Input_file* input_file, off_t offset,
1488              const typename elfcpp::Ehdr<32, big_endian>& ehdr)
1489     : Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>(name, input_file, offset, ehdr),
1490       stub_tables_(), local_symbol_is_thumb_function_(),
1491       attributes_section_data_(NULL), mapping_symbols_info_(),
1492       section_has_cortex_a8_workaround_(NULL), exidx_section_map_(),
1493       output_local_symbol_count_needs_update_(false),
1494       merge_flags_and_attributes_(true)
1495   { }
1496
1497   ~Arm_relobj()
1498   { delete this->attributes_section_data_; }
1499  
1500   // Return the stub table of the SHNDX-th section if there is one.
1501   Stub_table<big_endian>*
1502   stub_table(unsigned int shndx) const
1503   {
1504     gold_assert(shndx < this->stub_tables_.size());
1505     return this->stub_tables_[shndx];
1506   }
1507
1508   // Set STUB_TABLE to be the stub_table of the SHNDX-th section.
1509   void
1510   set_stub_table(unsigned int shndx, Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table)
1511   {
1512     gold_assert(shndx < this->stub_tables_.size());
1513     this->stub_tables_[shndx] = stub_table;
1514   }
1515
1516   // Whether a local symbol is a THUMB function.  R_SYM is the symbol table
1517   // index.  This is only valid after do_count_local_symbol is called.
1518   bool
1519   local_symbol_is_thumb_function(unsigned int r_sym) const
1520   {
1521     gold_assert(r_sym < this->local_symbol_is_thumb_function_.size());
1522     return this->local_symbol_is_thumb_function_[r_sym];
1523   }
1524   
1525   // Scan all relocation sections for stub generation.
1526   void
1527   scan_sections_for_stubs(Target_arm<big_endian>*, const Symbol_table*,
1528                           const Layout*);
1529
1530   // Convert regular input section with index SHNDX to a relaxed section.
1531   void
1532   convert_input_section_to_relaxed_section(unsigned shndx)
1533   {
1534     // The stubs have relocations and we need to process them after writing
1535     // out the stubs.  So relocation now must follow section write.
1536     this->set_section_offset(shndx, -1ULL);
1537     this->set_relocs_must_follow_section_writes();
1538   }
1539
1540   // Downcast a base pointer to an Arm_relobj pointer.  This is
1541   // not type-safe but we only use Arm_relobj not the base class.
1542   static Arm_relobj<big_endian>*
1543   as_arm_relobj(Relobj* relobj)
1544   { return static_cast<Arm_relobj<big_endian>*>(relobj); }
1545
1546   // Processor-specific flags in ELF file header.  This is valid only after
1547   // reading symbols.
1548   elfcpp::Elf_Word
1549   processor_specific_flags() const
1550   { return this->processor_specific_flags_; }
1551
1552   // Attribute section data  This is the contents of the .ARM.attribute section
1553   // if there is one.
1554   const Attributes_section_data*
1555   attributes_section_data() const
1556   { return this->attributes_section_data_; }
1557
1558   // Mapping symbol location.
1559   typedef std::pair<unsigned int, Arm_address> Mapping_symbol_position;
1560
1561   // Functor for STL container.
1562   struct Mapping_symbol_position_less
1563   {
1564     bool
1565     operator()(const Mapping_symbol_position& p1,
1566                const Mapping_symbol_position& p2) const
1567     {
1568       return (p1.first < p2.first
1569               || (p1.first == p2.first && p1.second < p2.second));
1570     }
1571   };
1572   
1573   // We only care about the first character of a mapping symbol, so
1574   // we only store that instead of the whole symbol name.
1575   typedef std::map<Mapping_symbol_position, char,
1576                    Mapping_symbol_position_less> Mapping_symbols_info;
1577
1578   // Whether a section contains any Cortex-A8 workaround.
1579   bool
1580   section_has_cortex_a8_workaround(unsigned int shndx) const
1581   { 
1582     return (this->section_has_cortex_a8_workaround_ != NULL
1583             && (*this->section_has_cortex_a8_workaround_)[shndx]);
1584   }
1585   
1586   // Mark a section that has Cortex-A8 workaround.
1587   void
1588   mark_section_for_cortex_a8_workaround(unsigned int shndx)
1589   {
1590     if (this->section_has_cortex_a8_workaround_ == NULL)
1591       this->section_has_cortex_a8_workaround_ =
1592         new std::vector<bool>(this->shnum(), false);
1593     (*this->section_has_cortex_a8_workaround_)[shndx] = true;
1594   }
1595
1596   // Return the EXIDX section of an text section with index SHNDX or NULL
1597   // if the text section has no associated EXIDX section.
1598   const Arm_exidx_input_section*
1599   exidx_input_section_by_link(unsigned int shndx) const
1600   {
1601     Exidx_section_map::const_iterator p = this->exidx_section_map_.find(shndx);
1602     return ((p != this->exidx_section_map_.end()
1603              && p->second->link() == shndx)
1604             ? p->second
1605             : NULL);
1606   }
1607
1608   // Return the EXIDX section with index SHNDX or NULL if there is none.
1609   const Arm_exidx_input_section*
1610   exidx_input_section_by_shndx(unsigned shndx) const
1611   {
1612     Exidx_section_map::const_iterator p = this->exidx_section_map_.find(shndx);
1613     return ((p != this->exidx_section_map_.end()
1614              && p->second->shndx() == shndx)
1615             ? p->second
1616             : NULL);
1617   }
1618
1619   // Whether output local symbol count needs updating.
1620   bool
1621   output_local_symbol_count_needs_update() const
1622   { return this->output_local_symbol_count_needs_update_; }
1623
1624   // Set output_local_symbol_count_needs_update flag to be true.
1625   void
1626   set_output_local_symbol_count_needs_update()
1627   { this->output_local_symbol_count_needs_update_ = true; }
1628   
1629   // Update output local symbol count at the end of relaxation.
1630   void
1631   update_output_local_symbol_count();
1632
1633   // Whether we want to merge processor-specific flags and attributes.
1634   bool
1635   merge_flags_and_attributes() const
1636   { return this->merge_flags_and_attributes_; }
1637   
1638   // Export list of EXIDX section indices.
1639   void
1640   get_exidx_shndx_list(std::vector<unsigned int>* list) const
1641   {
1642     list->clear();
1643     for (Exidx_section_map::const_iterator p = this->exidx_section_map_.begin();
1644          p != this->exidx_section_map_.end();
1645          ++p)
1646       {
1647         if (p->second->shndx() == p->first)
1648           list->push_back(p->first);
1649       }
1650     // Sort list to make result independent of implementation of map. 
1651     std::sort(list->begin(), list->end());
1652   }
1653
1654  protected:
1655   // Post constructor setup.
1656   void
1657   do_setup()
1658   {
1659     // Call parent's setup method.
1660     Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>::do_setup();
1661
1662     // Initialize look-up tables.
1663     Stub_table_list empty_stub_table_list(this->shnum(), NULL);
1664     this->stub_tables_.swap(empty_stub_table_list);
1665   }
1666
1667   // Count the local symbols.
1668   void
1669   do_count_local_symbols(Stringpool_template<char>*,
1670                          Stringpool_template<char>*);
1671
1672   void
1673   do_relocate_sections(
1674       const Symbol_table* symtab, const Layout* layout,
1675       const unsigned char* pshdrs, Output_file* of,
1676       typename Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>::Views* pivews);
1677
1678   // Read the symbol information.
1679   void
1680   do_read_symbols(Read_symbols_data* sd);
1681
1682   // Process relocs for garbage collection.
1683   void
1684   do_gc_process_relocs(Symbol_table*, Layout*, Read_relocs_data*);
1685
1686  private:
1687
1688   // Whether a section needs to be scanned for relocation stubs.
1689   bool
1690   section_needs_reloc_stub_scanning(const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>&,
1691                                     const Relobj::Output_sections&,
1692                                     const Symbol_table*, const unsigned char*);
1693
1694   // Whether a section is a scannable text section.
1695   bool
1696   section_is_scannable(const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>&, unsigned int,
1697                        const Output_section*, const Symbol_table*);
1698
1699   // Whether a section needs to be scanned for the Cortex-A8 erratum.
1700   bool
1701   section_needs_cortex_a8_stub_scanning(const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>&,
1702                                         unsigned int, Output_section*,
1703                                         const Symbol_table*);
1704
1705   // Scan a section for the Cortex-A8 erratum.
1706   void
1707   scan_section_for_cortex_a8_erratum(const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>&,
1708                                      unsigned int, Output_section*,
1709                                      Target_arm<big_endian>*);
1710
1711   // Find the linked text section of an EXIDX section by looking at the
1712   // first relocation of the EXIDX section.  PSHDR points to the section
1713   // headers of a relocation section and PSYMS points to the local symbols.
1714   // PSHNDX points to a location storing the text section index if found.
1715   // Return whether we can find the linked section.
1716   bool
1717   find_linked_text_section(const unsigned char* pshdr,
1718                            const unsigned char* psyms, unsigned int* pshndx);
1719
1720   //
1721   // Make a new Arm_exidx_input_section object for EXIDX section with
1722   // index SHNDX and section header SHDR.  TEXT_SHNDX is the section
1723   // index of the linked text section.
1724   void
1725   make_exidx_input_section(unsigned int shndx,
1726                            const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>& shdr,
1727                            unsigned int text_shndx,
1728                            const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>& text_shdr);
1729
1730   // Return the output address of either a plain input section or a
1731   // relaxed input section.  SHNDX is the section index.
1732   Arm_address
1733   simple_input_section_output_address(unsigned int, Output_section*);
1734
1735   typedef std::vector<Stub_table<big_endian>*> Stub_table_list;
1736   typedef Unordered_map<unsigned int, const Arm_exidx_input_section*>
1737     Exidx_section_map;
1738
1739   // List of stub tables.
1740   Stub_table_list stub_tables_;
1741   // Bit vector to tell if a local symbol is a thumb function or not.
1742   // This is only valid after do_count_local_symbol is called.
1743   std::vector<bool> local_symbol_is_thumb_function_;
1744   // processor-specific flags in ELF file header.
1745   elfcpp::Elf_Word processor_specific_flags_;
1746   // Object attributes if there is an .ARM.attributes section or NULL.
1747   Attributes_section_data* attributes_section_data_;
1748   // Mapping symbols information.
1749   Mapping_symbols_info mapping_symbols_info_;
1750   // Bitmap to indicate sections with Cortex-A8 workaround or NULL.
1751   std::vector<bool>* section_has_cortex_a8_workaround_;
1752   // Map a text section to its associated .ARM.exidx section, if there is one.
1753   Exidx_section_map exidx_section_map_;
1754   // Whether output local symbol count needs updating.
1755   bool output_local_symbol_count_needs_update_;
1756   // Whether we merge processor flags and attributes of this object to
1757   // output.
1758   bool merge_flags_and_attributes_;
1759 };
1760
1761 // Arm_dynobj class.
1762
1763 template<bool big_endian>
1764 class Arm_dynobj : public Sized_dynobj<32, big_endian>
1765 {
1766  public:
1767   Arm_dynobj(const std::string& name, Input_file* input_file, off_t offset,
1768              const elfcpp::Ehdr<32, big_endian>& ehdr)
1769     : Sized_dynobj<32, big_endian>(name, input_file, offset, ehdr),
1770       processor_specific_flags_(0), attributes_section_data_(NULL)
1771   { }
1772  
1773   ~Arm_dynobj()
1774   { delete this->attributes_section_data_; }
1775
1776   // Downcast a base pointer to an Arm_relobj pointer.  This is
1777   // not type-safe but we only use Arm_relobj not the base class.
1778   static Arm_dynobj<big_endian>*
1779   as_arm_dynobj(Dynobj* dynobj)
1780   { return static_cast<Arm_dynobj<big_endian>*>(dynobj); }
1781
1782   // Processor-specific flags in ELF file header.  This is valid only after
1783   // reading symbols.
1784   elfcpp::Elf_Word
1785   processor_specific_flags() const
1786   { return this->processor_specific_flags_; }
1787
1788   // Attributes section data.
1789   const Attributes_section_data*
1790   attributes_section_data() const
1791   { return this->attributes_section_data_; }
1792
1793  protected:
1794   // Read the symbol information.
1795   void
1796   do_read_symbols(Read_symbols_data* sd);
1797
1798  private:
1799   // processor-specific flags in ELF file header.
1800   elfcpp::Elf_Word processor_specific_flags_;
1801   // Object attributes if there is an .ARM.attributes section or NULL.
1802   Attributes_section_data* attributes_section_data_;
1803 };
1804
1805 // Functor to read reloc addends during stub generation.
1806
1807 template<int sh_type, bool big_endian>
1808 struct Stub_addend_reader
1809 {
1810   // Return the addend for a relocation of a particular type.  Depending
1811   // on whether this is a REL or RELA relocation, read the addend from a
1812   // view or from a Reloc object.
1813   elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword
1814   operator()(
1815     unsigned int /* r_type */,
1816     const unsigned char* /* view */,
1817     const typename Reloc_types<sh_type,
1818                                32, big_endian>::Reloc& /* reloc */) const;
1819 };
1820
1821 // Specialized Stub_addend_reader for SHT_REL type relocation sections.
1822
1823 template<bool big_endian>
1824 struct Stub_addend_reader<elfcpp::SHT_REL, big_endian>
1825 {
1826   elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword
1827   operator()(
1828     unsigned int,
1829     const unsigned char*,
1830     const typename Reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_REL, 32, big_endian>::Reloc&) const;
1831 };
1832
1833 // Specialized Stub_addend_reader for RELA type relocation sections.
1834 // We currently do not handle RELA type relocation sections but it is trivial
1835 // to implement the addend reader.  This is provided for completeness and to
1836 // make it easier to add support for RELA relocation sections in the future.
1837
1838 template<bool big_endian>
1839 struct Stub_addend_reader<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, big_endian>
1840 {
1841   elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword
1842   operator()(
1843     unsigned int,
1844     const unsigned char*,
1845     const typename Reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, 32,
1846                                big_endian>::Reloc& reloc) const
1847   { return reloc.get_r_addend(); }
1848 };
1849
1850 // Cortex_a8_reloc class.  We keep record of relocation that may need
1851 // the Cortex-A8 erratum workaround.
1852
1853 class Cortex_a8_reloc
1854 {
1855  public:
1856   Cortex_a8_reloc(Reloc_stub* reloc_stub, unsigned r_type,
1857                   Arm_address destination)
1858     : reloc_stub_(reloc_stub), r_type_(r_type), destination_(destination)
1859   { }
1860
1861   ~Cortex_a8_reloc()
1862   { }
1863
1864   // Accessors:  This is a read-only class.
1865   
1866   // Return the relocation stub associated with this relocation if there is
1867   // one.
1868   const Reloc_stub*
1869   reloc_stub() const
1870   { return this->reloc_stub_; } 
1871   
1872   // Return the relocation type.
1873   unsigned int
1874   r_type() const
1875   { return this->r_type_; }
1876
1877   // Return the destination address of the relocation.  LSB stores the THUMB
1878   // bit.
1879   Arm_address
1880   destination() const
1881   { return this->destination_; }
1882
1883  private:
1884   // Associated relocation stub if there is one, or NULL.
1885   const Reloc_stub* reloc_stub_;
1886   // Relocation type.
1887   unsigned int r_type_;
1888   // Destination address of this relocation.  LSB is used to distinguish
1889   // ARM/THUMB mode.
1890   Arm_address destination_;
1891 };
1892
1893 // Arm_output_data_got class.  We derive this from Output_data_got to add
1894 // extra methods to handle TLS relocations in a static link.
1895
1896 template<bool big_endian>
1897 class Arm_output_data_got : public Output_data_got<32, big_endian>
1898 {
1899  public:
1900   Arm_output_data_got(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout)
1901     : Output_data_got<32, big_endian>(), symbol_table_(symtab), layout_(layout)
1902   { }
1903
1904   // Add a static entry for the GOT entry at OFFSET.  GSYM is a global
1905   // symbol and R_TYPE is the code of a dynamic relocation that needs to be
1906   // applied in a static link.
1907   void
1908   add_static_reloc(unsigned int got_offset, unsigned int r_type, Symbol* gsym)
1909   { this->static_relocs_.push_back(Static_reloc(got_offset, r_type, gsym)); }
1910
1911   // Add a static reloc for the GOT entry at OFFSET.  RELOBJ is an object
1912   // defining a local symbol with INDEX.  R_TYPE is the code of a dynamic
1913   // relocation that needs to be applied in a static link.
1914   void
1915   add_static_reloc(unsigned int got_offset, unsigned int r_type,
1916                    Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* relobj,
1917                    unsigned int index)
1918   {
1919     this->static_relocs_.push_back(Static_reloc(got_offset, r_type, relobj,
1920                                                 index));
1921   }
1922
1923   // Add a GOT pair for R_ARM_TLS_GD32.  The creates a pair of GOT entries.
1924   // The first one is initialized to be 1, which is the module index for
1925   // the main executable and the second one 0.  A reloc of the type
1926   // R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32 will be created for the second GOT entry and will
1927   // be applied by gold.  GSYM is a global symbol.
1928   void
1929   add_tls_gd32_with_static_reloc(unsigned int got_type, Symbol* gsym);
1930
1931   // Same as the above but for a local symbol in OBJECT with INDEX.
1932   void
1933   add_tls_gd32_with_static_reloc(unsigned int got_type,
1934                                  Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
1935                                  unsigned int index);
1936
1937  protected:
1938   // Write out the GOT table.
1939   void
1940   do_write(Output_file*);
1941
1942  private:
1943   // This class represent dynamic relocations that need to be applied by
1944   // gold because we are using TLS relocations in a static link.
1945   class Static_reloc
1946   {
1947    public:
1948     Static_reloc(unsigned int got_offset, unsigned int r_type, Symbol* gsym)
1949       : got_offset_(got_offset), r_type_(r_type), symbol_is_global_(true)
1950     { this->u_.global.symbol = gsym; }
1951
1952     Static_reloc(unsigned int got_offset, unsigned int r_type,
1953           Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* relobj, unsigned int index)
1954       : got_offset_(got_offset), r_type_(r_type), symbol_is_global_(false)
1955     {
1956       this->u_.local.relobj = relobj;
1957       this->u_.local.index = index;
1958     }
1959
1960     // Return the GOT offset.
1961     unsigned int
1962     got_offset() const
1963     { return this->got_offset_; }
1964
1965     // Relocation type.
1966     unsigned int
1967     r_type() const
1968     { return this->r_type_; }
1969
1970     // Whether the symbol is global or not.
1971     bool
1972     symbol_is_global() const
1973     { return this->symbol_is_global_; }
1974
1975     // For a relocation against a global symbol, the global symbol.
1976     Symbol*
1977     symbol() const
1978     {
1979       gold_assert(this->symbol_is_global_);
1980       return this->u_.global.symbol;
1981     }
1982
1983     // For a relocation against a local symbol, the defining object.
1984     Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>*
1985     relobj() const
1986     {
1987       gold_assert(!this->symbol_is_global_);
1988       return this->u_.local.relobj;
1989     }
1990
1991     // For a relocation against a local symbol, the local symbol index.
1992     unsigned int
1993     index() const
1994     {
1995       gold_assert(!this->symbol_is_global_);
1996       return this->u_.local.index;
1997     }
1998
1999    private:
2000     // GOT offset of the entry to which this relocation is applied.
2001     unsigned int got_offset_;
2002     // Type of relocation.
2003     unsigned int r_type_;
2004     // Whether this relocation is against a global symbol.
2005     bool symbol_is_global_;
2006     // A global or local symbol.
2007     union
2008     {
2009       struct
2010       {
2011         // For a global symbol, the symbol itself.
2012         Symbol* symbol;
2013       } global;
2014       struct
2015       {
2016         // For a local symbol, the object defining object.
2017         Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* relobj;
2018         // For a local symbol, the symbol index.
2019         unsigned int index;
2020       } local;
2021     } u_;
2022   };
2023
2024   // Symbol table of the output object.
2025   Symbol_table* symbol_table_;
2026   // Layout of the output object.
2027   Layout* layout_;
2028   // Static relocs to be applied to the GOT.
2029   std::vector<Static_reloc> static_relocs_;
2030 };
2031
2032 // The ARM target has many relocation types with odd-sizes or noncontiguous
2033 // bits.  The default handling of relocatable relocation cannot process these
2034 // relocations.  So we have to extend the default code.
2035
2036 template<bool big_endian, int sh_type, typename Classify_reloc>
2037 class Arm_scan_relocatable_relocs :
2038   public Default_scan_relocatable_relocs<sh_type, Classify_reloc>
2039 {
2040  public:
2041   // Return the strategy to use for a local symbol which is a section
2042   // symbol, given the relocation type.
2043   inline Relocatable_relocs::Reloc_strategy
2044   local_section_strategy(unsigned int r_type, Relobj*)
2045   {
2046     if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
2047       return Relocatable_relocs::RELOC_ADJUST_FOR_SECTION_RELA;
2048     else
2049       {
2050         if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET1
2051             || r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET2)
2052           {
2053             const Target_arm<big_endian>* arm_target =
2054               Target_arm<big_endian>::default_target();
2055             r_type = arm_target->get_real_reloc_type(r_type);
2056           }
2057
2058         switch(r_type)
2059           {
2060           // Relocations that write nothing.  These exclude R_ARM_TARGET1
2061           // and R_ARM_TARGET2.
2062           case elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE:
2063           case elfcpp::R_ARM_V4BX:
2064           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_GOTDESC:
2065           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_CALL:
2066           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_DESCSEQ:
2067           case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_TLS_CALL:
2068           case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOTRELAX:
2069           case elfcpp::R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY:
2070           case elfcpp::R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT:
2071           case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ16:
2072           case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_TLS_DESCSEQ32:
2073             return Relocatable_relocs::RELOC_ADJUST_FOR_SECTION_0;
2074           // These should have been converted to something else above.
2075           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET1:
2076           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET2:
2077             gold_unreachable();
2078           // Relocations that write full 32 bits.
2079           case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32:
2080           case elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32:
2081           case elfcpp::R_ARM_SBREL32:
2082           case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOTOFF32:
2083           case elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_PREL:
2084           case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_BREL:
2085           case elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_ABS:
2086           case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32_NOI:
2087           case elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32_NOI:
2088           case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32_ABS:
2089           case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_ABS:
2090           case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_PREL:
2091           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_GD32:
2092           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:
2093           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDO32:
2094           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_IE32:
2095           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LE32:
2096             return Relocatable_relocs::RELOC_ADJUST_FOR_SECTION_4;
2097           default:
2098             // For all other static relocations, return RELOC_SPECIAL.
2099             return Relocatable_relocs::RELOC_SPECIAL;
2100           }
2101       }
2102   }
2103 };
2104
2105 // Utilities for manipulating integers of up to 32-bits
2106
2107 namespace utils
2108 {
2109   // Sign extend an n-bit unsigned integer stored in an uint32_t into
2110   // an int32_t.  NO_BITS must be between 1 to 32.
2111   template<int no_bits>
2112   static inline int32_t
2113   sign_extend(uint32_t bits)
2114   {
2115     gold_assert(no_bits >= 0 && no_bits <= 32);
2116     if (no_bits == 32)
2117       return static_cast<int32_t>(bits);
2118     uint32_t mask = (~((uint32_t) 0)) >> (32 - no_bits);
2119     bits &= mask;
2120     uint32_t top_bit = 1U << (no_bits - 1);
2121     int32_t as_signed = static_cast<int32_t>(bits);
2122     return (bits & top_bit) ? as_signed + (-top_bit * 2) : as_signed;
2123   }
2124
2125   // Detects overflow of an NO_BITS integer stored in a uint32_t.
2126   template<int no_bits>
2127   static inline bool
2128   has_overflow(uint32_t bits)
2129   {
2130     gold_assert(no_bits >= 0 && no_bits <= 32);
2131     if (no_bits == 32)
2132       return false;
2133     int32_t max = (1 << (no_bits - 1)) - 1;
2134     int32_t min = -(1 << (no_bits - 1));
2135     int32_t as_signed = static_cast<int32_t>(bits);
2136     return as_signed > max || as_signed < min;
2137   }
2138
2139   // Detects overflow of an NO_BITS integer stored in a uint32_t when it
2140   // fits in the given number of bits as either a signed or unsigned value.
2141   // For example, has_signed_unsigned_overflow<8> would check
2142   // -128 <= bits <= 255
2143   template<int no_bits>
2144   static inline bool
2145   has_signed_unsigned_overflow(uint32_t bits)
2146   {
2147     gold_assert(no_bits >= 2 && no_bits <= 32);
2148     if (no_bits == 32)
2149       return false;
2150     int32_t max = static_cast<int32_t>((1U << no_bits) - 1);
2151     int32_t min = -(1 << (no_bits - 1));
2152     int32_t as_signed = static_cast<int32_t>(bits);
2153     return as_signed > max || as_signed < min;
2154   }
2155
2156   // Select bits from A and B using bits in MASK.  For each n in [0..31],
2157   // the n-th bit in the result is chosen from the n-th bits of A and B.
2158   // A zero selects A and a one selects B.
2159   static inline uint32_t
2160   bit_select(uint32_t a, uint32_t b, uint32_t mask)
2161   { return (a & ~mask) | (b & mask); }
2162 };
2163
2164 template<bool big_endian>
2165 class Target_arm : public Sized_target<32, big_endian>
2166 {
2167  public:
2168   typedef Output_data_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, true, 32, big_endian>
2169     Reloc_section;
2170
2171   // When were are relocating a stub, we pass this as the relocation number.
2172   static const size_t fake_relnum_for_stubs = static_cast<size_t>(-1);
2173
2174   Target_arm()
2175     : Sized_target<32, big_endian>(&arm_info),
2176       got_(NULL), plt_(NULL), got_plt_(NULL), rel_dyn_(NULL),
2177       copy_relocs_(elfcpp::R_ARM_COPY), dynbss_(NULL), 
2178       got_mod_index_offset_(-1U), tls_base_symbol_defined_(false),
2179       stub_tables_(), stub_factory_(Stub_factory::get_instance()),
2180       may_use_blx_(false), should_force_pic_veneer_(false),
2181       arm_input_section_map_(), attributes_section_data_(NULL),
2182       fix_cortex_a8_(false), cortex_a8_relocs_info_()
2183   { }
2184
2185   // Virtual function which is set to return true by a target if
2186   // it can use relocation types to determine if a function's
2187   // pointer is taken.
2188   virtual bool
2189   can_check_for_function_pointers() const
2190   { return true; }
2191
2192   // Whether a section called SECTION_NAME may have function pointers to
2193   // sections not eligible for safe ICF folding.
2194   virtual bool
2195   section_may_have_icf_unsafe_pointers(const char* section_name) const
2196   {
2197     return (!is_prefix_of(".ARM.exidx", section_name)
2198             && !is_prefix_of(".ARM.extab", section_name)
2199             && Target::section_may_have_icf_unsafe_pointers(section_name));
2200   }
2201   
2202   // Whether we can use BLX.
2203   bool
2204   may_use_blx() const
2205   { return this->may_use_blx_; }
2206
2207   // Set use-BLX flag.
2208   void
2209   set_may_use_blx(bool value)
2210   { this->may_use_blx_ = value; }
2211   
2212   // Whether we force PCI branch veneers.
2213   bool
2214   should_force_pic_veneer() const
2215   { return this->should_force_pic_veneer_; }
2216
2217   // Set PIC veneer flag.
2218   void
2219   set_should_force_pic_veneer(bool value)
2220   { this->should_force_pic_veneer_ = value; }
2221   
2222   // Whether we use THUMB-2 instructions.
2223   bool
2224   using_thumb2() const
2225   {
2226     Object_attribute* attr =
2227       this->get_aeabi_object_attribute(elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch);
2228     int arch = attr->int_value();
2229     return arch == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6T2 || arch >= elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7;
2230   }
2231
2232   // Whether we use THUMB/THUMB-2 instructions only.
2233   bool
2234   using_thumb_only() const
2235   {
2236     Object_attribute* attr =
2237       this->get_aeabi_object_attribute(elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch);
2238
2239     if (attr->int_value() == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6_M
2240         || attr->int_value() == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6S_M)
2241       return true;
2242     if (attr->int_value() != elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7
2243         && attr->int_value() != elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7E_M)
2244       return false;
2245     attr = this->get_aeabi_object_attribute(elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch_profile);
2246     return attr->int_value() == 'M';
2247   }
2248
2249   // Whether we have an NOP instruction.  If not, use mov r0, r0 instead.
2250   bool
2251   may_use_arm_nop() const
2252   {
2253     Object_attribute* attr =
2254       this->get_aeabi_object_attribute(elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch);
2255     int arch = attr->int_value();
2256     return (arch == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6T2
2257             || arch == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6K
2258             || arch == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7
2259             || arch == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7E_M);
2260   }
2261
2262   // Whether we have THUMB-2 NOP.W instruction.
2263   bool
2264   may_use_thumb2_nop() const
2265   {
2266     Object_attribute* attr =
2267       this->get_aeabi_object_attribute(elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch);
2268     int arch = attr->int_value();
2269     return (arch == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6T2
2270             || arch == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7
2271             || arch == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7E_M);
2272   }
2273   
2274   // Process the relocations to determine unreferenced sections for 
2275   // garbage collection.
2276   void
2277   gc_process_relocs(Symbol_table* symtab,
2278                     Layout* layout,
2279                     Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
2280                     unsigned int data_shndx,
2281                     unsigned int sh_type,
2282                     const unsigned char* prelocs,
2283                     size_t reloc_count,
2284                     Output_section* output_section,
2285                     bool needs_special_offset_handling,
2286                     size_t local_symbol_count,
2287                     const unsigned char* plocal_symbols);
2288
2289   // Scan the relocations to look for symbol adjustments.
2290   void
2291   scan_relocs(Symbol_table* symtab,
2292               Layout* layout,
2293               Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
2294               unsigned int data_shndx,
2295               unsigned int sh_type,
2296               const unsigned char* prelocs,
2297               size_t reloc_count,
2298               Output_section* output_section,
2299               bool needs_special_offset_handling,
2300               size_t local_symbol_count,
2301               const unsigned char* plocal_symbols);
2302
2303   // Finalize the sections.
2304   void
2305   do_finalize_sections(Layout*, const Input_objects*, Symbol_table*);
2306
2307   // Return the value to use for a dynamic symbol which requires special
2308   // treatment.
2309   uint64_t
2310   do_dynsym_value(const Symbol*) const;
2311
2312   // Relocate a section.
2313   void
2314   relocate_section(const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*,
2315                    unsigned int sh_type,
2316                    const unsigned char* prelocs,
2317                    size_t reloc_count,
2318                    Output_section* output_section,
2319                    bool needs_special_offset_handling,
2320                    unsigned char* view,
2321                    Arm_address view_address,
2322                    section_size_type view_size,
2323                    const Reloc_symbol_changes*);
2324
2325   // Scan the relocs during a relocatable link.
2326   void
2327   scan_relocatable_relocs(Symbol_table* symtab,
2328                           Layout* layout,
2329                           Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
2330                           unsigned int data_shndx,
2331                           unsigned int sh_type,
2332                           const unsigned char* prelocs,
2333                           size_t reloc_count,
2334                           Output_section* output_section,
2335                           bool needs_special_offset_handling,
2336                           size_t local_symbol_count,
2337                           const unsigned char* plocal_symbols,
2338                           Relocatable_relocs*);
2339
2340   // Relocate a section during a relocatable link.
2341   void
2342   relocate_for_relocatable(const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*,
2343                            unsigned int sh_type,
2344                            const unsigned char* prelocs,
2345                            size_t reloc_count,
2346                            Output_section* output_section,
2347                            off_t offset_in_output_section,
2348                            const Relocatable_relocs*,
2349                            unsigned char* view,
2350                            Arm_address view_address,
2351                            section_size_type view_size,
2352                            unsigned char* reloc_view,
2353                            section_size_type reloc_view_size);
2354
2355   // Perform target-specific processing in a relocatable link.  This is
2356   // only used if we use the relocation strategy RELOC_SPECIAL.
2357   void
2358   relocate_special_relocatable(const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
2359                                unsigned int sh_type,
2360                                const unsigned char* preloc_in,
2361                                size_t relnum,
2362                                Output_section* output_section,
2363                                off_t offset_in_output_section,
2364                                unsigned char* view,
2365                                typename elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Addr
2366                                  view_address,
2367                                section_size_type view_size,
2368                                unsigned char* preloc_out);
2369  
2370   // Return whether SYM is defined by the ABI.
2371   bool
2372   do_is_defined_by_abi(Symbol* sym) const
2373   { return strcmp(sym->name(), "__tls_get_addr") == 0; }
2374
2375   // Return whether there is a GOT section.
2376   bool
2377   has_got_section() const
2378   { return this->got_ != NULL; }
2379
2380   // Return the size of the GOT section.
2381   section_size_type
2382   got_size() const
2383   {
2384     gold_assert(this->got_ != NULL);
2385     return this->got_->data_size();
2386   }
2387
2388   // Return the number of entries in the GOT.
2389   unsigned int
2390   got_entry_count() const
2391   {
2392     if (!this->has_got_section())
2393       return 0;
2394     return this->got_size() / 4;
2395   }
2396
2397   // Return the number of entries in the PLT.
2398   unsigned int
2399   plt_entry_count() const;
2400
2401   // Return the offset of the first non-reserved PLT entry.
2402   unsigned int
2403   first_plt_entry_offset() const;
2404
2405   // Return the size of each PLT entry.
2406   unsigned int
2407   plt_entry_size() const;
2408
2409   // Map platform-specific reloc types
2410   static unsigned int
2411   get_real_reloc_type(unsigned int r_type);
2412
2413   //
2414   // Methods to support stub-generations.
2415   //
2416   
2417   // Return the stub factory
2418   const Stub_factory&
2419   stub_factory() const
2420   { return this->stub_factory_; }
2421
2422   // Make a new Arm_input_section object.
2423   Arm_input_section<big_endian>*
2424   new_arm_input_section(Relobj*, unsigned int);
2425
2426   // Find the Arm_input_section object corresponding to the SHNDX-th input
2427   // section of RELOBJ.
2428   Arm_input_section<big_endian>*
2429   find_arm_input_section(Relobj* relobj, unsigned int shndx) const;
2430
2431   // Make a new Stub_table
2432   Stub_table<big_endian>*
2433   new_stub_table(Arm_input_section<big_endian>*);
2434
2435   // Scan a section for stub generation.
2436   void
2437   scan_section_for_stubs(const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*, unsigned int,
2438                          const unsigned char*, size_t, Output_section*,
2439                          bool, const unsigned char*, Arm_address,
2440                          section_size_type);
2441
2442   // Relocate a stub. 
2443   void
2444   relocate_stub(Stub*, const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*,
2445                 Output_section*, unsigned char*, Arm_address,
2446                 section_size_type);
2447  
2448   // Get the default ARM target.
2449   static Target_arm<big_endian>*
2450   default_target()
2451   {
2452     gold_assert(parameters->target().machine_code() == elfcpp::EM_ARM
2453                 && parameters->target().is_big_endian() == big_endian);
2454     return static_cast<Target_arm<big_endian>*>(
2455              parameters->sized_target<32, big_endian>());
2456   }
2457
2458   // Whether NAME belongs to a mapping symbol.
2459   static bool
2460   is_mapping_symbol_name(const char* name)
2461   {
2462     return (name
2463             && name[0] == '$'
2464             && (name[1] == 'a' || name[1] == 't' || name[1] == 'd')
2465             && (name[2] == '\0' || name[2] == '.'));
2466   }
2467
2468   // Whether we work around the Cortex-A8 erratum.
2469   bool
2470   fix_cortex_a8() const
2471   { return this->fix_cortex_a8_; }
2472
2473   // Whether we merge exidx entries in debuginfo.
2474   bool
2475   merge_exidx_entries() const
2476   { return parameters->options().merge_exidx_entries(); }
2477
2478   // Whether we fix R_ARM_V4BX relocation.
2479   // 0 - do not fix
2480   // 1 - replace with MOV instruction (armv4 target)
2481   // 2 - make interworking veneer (>= armv4t targets only)
2482   General_options::Fix_v4bx
2483   fix_v4bx() const
2484   { return parameters->options().fix_v4bx(); }
2485
2486   // Scan a span of THUMB code section for Cortex-A8 erratum.
2487   void
2488   scan_span_for_cortex_a8_erratum(Arm_relobj<big_endian>*, unsigned int,
2489                                   section_size_type, section_size_type,
2490                                   const unsigned char*, Arm_address);
2491
2492   // Apply Cortex-A8 workaround to a branch.
2493   void
2494   apply_cortex_a8_workaround(const Cortex_a8_stub*, Arm_address,
2495                              unsigned char*, Arm_address);
2496
2497  protected:
2498   // Make an ELF object.
2499   Object*
2500   do_make_elf_object(const std::string&, Input_file*, off_t,
2501                      const elfcpp::Ehdr<32, big_endian>& ehdr);
2502
2503   Object*
2504   do_make_elf_object(const std::string&, Input_file*, off_t,
2505                      const elfcpp::Ehdr<32, !big_endian>&)
2506   { gold_unreachable(); }
2507
2508   Object*
2509   do_make_elf_object(const std::string&, Input_file*, off_t,
2510                       const elfcpp::Ehdr<64, false>&)
2511   { gold_unreachable(); }
2512
2513   Object*
2514   do_make_elf_object(const std::string&, Input_file*, off_t,
2515                      const elfcpp::Ehdr<64, true>&)
2516   { gold_unreachable(); }
2517
2518   // Make an output section.
2519   Output_section*
2520   do_make_output_section(const char* name, elfcpp::Elf_Word type,
2521                          elfcpp::Elf_Xword flags)
2522   { return new Arm_output_section<big_endian>(name, type, flags); }
2523
2524   void
2525   do_adjust_elf_header(unsigned char* view, int len) const;
2526
2527   // We only need to generate stubs, and hence perform relaxation if we are
2528   // not doing relocatable linking.
2529   bool
2530   do_may_relax() const
2531   { return !parameters->options().relocatable(); }
2532
2533   bool
2534   do_relax(int, const Input_objects*, Symbol_table*, Layout*, const Task*);
2535
2536   // Determine whether an object attribute tag takes an integer, a
2537   // string or both.
2538   int
2539   do_attribute_arg_type(int tag) const;
2540
2541   // Reorder tags during output.
2542   int
2543   do_attributes_order(int num) const;
2544
2545   // This is called when the target is selected as the default.
2546   void
2547   do_select_as_default_target()
2548   {
2549     // No locking is required since there should only be one default target.
2550     // We cannot have both the big-endian and little-endian ARM targets
2551     // as the default.
2552     gold_assert(arm_reloc_property_table == NULL);
2553     arm_reloc_property_table = new Arm_reloc_property_table();
2554   }
2555
2556  private:
2557   // The class which scans relocations.
2558   class Scan
2559   {
2560    public:
2561     Scan()
2562       : issued_non_pic_error_(false)
2563     { }
2564
2565     static inline int
2566     get_reference_flags(unsigned int r_type);
2567
2568     inline void
2569     local(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout, Target_arm* target,
2570           Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
2571           unsigned int data_shndx,
2572           Output_section* output_section,
2573           const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>& reloc, unsigned int r_type,
2574           const elfcpp::Sym<32, big_endian>& lsym);
2575
2576     inline void
2577     global(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout, Target_arm* target,
2578            Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
2579            unsigned int data_shndx,
2580            Output_section* output_section,
2581            const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>& reloc, unsigned int r_type,
2582            Symbol* gsym);
2583
2584     inline bool
2585     local_reloc_may_be_function_pointer(Symbol_table* , Layout* , Target_arm* ,
2586                                         Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* ,
2587                                         unsigned int ,
2588                                         Output_section* ,
2589                                         const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>& ,
2590                                         unsigned int ,
2591                                         const elfcpp::Sym<32, big_endian>&);
2592
2593     inline bool
2594     global_reloc_may_be_function_pointer(Symbol_table* , Layout* , Target_arm* ,
2595                                          Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* ,
2596                                          unsigned int ,
2597                                          Output_section* ,
2598                                          const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>& ,
2599                                          unsigned int , Symbol*);
2600
2601    private:
2602     static void
2603     unsupported_reloc_local(Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>*,
2604                             unsigned int r_type);
2605
2606     static void
2607     unsupported_reloc_global(Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>*,
2608                              unsigned int r_type, Symbol*);
2609
2610     void
2611     check_non_pic(Relobj*, unsigned int r_type);
2612
2613     // Almost identical to Symbol::needs_plt_entry except that it also
2614     // handles STT_ARM_TFUNC.
2615     static bool
2616     symbol_needs_plt_entry(const Symbol* sym)
2617     {
2618       // An undefined symbol from an executable does not need a PLT entry.
2619       if (sym->is_undefined() && !parameters->options().shared())
2620         return false;
2621
2622       return (!parameters->doing_static_link()
2623               && (sym->type() == elfcpp::STT_FUNC
2624                   || sym->type() == elfcpp::STT_ARM_TFUNC)
2625               && (sym->is_from_dynobj()
2626                   || sym->is_undefined()
2627                   || sym->is_preemptible()));
2628     }
2629
2630     inline bool
2631     possible_function_pointer_reloc(unsigned int r_type);
2632
2633     // Whether we have issued an error about a non-PIC compilation.
2634     bool issued_non_pic_error_;
2635   };
2636
2637   // The class which implements relocation.
2638   class Relocate
2639   {
2640    public:
2641     Relocate()
2642     { }
2643
2644     ~Relocate()
2645     { }
2646
2647     // Return whether the static relocation needs to be applied.
2648     inline bool
2649     should_apply_static_reloc(const Sized_symbol<32>* gsym,
2650                               unsigned int r_type,
2651                               bool is_32bit,
2652                               Output_section* output_section);
2653
2654     // Do a relocation.  Return false if the caller should not issue
2655     // any warnings about this relocation.
2656     inline bool
2657     relocate(const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*, Target_arm*,
2658              Output_section*,  size_t relnum,
2659              const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>&,
2660              unsigned int r_type, const Sized_symbol<32>*,
2661              const Symbol_value<32>*,
2662              unsigned char*, Arm_address,
2663              section_size_type);
2664
2665     // Return whether we want to pass flag NON_PIC_REF for this
2666     // reloc.  This means the relocation type accesses a symbol not via
2667     // GOT or PLT.
2668     static inline bool
2669     reloc_is_non_pic(unsigned int r_type)
2670     {
2671       switch (r_type)
2672         {
2673         // These relocation types reference GOT or PLT entries explicitly.
2674         case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_BREL:
2675         case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_ABS:
2676         case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_PREL:
2677         case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_BREL12:
2678         case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32_ABS:
2679         case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_GD32:
2680         case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:
2681         case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_IE32:
2682         case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_IE12GP:
2683
2684         // These relocate types may use PLT entries.
2685         case elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL:
2686         case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL:
2687         case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24:
2688         case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
2689         case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
2690         case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32:
2691         case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_XPC22:
2692         case elfcpp::R_ARM_PREL31:
2693         case elfcpp::R_ARM_SBREL31:
2694           return false;
2695
2696         default:
2697           return true;
2698         }
2699     }
2700
2701    private:
2702     // Do a TLS relocation.
2703     inline typename Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::Status
2704     relocate_tls(const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*, Target_arm<big_endian>*,
2705                  size_t, const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>&, unsigned int,
2706                  const Sized_symbol<32>*, const Symbol_value<32>*,
2707                  unsigned char*, elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Addr,
2708                  section_size_type);
2709
2710   };
2711
2712   // A class which returns the size required for a relocation type,
2713   // used while scanning relocs during a relocatable link.
2714   class Relocatable_size_for_reloc
2715   {
2716    public:
2717     unsigned int
2718     get_size_for_reloc(unsigned int, Relobj*);
2719   };
2720
2721   // Adjust TLS relocation type based on the options and whether this
2722   // is a local symbol.
2723   static tls::Tls_optimization
2724   optimize_tls_reloc(bool is_final, int r_type);
2725
2726   // Get the GOT section, creating it if necessary.
2727   Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>*
2728   got_section(Symbol_table*, Layout*);
2729
2730   // Get the GOT PLT section.
2731   Output_data_space*
2732   got_plt_section() const
2733   {
2734     gold_assert(this->got_plt_ != NULL);
2735     return this->got_plt_;
2736   }
2737
2738   // Create a PLT entry for a global symbol.
2739   void
2740   make_plt_entry(Symbol_table*, Layout*, Symbol*);
2741
2742   // Define the _TLS_MODULE_BASE_ symbol in the TLS segment.
2743   void
2744   define_tls_base_symbol(Symbol_table*, Layout*);
2745
2746   // Create a GOT entry for the TLS module index.
2747   unsigned int
2748   got_mod_index_entry(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout,
2749                       Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object);
2750
2751   // Get the PLT section.
2752   const Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>*
2753   plt_section() const
2754   {
2755     gold_assert(this->plt_ != NULL);
2756     return this->plt_;
2757   }
2758
2759   // Get the dynamic reloc section, creating it if necessary.
2760   Reloc_section*
2761   rel_dyn_section(Layout*);
2762
2763   // Get the section to use for TLS_DESC relocations.
2764   Reloc_section*
2765   rel_tls_desc_section(Layout*) const;
2766
2767   // Return true if the symbol may need a COPY relocation.
2768   // References from an executable object to non-function symbols
2769   // defined in a dynamic object may need a COPY relocation.
2770   bool
2771   may_need_copy_reloc(Symbol* gsym)
2772   {
2773     return (gsym->type() != elfcpp::STT_ARM_TFUNC
2774             && gsym->may_need_copy_reloc());
2775   }
2776
2777   // Add a potential copy relocation.
2778   void
2779   copy_reloc(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout,
2780              Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
2781              unsigned int shndx, Output_section* output_section,
2782              Symbol* sym, const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>& reloc)
2783   {
2784     this->copy_relocs_.copy_reloc(symtab, layout,
2785                                   symtab->get_sized_symbol<32>(sym),
2786                                   object, shndx, output_section, reloc,
2787                                   this->rel_dyn_section(layout));
2788   }
2789
2790   // Whether two EABI versions are compatible.
2791   static bool
2792   are_eabi_versions_compatible(elfcpp::Elf_Word v1, elfcpp::Elf_Word v2);
2793
2794   // Merge processor-specific flags from input object and those in the ELF
2795   // header of the output.
2796   void
2797   merge_processor_specific_flags(const std::string&, elfcpp::Elf_Word);
2798
2799   // Get the secondary compatible architecture.
2800   static int
2801   get_secondary_compatible_arch(const Attributes_section_data*);
2802
2803   // Set the secondary compatible architecture.
2804   static void
2805   set_secondary_compatible_arch(Attributes_section_data*, int);
2806
2807   static int
2808   tag_cpu_arch_combine(const char*, int, int*, int, int);
2809
2810   // Helper to print AEABI enum tag value.
2811   static std::string
2812   aeabi_enum_name(unsigned int);
2813
2814   // Return string value for TAG_CPU_name.
2815   static std::string
2816   tag_cpu_name_value(unsigned int);
2817
2818   // Merge object attributes from input object and those in the output.
2819   void
2820   merge_object_attributes(const char*, const Attributes_section_data*);
2821
2822   // Helper to get an AEABI object attribute
2823   Object_attribute*
2824   get_aeabi_object_attribute(int tag) const
2825   {
2826     Attributes_section_data* pasd = this->attributes_section_data_;
2827     gold_assert(pasd != NULL);
2828     Object_attribute* attr =
2829       pasd->get_attribute(Object_attribute::OBJ_ATTR_PROC, tag);
2830     gold_assert(attr != NULL);
2831     return attr;
2832   }
2833
2834   //
2835   // Methods to support stub-generations.
2836   //
2837
2838   // Group input sections for stub generation.
2839   void
2840   group_sections(Layout*, section_size_type, bool, const Task*);
2841
2842   // Scan a relocation for stub generation.
2843   void
2844   scan_reloc_for_stub(const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*, unsigned int,
2845                       const Sized_symbol<32>*, unsigned int,
2846                       const Symbol_value<32>*,
2847                       elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword, Arm_address);
2848
2849   // Scan a relocation section for stub.
2850   template<int sh_type>
2851   void
2852   scan_reloc_section_for_stubs(
2853       const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
2854       const unsigned char* prelocs,
2855       size_t reloc_count,
2856       Output_section* output_section,
2857       bool needs_special_offset_handling,
2858       const unsigned char* view,
2859       elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Addr view_address,
2860       section_size_type);
2861
2862   // Fix .ARM.exidx section coverage.
2863   void
2864   fix_exidx_coverage(Layout*, const Input_objects*,
2865                      Arm_output_section<big_endian>*, Symbol_table*,
2866                      const Task*);
2867
2868   // Functors for STL set.
2869   struct output_section_address_less_than
2870   {
2871     bool
2872     operator()(const Output_section* s1, const Output_section* s2) const
2873     { return s1->address() < s2->address(); }
2874   };
2875
2876   // Information about this specific target which we pass to the
2877   // general Target structure.
2878   static const Target::Target_info arm_info;
2879
2880   // The types of GOT entries needed for this platform.
2881   // These values are exposed to the ABI in an incremental link.
2882   // Do not renumber existing values without changing the version
2883   // number of the .gnu_incremental_inputs section.
2884   enum Got_type
2885   {
2886     GOT_TYPE_STANDARD = 0,      // GOT entry for a regular symbol
2887     GOT_TYPE_TLS_NOFFSET = 1,   // GOT entry for negative TLS offset
2888     GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET = 2,    // GOT entry for positive TLS offset
2889     GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR = 3,      // GOT entry for TLS module/offset pair
2890     GOT_TYPE_TLS_DESC = 4       // GOT entry for TLS_DESC pair
2891   };
2892
2893   typedef typename std::vector<Stub_table<big_endian>*> Stub_table_list;
2894
2895   // Map input section to Arm_input_section.
2896   typedef Unordered_map<Section_id,
2897                         Arm_input_section<big_endian>*,
2898                         Section_id_hash>
2899           Arm_input_section_map;
2900     
2901   // Map output addresses to relocs for Cortex-A8 erratum.
2902   typedef Unordered_map<Arm_address, const Cortex_a8_reloc*>
2903           Cortex_a8_relocs_info;
2904
2905   // The GOT section.
2906   Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>* got_;
2907   // The PLT section.
2908   Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>* plt_;
2909   // The GOT PLT section.
2910   Output_data_space* got_plt_;
2911   // The dynamic reloc section.
2912   Reloc_section* rel_dyn_;
2913   // Relocs saved to avoid a COPY reloc.
2914   Copy_relocs<elfcpp::SHT_REL, 32, big_endian> copy_relocs_;
2915   // Space for variables copied with a COPY reloc.
2916   Output_data_space* dynbss_;
2917   // Offset of the GOT entry for the TLS module index.
2918   unsigned int got_mod_index_offset_;
2919   // True if the _TLS_MODULE_BASE_ symbol has been defined.
2920   bool tls_base_symbol_defined_;
2921   // Vector of Stub_tables created.
2922   Stub_table_list stub_tables_;
2923   // Stub factory.
2924   const Stub_factory &stub_factory_;
2925   // Whether we can use BLX.
2926   bool may_use_blx_;
2927   // Whether we force PIC branch veneers.
2928   bool should_force_pic_veneer_;
2929   // Map for locating Arm_input_sections.
2930   Arm_input_section_map arm_input_section_map_;
2931   // Attributes section data in output.
2932   Attributes_section_data* attributes_section_data_;
2933   // Whether we want to fix code for Cortex-A8 erratum.
2934   bool fix_cortex_a8_;
2935   // Map addresses to relocs for Cortex-A8 erratum.
2936   Cortex_a8_relocs_info cortex_a8_relocs_info_;
2937 };
2938
2939 template<bool big_endian>
2940 const Target::Target_info Target_arm<big_endian>::arm_info =
2941 {
2942   32,                   // size
2943   big_endian,           // is_big_endian
2944   elfcpp::EM_ARM,       // machine_code
2945   false,                // has_make_symbol
2946   false,                // has_resolve
2947   false,                // has_code_fill
2948   true,                 // is_default_stack_executable
2949   '\0',                 // wrap_char
2950   "/usr/lib/libc.so.1", // dynamic_linker
2951   0x8000,               // default_text_segment_address
2952   0x1000,               // abi_pagesize (overridable by -z max-page-size)
2953   0x1000,               // common_pagesize (overridable by -z common-page-size)
2954   elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF,    // small_common_shndx
2955   elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF,    // large_common_shndx
2956   0,                    // small_common_section_flags
2957   0,                    // large_common_section_flags
2958   ".ARM.attributes",    // attributes_section
2959   "aeabi"               // attributes_vendor
2960 };
2961
2962 // Arm relocate functions class
2963 //
2964
2965 template<bool big_endian>
2966 class Arm_relocate_functions : public Relocate_functions<32, big_endian>
2967 {
2968  public:
2969   typedef enum
2970   {
2971     STATUS_OKAY,        // No error during relocation.
2972     STATUS_OVERFLOW,    // Relocation overflow.
2973     STATUS_BAD_RELOC    // Relocation cannot be applied.
2974   } Status;
2975
2976  private:
2977   typedef Relocate_functions<32, big_endian> Base;
2978   typedef Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian> This;
2979
2980   // Encoding of imm16 argument for movt and movw ARM instructions
2981   // from ARM ARM:
2982   //     
2983   //     imm16 := imm4 | imm12
2984   //
2985   //  f e d c b a 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 f e d c b a 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 
2986   // +-------+---------------+-------+-------+-----------------------+
2987   // |       |               |imm4   |       |imm12                  |
2988   // +-------+---------------+-------+-------+-----------------------+
2989
2990   // Extract the relocation addend from VAL based on the ARM
2991   // instruction encoding described above.
2992   static inline typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype
2993   extract_arm_movw_movt_addend(
2994       typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype val)
2995   {
2996     // According to the Elf ABI for ARM Architecture the immediate
2997     // field is sign-extended to form the addend.
2998     return utils::sign_extend<16>(((val >> 4) & 0xf000) | (val & 0xfff));
2999   }
3000
3001   // Insert X into VAL based on the ARM instruction encoding described
3002   // above.
3003   static inline typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype
3004   insert_val_arm_movw_movt(
3005       typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype val,
3006       typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype x)
3007   {
3008     val &= 0xfff0f000;
3009     val |= x & 0x0fff;
3010     val |= (x & 0xf000) << 4;
3011     return val;
3012   }
3013
3014   // Encoding of imm16 argument for movt and movw Thumb2 instructions
3015   // from ARM ARM:
3016   //     
3017   //     imm16 := imm4 | i | imm3 | imm8
3018   //
3019   //  f e d c b a 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0  f e d c b a 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 
3020   // +---------+-+-----------+-------++-+-----+-------+---------------+
3021   // |         |i|           |imm4   || |imm3 |       |imm8           |
3022   // +---------+-+-----------+-------++-+-----+-------+---------------+
3023
3024   // Extract the relocation addend from VAL based on the Thumb2
3025   // instruction encoding described above.
3026   static inline typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype
3027   extract_thumb_movw_movt_addend(
3028       typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype val)
3029   {
3030     // According to the Elf ABI for ARM Architecture the immediate
3031     // field is sign-extended to form the addend.
3032     return utils::sign_extend<16>(((val >> 4) & 0xf000)
3033                                   | ((val >> 15) & 0x0800)
3034                                   | ((val >> 4) & 0x0700)
3035                                   | (val & 0x00ff));
3036   }
3037
3038   // Insert X into VAL based on the Thumb2 instruction encoding
3039   // described above.
3040   static inline typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype
3041   insert_val_thumb_movw_movt(
3042       typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype val,
3043       typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype x)
3044   {
3045     val &= 0xfbf08f00;
3046     val |= (x & 0xf000) << 4;
3047     val |= (x & 0x0800) << 15;
3048     val |= (x & 0x0700) << 4;
3049     val |= (x & 0x00ff);
3050     return val;
3051   }
3052
3053   // Calculate the smallest constant Kn for the specified residual.
3054   // (see (AAELF 4.6.1.4 Static ARM relocations, Group Relocations, p.32)
3055   static uint32_t
3056   calc_grp_kn(typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype residual)
3057   {
3058     int32_t msb;
3059
3060     if (residual == 0)
3061       return 0;
3062     // Determine the most significant bit in the residual and
3063     // align the resulting value to a 2-bit boundary.
3064     for (msb = 30; (msb >= 0) && !(residual & (3 << msb)); msb -= 2)
3065       ;
3066     // The desired shift is now (msb - 6), or zero, whichever
3067     // is the greater.
3068     return (((msb - 6) < 0) ? 0 : (msb - 6));
3069   }
3070
3071   // Calculate the final residual for the specified group index.
3072   // If the passed group index is less than zero, the method will return
3073   // the value of the specified residual without any change.
3074   // (see (AAELF 4.6.1.4 Static ARM relocations, Group Relocations, p.32)
3075   static typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype
3076   calc_grp_residual(typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype residual,
3077                     const int group)
3078   {
3079     for (int n = 0; n <= group; n++)
3080       {
3081         // Calculate which part of the value to mask.
3082         uint32_t shift = calc_grp_kn(residual);
3083         // Calculate the residual for the next time around.
3084         residual &= ~(residual & (0xff << shift));
3085       }
3086
3087     return residual;
3088   }
3089
3090   // Calculate the value of Gn for the specified group index.
3091   // We return it in the form of an encoded constant-and-rotation.
3092   // (see (AAELF 4.6.1.4 Static ARM relocations, Group Relocations, p.32)
3093   static typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype
3094   calc_grp_gn(typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype residual,
3095               const int group)
3096   {
3097     typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype gn = 0;
3098     uint32_t shift = 0;
3099
3100     for (int n = 0; n <= group; n++)
3101       {
3102         // Calculate which part of the value to mask.
3103         shift = calc_grp_kn(residual);
3104         // Calculate Gn in 32-bit as well as encoded constant-and-rotation form.
3105         gn = residual & (0xff << shift);
3106         // Calculate the residual for the next time around.
3107         residual &= ~gn;
3108       }
3109     // Return Gn in the form of an encoded constant-and-rotation.
3110     return ((gn >> shift) | ((gn <= 0xff ? 0 : (32 - shift) / 2) << 8));
3111   }
3112
3113  public:
3114   // Handle ARM long branches.
3115   static typename This::Status
3116   arm_branch_common(unsigned int, const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*,
3117                     unsigned char*, const Sized_symbol<32>*,
3118                     const Arm_relobj<big_endian>*, unsigned int,
3119                     const Symbol_value<32>*, Arm_address, Arm_address, bool);
3120
3121   // Handle THUMB long branches.
3122   static typename This::Status
3123   thumb_branch_common(unsigned int, const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>*,
3124                       unsigned char*, const Sized_symbol<32>*,
3125                       const Arm_relobj<big_endian>*, unsigned int,
3126                       const Symbol_value<32>*, Arm_address, Arm_address, bool);
3127
3128
3129   // Return the branch offset of a 32-bit THUMB branch.
3130   static inline int32_t
3131   thumb32_branch_offset(uint16_t upper_insn, uint16_t lower_insn)
3132   {
3133     // We use the Thumb-2 encoding (backwards compatible with Thumb-1)
3134     // involving the J1 and J2 bits.
3135     uint32_t s = (upper_insn & (1U << 10)) >> 10;
3136     uint32_t upper = upper_insn & 0x3ffU;
3137     uint32_t lower = lower_insn & 0x7ffU;
3138     uint32_t j1 = (lower_insn & (1U << 13)) >> 13;
3139     uint32_t j2 = (lower_insn & (1U << 11)) >> 11;
3140     uint32_t i1 = j1 ^ s ? 0 : 1;
3141     uint32_t i2 = j2 ^ s ? 0 : 1;
3142
3143     return utils::sign_extend<25>((s << 24) | (i1 << 23) | (i2 << 22)
3144                                   | (upper << 12) | (lower << 1));
3145   }
3146
3147   // Insert OFFSET to a 32-bit THUMB branch and return the upper instruction.
3148   // UPPER_INSN is the original upper instruction of the branch.  Caller is
3149   // responsible for overflow checking and BLX offset adjustment.
3150   static inline uint16_t
3151   thumb32_branch_upper(uint16_t upper_insn, int32_t offset)
3152   {
3153     uint32_t s = offset < 0 ? 1 : 0;
3154     uint32_t bits = static_cast<uint32_t>(offset);
3155     return (upper_insn & ~0x7ffU) | ((bits >> 12) & 0x3ffU) | (s << 10);
3156   }
3157
3158   // Insert OFFSET to a 32-bit THUMB branch and return the lower instruction.
3159   // LOWER_INSN is the original lower instruction of the branch.  Caller is
3160   // responsible for overflow checking and BLX offset adjustment.
3161   static inline uint16_t
3162   thumb32_branch_lower(uint16_t lower_insn, int32_t offset)
3163   {
3164     uint32_t s = offset < 0 ? 1 : 0;
3165     uint32_t bits = static_cast<uint32_t>(offset);
3166     return ((lower_insn & ~0x2fffU)
3167             | ((((bits >> 23) & 1) ^ !s) << 13)
3168             | ((((bits >> 22) & 1) ^ !s) << 11)
3169             | ((bits >> 1) & 0x7ffU));
3170   }
3171
3172   // Return the branch offset of a 32-bit THUMB conditional branch.
3173   static inline int32_t
3174   thumb32_cond_branch_offset(uint16_t upper_insn, uint16_t lower_insn)
3175   {
3176     uint32_t s = (upper_insn & 0x0400U) >> 10;
3177     uint32_t j1 = (lower_insn & 0x2000U) >> 13;
3178     uint32_t j2 = (lower_insn & 0x0800U) >> 11;
3179     uint32_t lower = (lower_insn & 0x07ffU);
3180     uint32_t upper = (s << 8) | (j2 << 7) | (j1 << 6) | (upper_insn & 0x003fU);
3181
3182     return utils::sign_extend<21>((upper << 12) | (lower << 1));
3183   }
3184
3185   // Insert OFFSET to a 32-bit THUMB conditional branch and return the upper
3186   // instruction.  UPPER_INSN is the original upper instruction of the branch.
3187   // Caller is responsible for overflow checking.
3188   static inline uint16_t
3189   thumb32_cond_branch_upper(uint16_t upper_insn, int32_t offset)
3190   {
3191     uint32_t s = offset < 0 ? 1 : 0;
3192     uint32_t bits = static_cast<uint32_t>(offset);
3193     return (upper_insn & 0xfbc0U) | (s << 10) | ((bits & 0x0003f000U) >> 12);
3194   }
3195
3196   // Insert OFFSET to a 32-bit THUMB conditional branch and return the lower
3197   // instruction.  LOWER_INSN is the original lower instruction of the branch.
3198   // The caller is responsible for overflow checking.
3199   static inline uint16_t
3200   thumb32_cond_branch_lower(uint16_t lower_insn, int32_t offset)
3201   {
3202     uint32_t bits = static_cast<uint32_t>(offset);
3203     uint32_t j2 = (bits & 0x00080000U) >> 19;
3204     uint32_t j1 = (bits & 0x00040000U) >> 18;
3205     uint32_t lo = (bits & 0x00000ffeU) >> 1;
3206
3207     return (lower_insn & 0xd000U) | (j1 << 13) | (j2 << 11) | lo;
3208   }
3209
3210   // R_ARM_ABS8: S + A
3211   static inline typename This::Status
3212   abs8(unsigned char* view,
3213        const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3214        const Symbol_value<32>* psymval)
3215   {
3216     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<8, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3217     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3218     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3219     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<8, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3220     Reltype addend = utils::sign_extend<8>(val);
3221     Reltype x = psymval->value(object, addend);
3222     val = utils::bit_select(val, x, 0xffU);
3223     elfcpp::Swap<8, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3224
3225     // R_ARM_ABS8 permits signed or unsigned results.
3226     int signed_x = static_cast<int32_t>(x);
3227     return ((signed_x < -128 || signed_x > 255)
3228             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
3229             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3230   }
3231
3232   // R_ARM_THM_ABS5: S + A
3233   static inline typename This::Status
3234   thm_abs5(unsigned char* view,
3235        const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3236        const Symbol_value<32>* psymval)
3237   {
3238     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3239     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3240     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3241     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3242     Reltype addend = (val & 0x7e0U) >> 6;
3243     Reltype x = psymval->value(object, addend);
3244     val = utils::bit_select(val, x << 6, 0x7e0U);
3245     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3246
3247     // R_ARM_ABS16 permits signed or unsigned results.
3248     int signed_x = static_cast<int32_t>(x);
3249     return ((signed_x < -32768 || signed_x > 65535)
3250             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
3251             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3252   }
3253
3254   // R_ARM_ABS12: S + A
3255   static inline typename This::Status
3256   abs12(unsigned char* view,
3257         const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3258         const Symbol_value<32>* psymval)
3259   {
3260     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3261     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3262     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3263     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3264     Reltype addend = val & 0x0fffU;
3265     Reltype x = psymval->value(object, addend);
3266     val = utils::bit_select(val, x, 0x0fffU);
3267     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3268     return (utils::has_overflow<12>(x)
3269             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
3270             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3271   }
3272
3273   // R_ARM_ABS16: S + A
3274   static inline typename This::Status
3275   abs16(unsigned char* view,
3276         const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3277         const Symbol_value<32>* psymval)
3278   {
3279     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3280     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3281     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3282     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3283     Reltype addend = utils::sign_extend<16>(val);
3284     Reltype x = psymval->value(object, addend);
3285     val = utils::bit_select(val, x, 0xffffU);
3286     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3287     return (utils::has_signed_unsigned_overflow<16>(x)
3288             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
3289             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3290   }
3291
3292   // R_ARM_ABS32: (S + A) | T
3293   static inline typename This::Status
3294   abs32(unsigned char* view,
3295         const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3296         const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3297         Arm_address thumb_bit)
3298   {
3299     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3300     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3301     Valtype addend = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3302     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend) | thumb_bit;
3303     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
3304     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3305   }
3306
3307   // R_ARM_REL32: (S + A) | T - P
3308   static inline typename This::Status
3309   rel32(unsigned char* view,
3310         const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3311         const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3312         Arm_address address,
3313         Arm_address thumb_bit)
3314   {
3315     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3316     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3317     Valtype addend = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3318     Valtype x = (psymval->value(object, addend) | thumb_bit) - address;
3319     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
3320     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3321   }
3322
3323   // R_ARM_THM_JUMP24: (S + A) | T - P
3324   static typename This::Status
3325   thm_jump19(unsigned char* view, const Arm_relobj<big_endian>* object,
3326              const Symbol_value<32>* psymval, Arm_address address,
3327              Arm_address thumb_bit);
3328
3329   // R_ARM_THM_JUMP6: S + A â€“ P
3330   static inline typename This::Status
3331   thm_jump6(unsigned char* view,
3332             const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3333             const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3334             Arm_address address)
3335   {
3336     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3337     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3338     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3339     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3340     // bit[9]:bit[7:3]:’0’ (mask: 0x02f8)
3341     Reltype addend = (((val & 0x0200) >> 3) | ((val & 0x00f8) >> 2));
3342     Reltype x = (psymval->value(object, addend) - address);
3343     val = (val & 0xfd07) | ((x  & 0x0040) << 3) | ((val & 0x003e) << 2);
3344     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3345     // CZB does only forward jumps.
3346     return ((x > 0x007e)
3347             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
3348             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3349   }
3350
3351   // R_ARM_THM_JUMP8: S + A â€“ P
3352   static inline typename This::Status
3353   thm_jump8(unsigned char* view,
3354             const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3355             const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3356             Arm_address address)
3357   {
3358     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3359     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3360     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3361     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3362     Reltype addend = utils::sign_extend<8>((val & 0x00ff) << 1);
3363     Reltype x = (psymval->value(object, addend) - address);
3364     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, (val & 0xff00) | ((x & 0x01fe) >> 1));
3365     return (utils::has_overflow<8>(x)
3366             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
3367             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3368   }
3369
3370   // R_ARM_THM_JUMP11: S + A â€“ P
3371   static inline typename This::Status
3372   thm_jump11(unsigned char* view,
3373             const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3374             const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3375             Arm_address address)
3376   {
3377     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3378     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3379     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3380     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3381     Reltype addend = utils::sign_extend<11>((val & 0x07ff) << 1);
3382     Reltype x = (psymval->value(object, addend) - address);
3383     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, (val & 0xf800) | ((x & 0x0ffe) >> 1));
3384     return (utils::has_overflow<11>(x)
3385             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
3386             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3387   }
3388
3389   // R_ARM_BASE_PREL: B(S) + A - P
3390   static inline typename This::Status
3391   base_prel(unsigned char* view,
3392             Arm_address origin,
3393             Arm_address address)
3394   {
3395     Base::rel32(view, origin - address);
3396     return STATUS_OKAY;
3397   }
3398
3399   // R_ARM_BASE_ABS: B(S) + A
3400   static inline typename This::Status
3401   base_abs(unsigned char* view,
3402            Arm_address origin)
3403   {
3404     Base::rel32(view, origin);
3405     return STATUS_OKAY;
3406   }
3407
3408   // R_ARM_GOT_BREL: GOT(S) + A - GOT_ORG
3409   static inline typename This::Status
3410   got_brel(unsigned char* view,
3411            typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype got_offset)
3412   {
3413     Base::rel32(view, got_offset);
3414     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3415   }
3416
3417   // R_ARM_GOT_PREL: GOT(S) + A - P
3418   static inline typename This::Status
3419   got_prel(unsigned char* view,
3420            Arm_address got_entry,
3421            Arm_address address)
3422   {
3423     Base::rel32(view, got_entry - address);
3424     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3425   }
3426
3427   // R_ARM_PREL: (S + A) | T - P
3428   static inline typename This::Status
3429   prel31(unsigned char* view,
3430          const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3431          const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3432          Arm_address address,
3433          Arm_address thumb_bit)
3434   {
3435     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3436     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3437     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3438     Valtype addend = utils::sign_extend<31>(val);
3439     Valtype x = (psymval->value(object, addend) | thumb_bit) - address;
3440     val = utils::bit_select(val, x, 0x7fffffffU);
3441     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3442     return (utils::has_overflow<31>(x) ?
3443             This::STATUS_OVERFLOW : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3444   }
3445
3446   // R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC: (S + A) | T     (relative address base is )
3447   // R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC: (S + A) | T - P
3448   // R_ARM_MOVW_BREL_NC: ((S + A) | T) - B(S)
3449   // R_ARM_MOVW_BREL: ((S + A) | T) - B(S)
3450   static inline typename This::Status
3451   movw(unsigned char* view,
3452        const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3453        const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3454        Arm_address relative_address_base,
3455        Arm_address thumb_bit,
3456        bool check_overflow)
3457   {
3458     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3459     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3460     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3461     Valtype addend = This::extract_arm_movw_movt_addend(val);
3462     Valtype x = ((psymval->value(object, addend) | thumb_bit)
3463                  - relative_address_base);
3464     val = This::insert_val_arm_movw_movt(val, x);
3465     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3466     return ((check_overflow && utils::has_overflow<16>(x))
3467             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
3468             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3469   }
3470
3471   // R_ARM_MOVT_ABS: S + A      (relative address base is 0)
3472   // R_ARM_MOVT_PREL: S + A - P
3473   // R_ARM_MOVT_BREL: S + A - B(S)
3474   static inline typename This::Status
3475   movt(unsigned char* view,
3476        const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3477        const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3478        Arm_address relative_address_base)
3479   {
3480     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3481     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3482     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3483     Valtype addend = This::extract_arm_movw_movt_addend(val);
3484     Valtype x = (psymval->value(object, addend) - relative_address_base) >> 16;
3485     val = This::insert_val_arm_movw_movt(val, x);
3486     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3487     // FIXME: IHI0044D says that we should check for overflow.
3488     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3489   }
3490
3491   // R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC: S + A | T           (relative_address_base is 0)
3492   // R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC: (S + A) | T - P
3493   // R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL_NC: ((S + A) | T) - B(S)
3494   // R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL: ((S + A) | T) - B(S)
3495   static inline typename This::Status
3496   thm_movw(unsigned char* view,
3497            const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3498            const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3499            Arm_address relative_address_base,
3500            Arm_address thumb_bit,
3501            bool check_overflow)
3502   {
3503     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3504     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3505     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3506     Reltype val = (elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv) << 16)
3507                   | elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv + 1);
3508     Reltype addend = This::extract_thumb_movw_movt_addend(val);
3509     Reltype x =
3510       (psymval->value(object, addend) | thumb_bit) - relative_address_base;
3511     val = This::insert_val_thumb_movw_movt(val, x);
3512     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val >> 16);
3513     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv + 1, val & 0xffff);
3514     return ((check_overflow && utils::has_overflow<16>(x))
3515             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
3516             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3517   }
3518
3519   // R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS: S + A          (relative address base is 0)
3520   // R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL: S + A - P
3521   // R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL: S + A - B(S)
3522   static inline typename This::Status
3523   thm_movt(unsigned char* view,
3524            const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3525            const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3526            Arm_address relative_address_base)
3527   {
3528     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3529     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3530     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3531     Reltype val = (elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv) << 16)
3532                   | elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv + 1);
3533     Reltype addend = This::extract_thumb_movw_movt_addend(val);
3534     Reltype x = (psymval->value(object, addend) - relative_address_base) >> 16;
3535     val = This::insert_val_thumb_movw_movt(val, x);
3536     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val >> 16);
3537     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv + 1, val & 0xffff);
3538     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3539   }
3540
3541   // R_ARM_THM_ALU_PREL_11_0: ((S + A) | T) - Pa (Thumb32)
3542   static inline typename This::Status
3543   thm_alu11(unsigned char* view,
3544             const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3545             const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3546             Arm_address address,
3547             Arm_address thumb_bit)
3548   {
3549     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3550     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3551     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3552     Reltype insn = (elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv) << 16)
3553                    | elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv + 1);
3554
3555     //        f e d c b|a|9|8 7 6 5|4|3 2 1 0||f|e d c|b a 9 8|7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
3556     // -----------------------------------------------------------------------
3557     // ADD{S} 1 1 1 1 0|i|0|1 0 0 0|S|1 1 0 1||0|imm3 |Rd     |imm8
3558     // ADDW   1 1 1 1 0|i|1|0 0 0 0|0|1 1 0 1||0|imm3 |Rd     |imm8
3559     // ADR[+] 1 1 1 1 0|i|1|0 0 0 0|0|1 1 1 1||0|imm3 |Rd     |imm8
3560     // SUB{S} 1 1 1 1 0|i|0|1 1 0 1|S|1 1 0 1||0|imm3 |Rd     |imm8
3561     // SUBW   1 1 1 1 0|i|1|0 1 0 1|0|1 1 0 1||0|imm3 |Rd     |imm8
3562     // ADR[-] 1 1 1 1 0|i|1|0 1 0 1|0|1 1 1 1||0|imm3 |Rd     |imm8
3563
3564     // Determine a sign for the addend.
3565     const int sign = ((insn & 0xf8ef0000) == 0xf0ad0000
3566                       || (insn & 0xf8ef0000) == 0xf0af0000) ? -1 : 1;
3567     // Thumb2 addend encoding:
3568     // imm12 := i | imm3 | imm8
3569     int32_t addend = (insn & 0xff)
3570                      | ((insn & 0x00007000) >> 4)
3571                      | ((insn & 0x04000000) >> 15);
3572     // Apply a sign to the added.
3573     addend *= sign;
3574
3575     int32_t x = (psymval->value(object, addend) | thumb_bit)
3576                 - (address & 0xfffffffc);
3577     Reltype val = abs(x);
3578     // Mask out the value and a distinct part of the ADD/SUB opcode
3579     // (bits 7:5 of opword).
3580     insn = (insn & 0xfb0f8f00)
3581            | (val & 0xff)
3582            | ((val & 0x700) << 4)
3583            | ((val & 0x800) << 15);
3584     // Set the opcode according to whether the value to go in the
3585     // place is negative.
3586     if (x < 0)
3587       insn |= 0x00a00000;
3588
3589     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, insn >> 16);
3590     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv + 1, insn & 0xffff);
3591     return ((val > 0xfff) ?
3592             This::STATUS_OVERFLOW : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3593   }
3594
3595   // R_ARM_THM_PC8: S + A - Pa (Thumb)
3596   static inline typename This::Status
3597   thm_pc8(unsigned char* view,
3598           const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3599           const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3600           Arm_address address)
3601   {
3602     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3603     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3604     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3605     Valtype insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3606     Reltype addend = ((insn & 0x00ff) << 2);
3607     int32_t x = (psymval->value(object, addend) - (address & 0xfffffffc));
3608     Reltype val = abs(x);
3609     insn = (insn & 0xff00) | ((val & 0x03fc) >> 2);
3610
3611     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, insn);
3612     return ((val > 0x03fc)
3613             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
3614             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3615   }
3616
3617   // R_ARM_THM_PC12: S + A - Pa (Thumb32)
3618   static inline typename This::Status
3619   thm_pc12(unsigned char* view,
3620            const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3621            const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3622            Arm_address address)
3623   {
3624     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3625     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Reltype;
3626     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3627     Reltype insn = (elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv) << 16)
3628                    | elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv + 1);
3629     // Determine a sign for the addend (positive if the U bit is 1).
3630     const int sign = (insn & 0x00800000) ? 1 : -1;
3631     int32_t addend = (insn & 0xfff);
3632     // Apply a sign to the added.
3633     addend *= sign;
3634
3635     int32_t x = (psymval->value(object, addend) - (address & 0xfffffffc));
3636     Reltype val = abs(x);
3637     // Mask out and apply the value and the U bit.
3638     insn = (insn & 0xff7ff000) | (val & 0xfff);
3639     // Set the U bit according to whether the value to go in the
3640     // place is positive.
3641     if (x >= 0)
3642       insn |= 0x00800000;
3643
3644     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, insn >> 16);
3645     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv + 1, insn & 0xffff);
3646     return ((val > 0xfff) ?
3647             This::STATUS_OVERFLOW : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3648   }
3649
3650   // R_ARM_V4BX
3651   static inline typename This::Status
3652   v4bx(const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
3653        unsigned char* view,
3654        const Arm_relobj<big_endian>* object,
3655        const Arm_address address,
3656        const bool is_interworking)
3657   {
3658
3659     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3660     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3661     Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3662
3663     // Ensure that we have a BX instruction.
3664     gold_assert((val & 0x0ffffff0) == 0x012fff10);
3665     const uint32_t reg = (val & 0xf);
3666     if (is_interworking && reg != 0xf)
3667       {
3668         Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table =
3669             object->stub_table(relinfo->data_shndx);
3670         gold_assert(stub_table != NULL);
3671
3672         Arm_v4bx_stub* stub = stub_table->find_arm_v4bx_stub(reg);
3673         gold_assert(stub != NULL);
3674
3675         int32_t veneer_address =
3676             stub_table->address() + stub->offset() - 8 - address;
3677         gold_assert((veneer_address <= ARM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET)
3678                     && (veneer_address >= ARM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET));
3679         // Replace with a branch to veneer (B <addr>)
3680         val = (val & 0xf0000000) | 0x0a000000
3681               | ((veneer_address >> 2) & 0x00ffffff);
3682       }
3683     else
3684       {
3685         // Preserve Rm (lowest four bits) and the condition code
3686         // (highest four bits). Other bits encode MOV PC,Rm.
3687         val = (val & 0xf000000f) | 0x01a0f000;
3688       }
3689     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3690     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3691   }
3692
3693   // R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC: ((S + A) | T) - P
3694   // R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0:    ((S + A) | T) - P
3695   // R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC: ((S + A) | T) - P
3696   // R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1:    ((S + A) | T) - P
3697   // R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2:    ((S + A) | T) - P
3698   // R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC: ((S + A) | T) - B(S)
3699   // R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0:    ((S + A) | T) - B(S)
3700   // R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC: ((S + A) | T) - B(S)
3701   // R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1:    ((S + A) | T) - B(S)
3702   // R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2:    ((S + A) | T) - B(S)
3703   static inline typename This::Status
3704   arm_grp_alu(unsigned char* view,
3705         const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3706         const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3707         const int group,
3708         Arm_address address,
3709         Arm_address thumb_bit,
3710         bool check_overflow)
3711   {
3712     gold_assert(group >= 0 && group < 3);
3713     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3714     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3715     Valtype insn = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3716
3717     // ALU group relocations are allowed only for the ADD/SUB instructions.
3718     // (0x00800000 - ADD, 0x00400000 - SUB)
3719     const Valtype opcode = insn & 0x01e00000;
3720     if (opcode != 0x00800000 && opcode != 0x00400000)
3721       return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
3722
3723     // Determine a sign for the addend.
3724     const int sign = (opcode == 0x00800000) ? 1 : -1;
3725     // shifter = rotate_imm * 2
3726     const uint32_t shifter = (insn & 0xf00) >> 7;
3727     // Initial addend value.
3728     int32_t addend = insn & 0xff;
3729     // Rotate addend right by shifter.
3730     addend = (addend >> shifter) | (addend << (32 - shifter));
3731     // Apply a sign to the added.
3732     addend *= sign;
3733
3734     int32_t x = ((psymval->value(object, addend) | thumb_bit) - address);
3735     Valtype gn = Arm_relocate_functions::calc_grp_gn(abs(x), group);
3736     // Check for overflow if required
3737     if (check_overflow
3738         && (Arm_relocate_functions::calc_grp_residual(abs(x), group) != 0))
3739       return This::STATUS_OVERFLOW;
3740
3741     // Mask out the value and the ADD/SUB part of the opcode; take care
3742     // not to destroy the S bit.
3743     insn &= 0xff1ff000;
3744     // Set the opcode according to whether the value to go in the
3745     // place is negative.
3746     insn |= ((x < 0) ? 0x00400000 : 0x00800000);
3747     // Encode the offset (encoded Gn).
3748     insn |= gn;
3749
3750     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, insn);
3751     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3752   }
3753
3754   // R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0: S + A - P
3755   // R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1: S + A - P
3756   // R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2: S + A - P
3757   // R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0: S + A - B(S)
3758   // R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1: S + A - B(S)
3759   // R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2: S + A - B(S)
3760   static inline typename This::Status
3761   arm_grp_ldr(unsigned char* view,
3762         const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3763         const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3764         const int group,
3765         Arm_address address)
3766   {
3767     gold_assert(group >= 0 && group < 3);
3768     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3769     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3770     Valtype insn = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3771
3772     const int sign = (insn & 0x00800000) ? 1 : -1;
3773     int32_t addend = (insn & 0xfff) * sign;
3774     int32_t x = (psymval->value(object, addend) - address);
3775     // Calculate the relevant G(n-1) value to obtain this stage residual.
3776     Valtype residual =
3777         Arm_relocate_functions::calc_grp_residual(abs(x), group - 1);
3778     if (residual >= 0x1000)
3779       return This::STATUS_OVERFLOW;
3780
3781     // Mask out the value and U bit.
3782     insn &= 0xff7ff000;
3783     // Set the U bit for non-negative values.
3784     if (x >= 0)
3785       insn |= 0x00800000;
3786     insn |= residual;
3787
3788     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, insn);
3789     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3790   }
3791
3792   // R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0: S + A - P
3793   // R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1: S + A - P
3794   // R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2: S + A - P
3795   // R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0: S + A - B(S)
3796   // R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1: S + A - B(S)
3797   // R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2: S + A - B(S)
3798   static inline typename This::Status
3799   arm_grp_ldrs(unsigned char* view,
3800         const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3801         const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3802         const int group,
3803         Arm_address address)
3804   {
3805     gold_assert(group >= 0 && group < 3);
3806     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3807     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3808     Valtype insn = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3809
3810     const int sign = (insn & 0x00800000) ? 1 : -1;
3811     int32_t addend = (((insn & 0xf00) >> 4) + (insn & 0xf)) * sign;
3812     int32_t x = (psymval->value(object, addend) - address);
3813     // Calculate the relevant G(n-1) value to obtain this stage residual.
3814     Valtype residual =
3815         Arm_relocate_functions::calc_grp_residual(abs(x), group - 1);
3816    if (residual >= 0x100)
3817       return This::STATUS_OVERFLOW;
3818
3819     // Mask out the value and U bit.
3820     insn &= 0xff7ff0f0;
3821     // Set the U bit for non-negative values.
3822     if (x >= 0)
3823       insn |= 0x00800000;
3824     insn |= ((residual & 0xf0) << 4) | (residual & 0xf);
3825
3826     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, insn);
3827     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3828   }
3829
3830   // R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0: S + A - P
3831   // R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1: S + A - P
3832   // R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2: S + A - P
3833   // R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0: S + A - B(S)
3834   // R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1: S + A - B(S)
3835   // R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2: S + A - B(S)
3836   static inline typename This::Status
3837   arm_grp_ldc(unsigned char* view,
3838       const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
3839       const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3840       const int group,
3841       Arm_address address)
3842   {
3843     gold_assert(group >= 0 && group < 3);
3844     typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3845     Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3846     Valtype insn = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3847
3848     const int sign = (insn & 0x00800000) ? 1 : -1;
3849     int32_t addend = ((insn & 0xff) << 2) * sign;
3850     int32_t x = (psymval->value(object, addend) - address);
3851     // Calculate the relevant G(n-1) value to obtain this stage residual.
3852     Valtype residual =
3853       Arm_relocate_functions::calc_grp_residual(abs(x), group - 1);
3854     if ((residual & 0x3) != 0 || residual >= 0x400)
3855       return This::STATUS_OVERFLOW;
3856
3857     // Mask out the value and U bit.
3858     insn &= 0xff7fff00;
3859     // Set the U bit for non-negative values.
3860     if (x >= 0)
3861       insn |= 0x00800000;
3862     insn |= (residual >> 2);
3863
3864     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, insn);
3865     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3866   }
3867 };
3868
3869 // Relocate ARM long branches.  This handles relocation types
3870 // R_ARM_CALL, R_ARM_JUMP24, R_ARM_PLT32 and R_ARM_XPC25.
3871 // If IS_WEAK_UNDEFINED_WITH_PLT is true.  The target symbol is weakly
3872 // undefined and we do not use PLT in this relocation.  In such a case,
3873 // the branch is converted into an NOP.
3874
3875 template<bool big_endian>
3876 typename Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::Status
3877 Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::arm_branch_common(
3878     unsigned int r_type,
3879     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
3880     unsigned char* view,
3881     const Sized_symbol<32>* gsym,
3882     const Arm_relobj<big_endian>* object,
3883     unsigned int r_sym,
3884     const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
3885     Arm_address address,
3886     Arm_address thumb_bit,
3887     bool is_weakly_undefined_without_plt)
3888 {
3889   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3890   Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
3891   Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
3892      
3893   bool insn_is_b = (((val >> 28) & 0xf) <= 0xe)
3894                     && ((val & 0x0f000000UL) == 0x0a000000UL);
3895   bool insn_is_uncond_bl = (val & 0xff000000UL) == 0xeb000000UL;
3896   bool insn_is_cond_bl = (((val >> 28) & 0xf) < 0xe)
3897                           && ((val & 0x0f000000UL) == 0x0b000000UL);
3898   bool insn_is_blx = (val & 0xfe000000UL) == 0xfa000000UL;
3899   bool insn_is_any_branch = (val & 0x0e000000UL) == 0x0a000000UL;
3900
3901   // Check that the instruction is valid.
3902   if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL)
3903     {
3904       if (!insn_is_uncond_bl && !insn_is_blx)
3905         return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
3906     }
3907   else if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24)
3908     {
3909       if (!insn_is_b && !insn_is_cond_bl)
3910         return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
3911     }
3912   else if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32)
3913     {
3914       if (!insn_is_any_branch)
3915         return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
3916     }
3917   else if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_XPC25)
3918     {
3919       // FIXME: AAELF document IH0044C does not say much about it other
3920       // than it being obsolete.
3921       if (!insn_is_any_branch)
3922         return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
3923     }
3924   else
3925     gold_unreachable();
3926
3927   // A branch to an undefined weak symbol is turned into a jump to
3928   // the next instruction unless a PLT entry will be created.
3929   // Do the same for local undefined symbols.
3930   // The jump to the next instruction is optimized as a NOP depending
3931   // on the architecture.
3932   const Target_arm<big_endian>* arm_target =
3933     Target_arm<big_endian>::default_target();
3934   if (is_weakly_undefined_without_plt)
3935     {
3936       gold_assert(!parameters->options().relocatable());
3937       Valtype cond = val & 0xf0000000U;
3938       if (arm_target->may_use_arm_nop())
3939         val = cond | 0x0320f000;
3940       else
3941         val = cond | 0x01a00000;        // Using pre-UAL nop: mov r0, r0.
3942       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3943       return This::STATUS_OKAY;
3944     }
3945  
3946   Valtype addend = utils::sign_extend<26>(val << 2);
3947   Valtype branch_target = psymval->value(object, addend);
3948   int32_t branch_offset = branch_target - address;
3949
3950   // We need a stub if the branch offset is too large or if we need
3951   // to switch mode.
3952   bool may_use_blx = arm_target->may_use_blx();
3953   Reloc_stub* stub = NULL;
3954
3955   if (!parameters->options().relocatable()
3956       && (utils::has_overflow<26>(branch_offset)
3957           || ((thumb_bit != 0)
3958               && !(may_use_blx && r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL))))
3959     {
3960       Valtype unadjusted_branch_target = psymval->value(object, 0);
3961
3962       Stub_type stub_type =
3963         Reloc_stub::stub_type_for_reloc(r_type, address,
3964                                         unadjusted_branch_target,
3965                                         (thumb_bit != 0));
3966       if (stub_type != arm_stub_none)
3967         {
3968           Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table =
3969             object->stub_table(relinfo->data_shndx);
3970           gold_assert(stub_table != NULL);
3971
3972           Reloc_stub::Key stub_key(stub_type, gsym, object, r_sym, addend);
3973           stub = stub_table->find_reloc_stub(stub_key);
3974           gold_assert(stub != NULL);
3975           thumb_bit = stub->stub_template()->entry_in_thumb_mode() ? 1 : 0;
3976           branch_target = stub_table->address() + stub->offset() + addend;
3977           branch_offset = branch_target - address;
3978           gold_assert(!utils::has_overflow<26>(branch_offset));
3979         }
3980     }
3981
3982   // At this point, if we still need to switch mode, the instruction
3983   // must either be a BLX or a BL that can be converted to a BLX.
3984   if (thumb_bit != 0)
3985     {
3986       // Turn BL to BLX.
3987       gold_assert(may_use_blx && r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL);
3988       val = (val & 0xffffff) | 0xfa000000 | ((branch_offset & 2) << 23);
3989     }
3990
3991   val = utils::bit_select(val, (branch_offset >> 2), 0xffffffUL);
3992   elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
3993   return (utils::has_overflow<26>(branch_offset)
3994           ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW : This::STATUS_OKAY);
3995 }
3996
3997 // Relocate THUMB long branches.  This handles relocation types
3998 // R_ARM_THM_CALL, R_ARM_THM_JUMP24 and R_ARM_THM_XPC22.
3999 // If IS_WEAK_UNDEFINED_WITH_PLT is true.  The target symbol is weakly
4000 // undefined and we do not use PLT in this relocation.  In such a case,
4001 // the branch is converted into an NOP.
4002
4003 template<bool big_endian>
4004 typename Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::Status
4005 Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thumb_branch_common(
4006     unsigned int r_type,
4007     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
4008     unsigned char* view,
4009     const Sized_symbol<32>* gsym,
4010     const Arm_relobj<big_endian>* object,
4011     unsigned int r_sym,
4012     const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
4013     Arm_address address,
4014     Arm_address thumb_bit,
4015     bool is_weakly_undefined_without_plt)
4016 {
4017   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
4018   Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
4019   uint32_t upper_insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4020   uint32_t lower_insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv + 1);
4021
4022   // FIXME: These tests are too loose and do not take THUMB/THUMB-2 difference
4023   // into account.
4024   bool is_bl_insn = (lower_insn & 0x1000U) == 0x1000U;
4025   bool is_blx_insn = (lower_insn & 0x1000U) == 0x0000U;
4026      
4027   // Check that the instruction is valid.
4028   if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL)
4029     {
4030       if (!is_bl_insn && !is_blx_insn)
4031         return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
4032     }
4033   else if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24)
4034     {
4035       // This cannot be a BLX.
4036       if (!is_bl_insn)
4037         return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
4038     }
4039   else if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_XPC22)
4040     {
4041       // Check for Thumb to Thumb call.
4042       if (!is_blx_insn)
4043         return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
4044       if (thumb_bit != 0)
4045         {
4046           gold_warning(_("%s: Thumb BLX instruction targets "
4047                          "thumb function '%s'."),
4048                          object->name().c_str(),
4049                          (gsym ? gsym->name() : "(local)")); 
4050           // Convert BLX to BL.
4051           lower_insn |= 0x1000U;
4052         }
4053     }
4054   else
4055     gold_unreachable();
4056
4057   // A branch to an undefined weak symbol is turned into a jump to
4058   // the next instruction unless a PLT entry will be created.
4059   // The jump to the next instruction is optimized as a NOP.W for
4060   // Thumb-2 enabled architectures.
4061   const Target_arm<big_endian>* arm_target =
4062     Target_arm<big_endian>::default_target();
4063   if (is_weakly_undefined_without_plt)
4064     {
4065       gold_assert(!parameters->options().relocatable());
4066       if (arm_target->may_use_thumb2_nop())
4067         {
4068           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, 0xf3af);
4069           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv + 1, 0x8000);
4070         }
4071       else
4072         {
4073           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, 0xe000);
4074           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv + 1, 0xbf00);
4075         }
4076       return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4077     }
4078  
4079   int32_t addend = This::thumb32_branch_offset(upper_insn, lower_insn);
4080   Arm_address branch_target = psymval->value(object, addend);
4081
4082   // For BLX, bit 1 of target address comes from bit 1 of base address.
4083   bool may_use_blx = arm_target->may_use_blx();
4084   if (thumb_bit == 0 && may_use_blx)
4085     branch_target = utils::bit_select(branch_target, address, 0x2);
4086
4087   int32_t branch_offset = branch_target - address;
4088
4089   // We need a stub if the branch offset is too large or if we need
4090   // to switch mode.
4091   bool thumb2 = arm_target->using_thumb2();
4092   if (!parameters->options().relocatable()
4093       && ((!thumb2 && utils::has_overflow<23>(branch_offset))
4094           || (thumb2 && utils::has_overflow<25>(branch_offset))
4095           || ((thumb_bit == 0)
4096               && (((r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL) && !may_use_blx)
4097                   || r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24))))
4098     {
4099       Arm_address unadjusted_branch_target = psymval->value(object, 0);
4100
4101       Stub_type stub_type =
4102         Reloc_stub::stub_type_for_reloc(r_type, address,
4103                                         unadjusted_branch_target,
4104                                         (thumb_bit != 0));
4105
4106       if (stub_type != arm_stub_none)
4107         {
4108           Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table =
4109             object->stub_table(relinfo->data_shndx);
4110           gold_assert(stub_table != NULL);
4111
4112           Reloc_stub::Key stub_key(stub_type, gsym, object, r_sym, addend);
4113           Reloc_stub* stub = stub_table->find_reloc_stub(stub_key);
4114           gold_assert(stub != NULL);
4115           thumb_bit = stub->stub_template()->entry_in_thumb_mode() ? 1 : 0;
4116           branch_target = stub_table->address() + stub->offset() + addend;
4117           if (thumb_bit == 0 && may_use_blx) 
4118             branch_target = utils::bit_select(branch_target, address, 0x2);
4119           branch_offset = branch_target - address;
4120         }
4121     }
4122
4123   // At this point, if we still need to switch mode, the instruction
4124   // must either be a BLX or a BL that can be converted to a BLX.
4125   if (thumb_bit == 0)
4126     {
4127       gold_assert(may_use_blx
4128                   && (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL
4129                       || r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_XPC22));
4130       // Make sure this is a BLX.
4131       lower_insn &= ~0x1000U;
4132     }
4133   else
4134     {
4135       // Make sure this is a BL.
4136       lower_insn |= 0x1000U;
4137     }
4138
4139   // For a BLX instruction, make sure that the relocation is rounded up
4140   // to a word boundary.  This follows the semantics of the instruction
4141   // which specifies that bit 1 of the target address will come from bit
4142   // 1 of the base address.
4143   if ((lower_insn & 0x5000U) == 0x4000U)
4144     gold_assert((branch_offset & 3) == 0);
4145
4146   // Put BRANCH_OFFSET back into the insn.  Assumes two's complement.
4147   // We use the Thumb-2 encoding, which is safe even if dealing with
4148   // a Thumb-1 instruction by virtue of our overflow check above.  */
4149   upper_insn = This::thumb32_branch_upper(upper_insn, branch_offset);
4150   lower_insn = This::thumb32_branch_lower(lower_insn, branch_offset);
4151
4152   elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, upper_insn);
4153   elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv + 1, lower_insn);
4154
4155   gold_assert(!utils::has_overflow<25>(branch_offset));
4156
4157   return ((thumb2
4158            ? utils::has_overflow<25>(branch_offset)
4159            : utils::has_overflow<23>(branch_offset))
4160           ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
4161           : This::STATUS_OKAY);
4162 }
4163
4164 // Relocate THUMB-2 long conditional branches.
4165 // If IS_WEAK_UNDEFINED_WITH_PLT is true.  The target symbol is weakly
4166 // undefined and we do not use PLT in this relocation.  In such a case,
4167 // the branch is converted into an NOP.
4168
4169 template<bool big_endian>
4170 typename Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::Status
4171 Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thm_jump19(
4172     unsigned char* view,
4173     const Arm_relobj<big_endian>* object,
4174     const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
4175     Arm_address address,
4176     Arm_address thumb_bit)
4177 {
4178   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
4179   Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(view);
4180   uint32_t upper_insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4181   uint32_t lower_insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv + 1);
4182   int32_t addend = This::thumb32_cond_branch_offset(upper_insn, lower_insn);
4183
4184   Arm_address branch_target = psymval->value(object, addend);
4185   int32_t branch_offset = branch_target - address;
4186
4187   // ??? Should handle interworking?  GCC might someday try to
4188   // use this for tail calls.
4189   // FIXME: We do support thumb entry to PLT yet.
4190   if (thumb_bit == 0)
4191     {
4192       gold_error(_("conditional branch to PLT in THUMB-2 not supported yet."));
4193       return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
4194     }
4195
4196   // Put RELOCATION back into the insn.
4197   upper_insn = This::thumb32_cond_branch_upper(upper_insn, branch_offset);
4198   lower_insn = This::thumb32_cond_branch_lower(lower_insn, branch_offset);
4199
4200   // Put the relocated value back in the object file:
4201   elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, upper_insn);
4202   elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv + 1, lower_insn);
4203
4204   return (utils::has_overflow<21>(branch_offset)
4205           ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
4206           : This::STATUS_OKAY);
4207 }
4208
4209 // Get the GOT section, creating it if necessary.
4210
4211 template<bool big_endian>
4212 Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>*
4213 Target_arm<big_endian>::got_section(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout)
4214 {
4215   if (this->got_ == NULL)
4216     {
4217       gold_assert(symtab != NULL && layout != NULL);
4218
4219       this->got_ = new Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>(symtab, layout);
4220
4221       layout->add_output_section_data(".got", elfcpp::SHT_PROGBITS,
4222                                       (elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC | elfcpp::SHF_WRITE),
4223                                       this->got_, ORDER_DATA, false);
4224
4225       // The old GNU linker creates a .got.plt section.  We just
4226       // create another set of data in the .got section.  Note that we
4227       // always create a PLT if we create a GOT, although the PLT
4228       // might be empty.
4229       this->got_plt_ = new Output_data_space(4, "** GOT PLT");
4230       layout->add_output_section_data(".got", elfcpp::SHT_PROGBITS,
4231                                       (elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC | elfcpp::SHF_WRITE),
4232                                       this->got_plt_, ORDER_DATA, false);
4233
4234       // The first three entries are reserved.
4235       this->got_plt_->set_current_data_size(3 * 4);
4236
4237       // Define _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ at the start of the PLT.
4238       symtab->define_in_output_data("_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", NULL,
4239                                     Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
4240                                     this->got_plt_,
4241                                     0, 0, elfcpp::STT_OBJECT,
4242                                     elfcpp::STB_LOCAL,
4243                                     elfcpp::STV_HIDDEN, 0,
4244                                     false, false);
4245     }
4246   return this->got_;
4247 }
4248
4249 // Get the dynamic reloc section, creating it if necessary.
4250
4251 template<bool big_endian>
4252 typename Target_arm<big_endian>::Reloc_section*
4253 Target_arm<big_endian>::rel_dyn_section(Layout* layout)
4254 {
4255   if (this->rel_dyn_ == NULL)
4256     {
4257       gold_assert(layout != NULL);
4258       this->rel_dyn_ = new Reloc_section(parameters->options().combreloc());
4259       layout->add_output_section_data(".rel.dyn", elfcpp::SHT_REL,
4260                                       elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC, this->rel_dyn_,
4261                                       ORDER_DYNAMIC_RELOCS, false);
4262     }
4263   return this->rel_dyn_;
4264 }
4265
4266 // Insn_template methods.
4267
4268 // Return byte size of an instruction template.
4269
4270 size_t
4271 Insn_template::size() const
4272 {
4273   switch (this->type())
4274     {
4275     case THUMB16_TYPE:
4276     case THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE:
4277       return 2;
4278     case ARM_TYPE:
4279     case THUMB32_TYPE:
4280     case DATA_TYPE:
4281       return 4;
4282     default:
4283       gold_unreachable();
4284     }
4285 }
4286
4287 // Return alignment of an instruction template.
4288
4289 unsigned
4290 Insn_template::alignment() const
4291 {
4292   switch (this->type())
4293     {
4294     case THUMB16_TYPE:
4295     case THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE:
4296     case THUMB32_TYPE:
4297       return 2;
4298     case ARM_TYPE:
4299     case DATA_TYPE:
4300       return 4;
4301     default:
4302       gold_unreachable();
4303     }
4304 }
4305
4306 // Stub_template methods.
4307
4308 Stub_template::Stub_template(
4309     Stub_type type, const Insn_template* insns,
4310      size_t insn_count)
4311   : type_(type), insns_(insns), insn_count_(insn_count), alignment_(1),
4312     entry_in_thumb_mode_(false), relocs_()
4313 {
4314   off_t offset = 0;
4315
4316   // Compute byte size and alignment of stub template.
4317   for (size_t i = 0; i < insn_count; i++)
4318     {
4319       unsigned insn_alignment = insns[i].alignment();
4320       size_t insn_size = insns[i].size();
4321       gold_assert((offset & (insn_alignment - 1)) == 0);
4322       this->alignment_ = std::max(this->alignment_, insn_alignment);
4323       switch (insns[i].type())
4324         {
4325         case Insn_template::THUMB16_TYPE:
4326         case Insn_template::THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE:
4327           if (i == 0)
4328             this->entry_in_thumb_mode_ = true;
4329           break;
4330
4331         case Insn_template::THUMB32_TYPE:
4332           if (insns[i].r_type() != elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE)
4333             this->relocs_.push_back(Reloc(i, offset));
4334           if (i == 0)
4335             this->entry_in_thumb_mode_ = true;
4336           break;
4337
4338         case Insn_template::ARM_TYPE:
4339           // Handle cases where the target is encoded within the
4340           // instruction.
4341           if (insns[i].r_type() == elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24)
4342             this->relocs_.push_back(Reloc(i, offset));
4343           break;
4344
4345         case Insn_template::DATA_TYPE:
4346           // Entry point cannot be data.
4347           gold_assert(i != 0);
4348           this->relocs_.push_back(Reloc(i, offset));
4349           break;
4350
4351         default:
4352           gold_unreachable();
4353         }
4354       offset += insn_size; 
4355     }
4356   this->size_ = offset;
4357 }
4358
4359 // Stub methods.
4360
4361 // Template to implement do_write for a specific target endianness.
4362
4363 template<bool big_endian>
4364 void inline
4365 Stub::do_fixed_endian_write(unsigned char* view, section_size_type view_size)
4366 {
4367   const Stub_template* stub_template = this->stub_template();
4368   const Insn_template* insns = stub_template->insns();
4369
4370   // FIXME:  We do not handle BE8 encoding yet.
4371   unsigned char* pov = view;
4372   for (size_t i = 0; i < stub_template->insn_count(); i++)
4373     {
4374       switch (insns[i].type())
4375         {
4376         case Insn_template::THUMB16_TYPE:
4377           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, insns[i].data() & 0xffff);
4378           break;
4379         case Insn_template::THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE:
4380           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(
4381               pov,
4382               this->thumb16_special(i));
4383           break;
4384         case Insn_template::THUMB32_TYPE:
4385           {
4386             uint32_t hi = (insns[i].data() >> 16) & 0xffff;
4387             uint32_t lo = insns[i].data() & 0xffff;
4388             elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, hi);
4389             elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 2, lo);
4390           }
4391           break;
4392         case Insn_template::ARM_TYPE:
4393         case Insn_template::DATA_TYPE:
4394           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov, insns[i].data());
4395           break;
4396         default:
4397           gold_unreachable();
4398         }
4399       pov += insns[i].size();
4400     }
4401   gold_assert(static_cast<section_size_type>(pov - view) == view_size);
4402
4403
4404 // Reloc_stub::Key methods.
4405
4406 // Dump a Key as a string for debugging.
4407
4408 std::string
4409 Reloc_stub::Key::name() const
4410 {
4411   if (this->r_sym_ == invalid_index)
4412     {
4413       // Global symbol key name
4414       // <stub-type>:<symbol name>:<addend>.
4415       const std::string sym_name = this->u_.symbol->name();
4416       // We need to print two hex number and two colons.  So just add 100 bytes
4417       // to the symbol name size.
4418       size_t len = sym_name.size() + 100;
4419       char* buffer = new char[len];
4420       int c = snprintf(buffer, len, "%d:%s:%x", this->stub_type_,
4421                        sym_name.c_str(), this->addend_);
4422       gold_assert(c > 0 && c < static_cast<int>(len));
4423       delete[] buffer;
4424       return std::string(buffer);
4425     }
4426   else
4427     {
4428       // local symbol key name
4429       // <stub-type>:<object>:<r_sym>:<addend>.
4430       const size_t len = 200;
4431       char buffer[len];
4432       int c = snprintf(buffer, len, "%d:%p:%u:%x", this->stub_type_,
4433                        this->u_.relobj, this->r_sym_, this->addend_);
4434       gold_assert(c > 0 && c < static_cast<int>(len));
4435       return std::string(buffer);
4436     }
4437 }
4438
4439 // Reloc_stub methods.
4440
4441 // Determine the type of stub needed, if any, for a relocation of R_TYPE at
4442 // LOCATION to DESTINATION.
4443 // This code is based on the arm_type_of_stub function in
4444 // bfd/elf32-arm.c.  We have changed the interface a little to keep the Stub
4445 // class simple.
4446
4447 Stub_type
4448 Reloc_stub::stub_type_for_reloc(
4449    unsigned int r_type,
4450    Arm_address location,
4451    Arm_address destination,
4452    bool target_is_thumb)
4453 {
4454   Stub_type stub_type = arm_stub_none;
4455
4456   // This is a bit ugly but we want to avoid using a templated class for
4457   // big and little endianities.
4458   bool may_use_blx;
4459   bool should_force_pic_veneer;
4460   bool thumb2;
4461   bool thumb_only;
4462   if (parameters->target().is_big_endian())
4463     {
4464       const Target_arm<true>* big_endian_target =
4465         Target_arm<true>::default_target();
4466       may_use_blx = big_endian_target->may_use_blx();
4467       should_force_pic_veneer = big_endian_target->should_force_pic_veneer();
4468       thumb2 = big_endian_target->using_thumb2();
4469       thumb_only = big_endian_target->using_thumb_only();
4470     }
4471   else
4472     {
4473       const Target_arm<false>* little_endian_target =
4474         Target_arm<false>::default_target();
4475       may_use_blx = little_endian_target->may_use_blx();
4476       should_force_pic_veneer = little_endian_target->should_force_pic_veneer();
4477       thumb2 = little_endian_target->using_thumb2();
4478       thumb_only = little_endian_target->using_thumb_only();
4479     }
4480
4481   int64_t branch_offset;
4482   if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL || r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24)
4483     {
4484       // For THUMB BLX instruction, bit 1 of target comes from bit 1 of the
4485       // base address (instruction address + 4).
4486       if ((r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL) && may_use_blx && !target_is_thumb)
4487         destination = utils::bit_select(destination, location, 0x2);
4488       branch_offset = static_cast<int64_t>(destination) - location;
4489         
4490       // Handle cases where:
4491       // - this call goes too far (different Thumb/Thumb2 max
4492       //   distance)
4493       // - it's a Thumb->Arm call and blx is not available, or it's a
4494       //   Thumb->Arm branch (not bl). A stub is needed in this case.
4495       if ((!thumb2
4496             && (branch_offset > THM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET
4497                 || (branch_offset < THM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET)))
4498           || (thumb2
4499               && (branch_offset > THM2_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET
4500                   || (branch_offset < THM2_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET)))
4501           || ((!target_is_thumb)
4502               && (((r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL) && !may_use_blx)
4503                   || (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24))))
4504         {
4505           if (target_is_thumb)
4506             {
4507               // Thumb to thumb.
4508               if (!thumb_only)
4509                 {
4510                   stub_type = (parameters->options().shared()
4511                                || should_force_pic_veneer)
4512                     // PIC stubs.
4513                     ? ((may_use_blx
4514                         && (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL))
4515                        // V5T and above. Stub starts with ARM code, so
4516                        // we must be able to switch mode before
4517                        // reaching it, which is only possible for 'bl'
4518                        // (ie R_ARM_THM_CALL relocation).
4519                        ? arm_stub_long_branch_any_thumb_pic
4520                        // On V4T, use Thumb code only.
4521                        : arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb_pic)
4522
4523                     // non-PIC stubs.
4524                     : ((may_use_blx
4525                         && (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL))
4526                        ? arm_stub_long_branch_any_any // V5T and above.
4527                        : arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb); // V4T.
4528                 }
4529               else
4530                 {
4531                   stub_type = (parameters->options().shared()
4532                                || should_force_pic_veneer)
4533                     ? arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only_pic       // PIC stub.
4534                     : arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only;  // non-PIC stub.
4535                 }
4536             }
4537           else
4538             {
4539               // Thumb to arm.
4540              
4541               // FIXME: We should check that the input section is from an
4542               // object that has interwork enabled.
4543
4544               stub_type = (parameters->options().shared()
4545                            || should_force_pic_veneer)
4546                 // PIC stubs.
4547                 ? ((may_use_blx
4548                     && (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL))
4549                    ? arm_stub_long_branch_any_arm_pic   // V5T and above.
4550                    : arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm_pic)    // V4T.
4551
4552                 // non-PIC stubs.
4553                 : ((may_use_blx
4554                     && (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL))
4555                    ? arm_stub_long_branch_any_any       // V5T and above.
4556                    : arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm);       // V4T.
4557
4558               // Handle v4t short branches.
4559               if ((stub_type == arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm)
4560                   && (branch_offset <= THM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET)
4561                   && (branch_offset >= THM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET))
4562                 stub_type = arm_stub_short_branch_v4t_thumb_arm;
4563             }
4564         }
4565     }
4566   else if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL
4567            || r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24
4568            || r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32)
4569     {
4570       branch_offset = static_cast<int64_t>(destination) - location;
4571       if (target_is_thumb)
4572         {
4573           // Arm to thumb.
4574
4575           // FIXME: We should check that the input section is from an
4576           // object that has interwork enabled.
4577
4578           // We have an extra 2-bytes reach because of
4579           // the mode change (bit 24 (H) of BLX encoding).
4580           if (branch_offset > (ARM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET + 2)
4581               || (branch_offset < ARM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET)
4582               || ((r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL) && !may_use_blx)
4583               || (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24)
4584               || (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32))
4585             {
4586               stub_type = (parameters->options().shared()
4587                            || should_force_pic_veneer)
4588                 // PIC stubs.
4589                 ? (may_use_blx
4590                    ? arm_stub_long_branch_any_thumb_pic// V5T and above.
4591                    : arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb_pic)    // V4T stub.
4592
4593                 // non-PIC stubs.
4594                 : (may_use_blx
4595                    ? arm_stub_long_branch_any_any       // V5T and above.
4596                    : arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb);       // V4T.
4597             }
4598         }
4599       else
4600         {
4601           // Arm to arm.
4602           if (branch_offset > ARM_MAX_FWD_BRANCH_OFFSET
4603               || (branch_offset < ARM_MAX_BWD_BRANCH_OFFSET))
4604             {
4605               stub_type = (parameters->options().shared()
4606                            || should_force_pic_veneer)
4607                 ? arm_stub_long_branch_any_arm_pic      // PIC stubs.
4608                 : arm_stub_long_branch_any_any;         /// non-PIC.
4609             }
4610         }
4611     }
4612
4613   return stub_type;
4614 }
4615
4616 // Cortex_a8_stub methods.
4617
4618 // Return the instruction for a THUMB16_SPECIAL_TYPE instruction template.
4619 // I is the position of the instruction template in the stub template.
4620
4621 uint16_t
4622 Cortex_a8_stub::do_thumb16_special(size_t i)
4623 {
4624   // The only use of this is to copy condition code from a conditional
4625   // branch being worked around to the corresponding conditional branch in
4626   // to the stub.
4627   gold_assert(this->stub_template()->type() == arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond
4628               && i == 0);
4629   uint16_t data = this->stub_template()->insns()[i].data();
4630   gold_assert((data & 0xff00U) == 0xd000U);
4631   data |= ((this->original_insn_ >> 22) & 0xf) << 8;
4632   return data;
4633 }
4634
4635 // Stub_factory methods.
4636
4637 Stub_factory::Stub_factory()
4638 {
4639   // The instruction template sequences are declared as static
4640   // objects and initialized first time the constructor runs.
4641  
4642   // Arm/Thumb -> Arm/Thumb long branch stub. On V5T and above, use blx
4643   // to reach the stub if necessary.
4644   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_any_any[] =
4645     {
4646       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe51ff004),      // ldr   pc, [pc, #-4]
4647       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32, 0),
4648                                                 // dcd   R_ARM_ABS32(X)
4649     };
4650   
4651   // V4T Arm -> Thumb long branch stub. Used on V4T where blx is not
4652   // available.
4653   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb[] =
4654     {
4655       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe59fc000),      // ldr   ip, [pc, #0]
4656       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe12fff1c),      // bx    ip
4657       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32, 0),
4658                                                 // dcd   R_ARM_ABS32(X)
4659     };
4660   
4661   // Thumb -> Thumb long branch stub. Used on M-profile architectures.
4662   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only[] =
4663     {
4664       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0xb401),      // push {r0}
4665       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4802),      // ldr  r0, [pc, #8]
4666       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4684),      // mov  ip, r0
4667       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0xbc01),      // pop  {r0}
4668       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4760),      // bx   ip
4669       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0xbf00),      // nop
4670       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32, 0),
4671                                                 // dcd  R_ARM_ABS32(X)
4672     };
4673   
4674   // V4T Thumb -> Thumb long branch stub. Using the stack is not
4675   // allowed.
4676   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb[] =
4677     {
4678       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4778),      // bx   pc
4679       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x46c0),      // nop
4680       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe59fc000),      // ldr  ip, [pc, #0]
4681       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe12fff1c),      // bx   ip
4682       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32, 0),
4683                                                 // dcd  R_ARM_ABS32(X)
4684     };
4685   
4686   // V4T Thumb -> ARM long branch stub. Used on V4T where blx is not
4687   // available.
4688   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm[] =
4689     {
4690       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4778),      // bx   pc
4691       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x46c0),      // nop
4692       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe51ff004),      // ldr   pc, [pc, #-4]
4693       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32, 0),
4694                                                 // dcd   R_ARM_ABS32(X)
4695     };
4696   
4697   // V4T Thumb -> ARM short branch stub. Shorter variant of the above
4698   // one, when the destination is close enough.
4699   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_short_branch_v4t_thumb_arm[] =
4700     {
4701       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4778),              // bx   pc
4702       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x46c0),              // nop
4703       Insn_template::arm_rel_insn(0xea000000, -8),      // b    (X-8)
4704     };
4705   
4706   // ARM/Thumb -> ARM long branch stub, PIC.  On V5T and above, use
4707   // blx to reach the stub if necessary.
4708   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_any_arm_pic[] =
4709     {
4710       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe59fc000),      // ldr   r12, [pc]
4711       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe08ff00c),      // add   pc, pc, ip
4712       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32, -4),
4713                                                 // dcd   R_ARM_REL32(X-4)
4714     };
4715   
4716   // ARM/Thumb -> Thumb long branch stub, PIC.  On V5T and above, use
4717   // blx to reach the stub if necessary.  We can not add into pc;
4718   // it is not guaranteed to mode switch (different in ARMv6 and
4719   // ARMv7).
4720   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_any_thumb_pic[] =
4721     {
4722       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe59fc004),      // ldr   r12, [pc, #4]
4723       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe08fc00c),      // add   ip, pc, ip
4724       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe12fff1c),      // bx    ip
4725       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32, 0),
4726                                                 // dcd   R_ARM_REL32(X)
4727     };
4728   
4729   // V4T ARM -> ARM long branch stub, PIC.
4730   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_arm_thumb_pic[] =
4731     {
4732       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe59fc004),      // ldr   ip, [pc, #4]
4733       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe08fc00c),      // add   ip, pc, ip
4734       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe12fff1c),      // bx    ip
4735       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32, 0),
4736                                                 // dcd   R_ARM_REL32(X)
4737     };
4738   
4739   // V4T Thumb -> ARM long branch stub, PIC.
4740   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_arm_pic[] =
4741     {
4742       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4778),      // bx   pc
4743       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x46c0),      // nop
4744       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe59fc000),      // ldr  ip, [pc, #0]
4745       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe08cf00f),      // add  pc, ip, pc
4746       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32, -4),
4747                                                 // dcd  R_ARM_REL32(X)
4748     };
4749   
4750   // Thumb -> Thumb long branch stub, PIC. Used on M-profile
4751   // architectures.
4752   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_thumb_only_pic[] =
4753     {
4754       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0xb401),      // push {r0}
4755       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4802),      // ldr  r0, [pc, #8]
4756       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x46fc),      // mov  ip, pc
4757       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4484),      // add  ip, r0
4758       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0xbc01),      // pop  {r0}
4759       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4760),      // bx   ip
4760       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32, 4),
4761                                                 // dcd  R_ARM_REL32(X)
4762     };
4763   
4764   // V4T Thumb -> Thumb long branch stub, PIC. Using the stack is not
4765   // allowed.
4766   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_long_branch_v4t_thumb_thumb_pic[] =
4767     {
4768       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x4778),      // bx   pc
4769       Insn_template::thumb16_insn(0x46c0),      // nop
4770       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe59fc004),      // ldr  ip, [pc, #4]
4771       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe08fc00c),      // add   ip, pc, ip
4772       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe12fff1c),      // bx   ip
4773       Insn_template::data_word(0, elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32, 0),
4774                                                 // dcd  R_ARM_REL32(X)
4775     };
4776   
4777   // Cortex-A8 erratum-workaround stubs.
4778   
4779   // Stub used for conditional branches (which may be beyond +/-1MB away,
4780   // so we can't use a conditional branch to reach this stub).
4781   
4782   // original code:
4783   //
4784   //    b<cond> X
4785   // after:
4786   //
4787   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond[] =
4788     {
4789       Insn_template::thumb16_bcond_insn(0xd001),        //      b<cond>.n true
4790       Insn_template::thumb32_b_insn(0xf000b800, -4),    //      b.w after
4791       Insn_template::thumb32_b_insn(0xf000b800, -4)     // true:
4792                                                         //      b.w X
4793     };
4794   
4795   // Stub used for b.w and bl.w instructions.
4796   
4797   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_a8_veneer_b[] =
4798     {
4799       Insn_template::thumb32_b_insn(0xf000b800, -4)     // b.w dest
4800     };
4801   
4802   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl[] =
4803     {
4804       Insn_template::thumb32_b_insn(0xf000b800, -4)     // b.w dest
4805     };
4806   
4807   // Stub used for Thumb-2 blx.w instructions.  We modified the original blx.w
4808   // instruction (which switches to ARM mode) to point to this stub.  Jump to
4809   // the real destination using an ARM-mode branch.
4810   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx[] =
4811     {
4812       Insn_template::arm_rel_insn(0xea000000, -8)       // b dest
4813     };
4814
4815   // Stub used to provide an interworking for R_ARM_V4BX relocation
4816   // (bx r[n] instruction).
4817   static const Insn_template elf32_arm_stub_v4_veneer_bx[] =
4818     {
4819       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe3100001),              // tst   r<n>, #1
4820       Insn_template::arm_insn(0x01a0f000),              // moveq pc, r<n>
4821       Insn_template::arm_insn(0xe12fff10)               // bx    r<n>
4822     };
4823
4824   // Fill in the stub template look-up table.  Stub templates are constructed
4825   // per instance of Stub_factory for fast look-up without locking
4826   // in a thread-enabled environment.
4827
4828   this->stub_templates_[arm_stub_none] =
4829     new Stub_template(arm_stub_none, NULL, 0);
4830
4831 #define DEF_STUB(x)     \
4832   do \
4833     { \
4834       size_t array_size \
4835         = sizeof(elf32_arm_stub_##x) / sizeof(elf32_arm_stub_##x[0]); \
4836       Stub_type type = arm_stub_##x; \
4837       this->stub_templates_[type] = \
4838         new Stub_template(type, elf32_arm_stub_##x, array_size); \
4839     } \
4840   while (0);
4841
4842   DEF_STUBS
4843 #undef DEF_STUB
4844 }
4845
4846 // Stub_table methods.
4847
4848 // Remove all Cortex-A8 stub.
4849
4850 template<bool big_endian>
4851 void
4852 Stub_table<big_endian>::remove_all_cortex_a8_stubs()
4853 {
4854   for (Cortex_a8_stub_list::iterator p = this->cortex_a8_stubs_.begin();
4855        p != this->cortex_a8_stubs_.end();
4856        ++p)
4857     delete p->second;
4858   this->cortex_a8_stubs_.clear();
4859 }
4860
4861 // Relocate one stub.  This is a helper for Stub_table::relocate_stubs().
4862
4863 template<bool big_endian>
4864 void
4865 Stub_table<big_endian>::relocate_stub(
4866     Stub* stub,
4867     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
4868     Target_arm<big_endian>* arm_target,
4869     Output_section* output_section,
4870     unsigned char* view,
4871     Arm_address address,
4872     section_size_type view_size)
4873 {
4874   const Stub_template* stub_template = stub->stub_template();
4875   if (stub_template->reloc_count() != 0)
4876     {
4877       // Adjust view to cover the stub only.
4878       section_size_type offset = stub->offset();
4879       section_size_type stub_size = stub_template->size();
4880       gold_assert(offset + stub_size <= view_size);
4881
4882       arm_target->relocate_stub(stub, relinfo, output_section, view + offset,
4883                                 address + offset, stub_size);
4884     }
4885 }
4886
4887 // Relocate all stubs in this stub table.
4888
4889 template<bool big_endian>
4890 void
4891 Stub_table<big_endian>::relocate_stubs(
4892     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
4893     Target_arm<big_endian>* arm_target,
4894     Output_section* output_section,
4895     unsigned char* view,
4896     Arm_address address,
4897     section_size_type view_size)
4898 {
4899   // If we are passed a view bigger than the stub table's.  we need to
4900   // adjust the view.
4901   gold_assert(address == this->address()
4902               && (view_size
4903                   == static_cast<section_size_type>(this->data_size())));
4904
4905   // Relocate all relocation stubs.
4906   for (typename Reloc_stub_map::const_iterator p = this->reloc_stubs_.begin();
4907       p != this->reloc_stubs_.end();
4908       ++p)
4909     this->relocate_stub(p->second, relinfo, arm_target, output_section, view,
4910                         address, view_size);
4911
4912   // Relocate all Cortex-A8 stubs.
4913   for (Cortex_a8_stub_list::iterator p = this->cortex_a8_stubs_.begin();
4914        p != this->cortex_a8_stubs_.end();
4915        ++p)
4916     this->relocate_stub(p->second, relinfo, arm_target, output_section, view,
4917                         address, view_size);
4918
4919   // Relocate all ARM V4BX stubs.
4920   for (Arm_v4bx_stub_list::iterator p = this->arm_v4bx_stubs_.begin();
4921        p != this->arm_v4bx_stubs_.end();
4922        ++p)
4923     {
4924       if (*p != NULL)
4925         this->relocate_stub(*p, relinfo, arm_target, output_section, view,
4926                             address, view_size);
4927     }
4928 }
4929
4930 // Write out the stubs to file.
4931
4932 template<bool big_endian>
4933 void
4934 Stub_table<big_endian>::do_write(Output_file* of)
4935 {
4936   off_t offset = this->offset();
4937   const section_size_type oview_size =
4938     convert_to_section_size_type(this->data_size());
4939   unsigned char* const oview = of->get_output_view(offset, oview_size);
4940
4941   // Write relocation stubs.
4942   for (typename Reloc_stub_map::const_iterator p = this->reloc_stubs_.begin();
4943       p != this->reloc_stubs_.end();
4944       ++p)
4945     {
4946       Reloc_stub* stub = p->second;
4947       Arm_address address = this->address() + stub->offset();
4948       gold_assert(address
4949                   == align_address(address,
4950                                    stub->stub_template()->alignment()));
4951       stub->write(oview + stub->offset(), stub->stub_template()->size(),
4952                   big_endian);
4953     }
4954
4955   // Write Cortex-A8 stubs.
4956   for (Cortex_a8_stub_list::const_iterator p = this->cortex_a8_stubs_.begin();
4957        p != this->cortex_a8_stubs_.end();
4958        ++p)
4959     {
4960       Cortex_a8_stub* stub = p->second;
4961       Arm_address address = this->address() + stub->offset();
4962       gold_assert(address
4963                   == align_address(address,
4964                                    stub->stub_template()->alignment()));
4965       stub->write(oview + stub->offset(), stub->stub_template()->size(),
4966                   big_endian);
4967     }
4968
4969   // Write ARM V4BX relocation stubs.
4970   for (Arm_v4bx_stub_list::const_iterator p = this->arm_v4bx_stubs_.begin();
4971        p != this->arm_v4bx_stubs_.end();
4972        ++p)
4973     {
4974       if (*p == NULL)
4975         continue;
4976
4977       Arm_address address = this->address() + (*p)->offset();
4978       gold_assert(address
4979                   == align_address(address,
4980                                    (*p)->stub_template()->alignment()));
4981       (*p)->write(oview + (*p)->offset(), (*p)->stub_template()->size(),
4982                   big_endian);
4983     }
4984
4985   of->write_output_view(this->offset(), oview_size, oview);
4986 }
4987
4988 // Update the data size and address alignment of the stub table at the end
4989 // of a relaxation pass.   Return true if either the data size or the
4990 // alignment changed in this relaxation pass.
4991
4992 template<bool big_endian>
4993 bool
4994 Stub_table<big_endian>::update_data_size_and_addralign()
4995 {
4996   // Go over all stubs in table to compute data size and address alignment.
4997   off_t size = this->reloc_stubs_size_;
4998   unsigned addralign = this->reloc_stubs_addralign_;
4999
5000   for (Cortex_a8_stub_list::const_iterator p = this->cortex_a8_stubs_.begin();
5001        p != this->cortex_a8_stubs_.end();
5002        ++p)
5003     {
5004       const Stub_template* stub_template = p->second->stub_template();
5005       addralign = std::max(addralign, stub_template->alignment());
5006       size = (align_address(size, stub_template->alignment())
5007               + stub_template->size());
5008     }
5009
5010   for (Arm_v4bx_stub_list::const_iterator p = this->arm_v4bx_stubs_.begin();
5011        p != this->arm_v4bx_stubs_.end();
5012        ++p)
5013     {
5014       if (*p == NULL)
5015         continue;
5016
5017       const Stub_template* stub_template = (*p)->stub_template();
5018       addralign = std::max(addralign, stub_template->alignment());
5019       size = (align_address(size, stub_template->alignment())
5020               + stub_template->size());
5021     }
5022
5023   // Check if either data size or alignment changed in this pass.
5024   // Update prev_data_size_ and prev_addralign_.  These will be used
5025   // as the current data size and address alignment for the next pass.
5026   bool changed = size != this->prev_data_size_;
5027   this->prev_data_size_ = size; 
5028
5029   if (addralign != this->prev_addralign_)
5030     changed = true;
5031   this->prev_addralign_ = addralign;
5032
5033   return changed;
5034 }
5035
5036 // Finalize the stubs.  This sets the offsets of the stubs within the stub
5037 // table.  It also marks all input sections needing Cortex-A8 workaround.
5038
5039 template<bool big_endian>
5040 void
5041 Stub_table<big_endian>::finalize_stubs()
5042 {
5043   off_t off = this->reloc_stubs_size_;
5044   for (Cortex_a8_stub_list::const_iterator p = this->cortex_a8_stubs_.begin();
5045        p != this->cortex_a8_stubs_.end();
5046        ++p)
5047     {
5048       Cortex_a8_stub* stub = p->second;
5049       const Stub_template* stub_template = stub->stub_template();
5050       uint64_t stub_addralign = stub_template->alignment();
5051       off = align_address(off, stub_addralign);
5052       stub->set_offset(off);
5053       off += stub_template->size();
5054
5055       // Mark input section so that we can determine later if a code section
5056       // needs the Cortex-A8 workaround quickly.
5057       Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
5058         Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(stub->relobj());
5059       arm_relobj->mark_section_for_cortex_a8_workaround(stub->shndx());
5060     }
5061
5062   for (Arm_v4bx_stub_list::const_iterator p = this->arm_v4bx_stubs_.begin();
5063       p != this->arm_v4bx_stubs_.end();
5064       ++p)
5065     {
5066       if (*p == NULL)
5067         continue;
5068
5069       const Stub_template* stub_template = (*p)->stub_template();
5070       uint64_t stub_addralign = stub_template->alignment();
5071       off = align_address(off, stub_addralign);
5072       (*p)->set_offset(off);
5073       off += stub_template->size();
5074     }
5075
5076   gold_assert(off <= this->prev_data_size_);
5077 }
5078
5079 // Apply Cortex-A8 workaround to an address range between VIEW_ADDRESS
5080 // and VIEW_ADDRESS + VIEW_SIZE - 1.  VIEW points to the mapped address
5081 // of the address range seen by the linker.
5082
5083 template<bool big_endian>
5084 void
5085 Stub_table<big_endian>::apply_cortex_a8_workaround_to_address_range(
5086     Target_arm<big_endian>* arm_target,
5087     unsigned char* view,
5088     Arm_address view_address,
5089     section_size_type view_size)
5090 {
5091   // Cortex-A8 stubs are sorted by addresses of branches being fixed up.
5092   for (Cortex_a8_stub_list::const_iterator p =
5093          this->cortex_a8_stubs_.lower_bound(view_address);
5094        ((p != this->cortex_a8_stubs_.end())
5095         && (p->first < (view_address + view_size)));
5096        ++p)
5097     {
5098       // We do not store the THUMB bit in the LSB of either the branch address
5099       // or the stub offset.  There is no need to strip the LSB.
5100       Arm_address branch_address = p->first;
5101       const Cortex_a8_stub* stub = p->second;
5102       Arm_address stub_address = this->address() + stub->offset();
5103
5104       // Offset of the branch instruction relative to this view.
5105       section_size_type offset =
5106         convert_to_section_size_type(branch_address - view_address);
5107       gold_assert((offset + 4) <= view_size);
5108
5109       arm_target->apply_cortex_a8_workaround(stub, stub_address,
5110                                              view + offset, branch_address);
5111     }
5112 }
5113
5114 // Arm_input_section methods.
5115
5116 // Initialize an Arm_input_section.
5117
5118 template<bool big_endian>
5119 void
5120 Arm_input_section<big_endian>::init()
5121 {
5122   Relobj* relobj = this->relobj();
5123   unsigned int shndx = this->shndx();
5124
5125   // We have to cache original size, alignment and contents to avoid locking
5126   // the original file.
5127   this->original_addralign_ =
5128     convert_types<uint32_t, uint64_t>(relobj->section_addralign(shndx));
5129
5130   // This is not efficient but we expect only a small number of relaxed
5131   // input sections for stubs.
5132   section_size_type section_size;
5133   const unsigned char* section_contents =
5134     relobj->section_contents(shndx, &section_size, false);
5135   this->original_size_ =
5136     convert_types<uint32_t, uint64_t>(relobj->section_size(shndx));
5137
5138   gold_assert(this->original_contents_ == NULL);
5139   this->original_contents_ = new unsigned char[section_size];
5140   memcpy(this->original_contents_, section_contents, section_size);
5141
5142   // We want to make this look like the original input section after
5143   // output sections are finalized.
5144   Output_section* os = relobj->output_section(shndx);
5145   off_t offset = relobj->output_section_offset(shndx);
5146   gold_assert(os != NULL && !relobj->is_output_section_offset_invalid(shndx));
5147   this->set_address(os->address() + offset);
5148   this->set_file_offset(os->offset() + offset);
5149
5150   this->set_current_data_size(this->original_size_);
5151   this->finalize_data_size();
5152 }
5153
5154 template<bool big_endian>
5155 void
5156 Arm_input_section<big_endian>::do_write(Output_file* of)
5157 {
5158   // We have to write out the original section content.
5159   gold_assert(this->original_contents_ != NULL);
5160   of->write(this->offset(), this->original_contents_,
5161             this->original_size_); 
5162
5163   // If this owns a stub table and it is not empty, write it.
5164   if (this->is_stub_table_owner() && !this->stub_table_->empty())
5165     this->stub_table_->write(of);
5166 }
5167
5168 // Finalize data size.
5169
5170 template<bool big_endian>
5171 void
5172 Arm_input_section<big_endian>::set_final_data_size()
5173 {
5174   off_t off = convert_types<off_t, uint64_t>(this->original_size_);
5175
5176   if (this->is_stub_table_owner())
5177     {
5178       this->stub_table_->finalize_data_size();
5179       off = align_address(off, this->stub_table_->addralign());
5180       off += this->stub_table_->data_size();
5181     }
5182   this->set_data_size(off);
5183 }
5184
5185 // Reset address and file offset.
5186
5187 template<bool big_endian>
5188 void
5189 Arm_input_section<big_endian>::do_reset_address_and_file_offset()
5190 {
5191   // Size of the original input section contents.
5192   off_t off = convert_types<off_t, uint64_t>(this->original_size_);
5193
5194   // If this is a stub table owner, account for the stub table size.
5195   if (this->is_stub_table_owner())
5196     {
5197       Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table = this->stub_table_;
5198
5199       // Reset the stub table's address and file offset.  The
5200       // current data size for child will be updated after that.
5201       stub_table_->reset_address_and_file_offset();
5202       off = align_address(off, stub_table_->addralign());
5203       off += stub_table->current_data_size();
5204     }
5205
5206   this->set_current_data_size(off);
5207 }
5208
5209 // Arm_exidx_cantunwind methods.
5210
5211 // Write this to Output file OF for a fixed endianness.
5212
5213 template<bool big_endian>
5214 void
5215 Arm_exidx_cantunwind::do_fixed_endian_write(Output_file* of)
5216 {
5217   off_t offset = this->offset();
5218   const section_size_type oview_size = 8;
5219   unsigned char* const oview = of->get_output_view(offset, oview_size);
5220   
5221   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
5222   Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(oview);
5223
5224   Output_section* os = this->relobj_->output_section(this->shndx_);
5225   gold_assert(os != NULL);
5226
5227   Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
5228     Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(this->relobj_);
5229   Arm_address output_offset =
5230     arm_relobj->get_output_section_offset(this->shndx_);
5231   Arm_address section_start;
5232   section_size_type section_size;
5233
5234   // Find out the end of the text section referred by this.
5235   if (output_offset != Arm_relobj<big_endian>::invalid_address)
5236     {
5237       section_start = os->address() + output_offset;
5238       const Arm_exidx_input_section* exidx_input_section =
5239         arm_relobj->exidx_input_section_by_link(this->shndx_);
5240       gold_assert(exidx_input_section != NULL);
5241       section_size =
5242         convert_to_section_size_type(exidx_input_section->text_size());
5243     }
5244   else
5245     {
5246       // Currently this only happens for a relaxed section.
5247       const Output_relaxed_input_section* poris =
5248         os->find_relaxed_input_section(this->relobj_, this->shndx_);
5249       gold_assert(poris != NULL);
5250       section_start = poris->address();
5251       section_size = convert_to_section_size_type(poris->data_size());
5252     }
5253
5254   // We always append this to the end of an EXIDX section.
5255   Arm_address output_address = section_start + section_size;
5256
5257   // Write out the entry.  The first word either points to the beginning
5258   // or after the end of a text section.  The second word is the special
5259   // EXIDX_CANTUNWIND value.
5260   uint32_t prel31_offset = output_address - this->address();
5261   if (utils::has_overflow<31>(offset))
5262     gold_error(_("PREL31 overflow in EXIDX_CANTUNWIND entry"));
5263   elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, prel31_offset & 0x7fffffffU);
5264   elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv + 1, elfcpp::EXIDX_CANTUNWIND);
5265
5266   of->write_output_view(this->offset(), oview_size, oview);
5267 }
5268
5269 // Arm_exidx_merged_section methods.
5270
5271 // Constructor for Arm_exidx_merged_section.
5272 // EXIDX_INPUT_SECTION points to the unmodified EXIDX input section.
5273 // SECTION_OFFSET_MAP points to a section offset map describing how
5274 // parts of the input section are mapped to output.  DELETED_BYTES is
5275 // the number of bytes deleted from the EXIDX input section.
5276
5277 Arm_exidx_merged_section::Arm_exidx_merged_section(
5278     const Arm_exidx_input_section& exidx_input_section,
5279     const Arm_exidx_section_offset_map& section_offset_map,
5280     uint32_t deleted_bytes)
5281   : Output_relaxed_input_section(exidx_input_section.relobj(),
5282                                  exidx_input_section.shndx(),
5283                                  exidx_input_section.addralign()),
5284     exidx_input_section_(exidx_input_section),
5285     section_offset_map_(section_offset_map)
5286 {
5287   // If we retain or discard the whole EXIDX input section,  we would
5288   // not be here.
5289   gold_assert(deleted_bytes != 0
5290               && deleted_bytes != this->exidx_input_section_.size());
5291
5292   // Fix size here so that we do not need to implement set_final_data_size.
5293   uint32_t size = exidx_input_section.size() - deleted_bytes;
5294   this->set_data_size(size);
5295   this->fix_data_size();
5296
5297   // Allocate buffer for section contents and build contents.
5298   this->section_contents_ = new unsigned char[size];
5299 }
5300
5301 // Build the contents of a merged EXIDX output section.
5302
5303 void
5304 Arm_exidx_merged_section::build_contents(
5305     const unsigned char* original_contents,
5306     section_size_type original_size)
5307 {
5308   // Go over spans of input offsets and write only those that are not
5309   // discarded.
5310   section_offset_type in_start = 0;
5311   section_offset_type out_start = 0;
5312   section_offset_type in_max =
5313     convert_types<section_offset_type>(original_size);
5314   section_offset_type out_max =
5315     convert_types<section_offset_type>(this->data_size());
5316   for (Arm_exidx_section_offset_map::const_iterator p =
5317         this->section_offset_map_.begin();
5318       p != this->section_offset_map_.end();
5319       ++p)
5320     {
5321       section_offset_type in_end = p->first;
5322       gold_assert(in_end >= in_start);
5323       section_offset_type out_end = p->second;
5324       size_t in_chunk_size = convert_types<size_t>(in_end - in_start + 1);
5325       if (out_end != -1)
5326         {
5327           size_t out_chunk_size =
5328             convert_types<size_t>(out_end - out_start + 1);
5329
5330           gold_assert(out_chunk_size == in_chunk_size
5331                       && in_end < in_max && out_end < out_max);
5332
5333           memcpy(this->section_contents_ + out_start,
5334                  original_contents + in_start,
5335                  out_chunk_size);
5336           out_start += out_chunk_size;
5337         }
5338       in_start += in_chunk_size;
5339     }
5340 }
5341
5342 // Given an input OBJECT, an input section index SHNDX within that
5343 // object, and an OFFSET relative to the start of that input
5344 // section, return whether or not the corresponding offset within
5345 // the output section is known.  If this function returns true, it
5346 // sets *POUTPUT to the output offset.  The value -1 indicates that
5347 // this input offset is being discarded.
5348
5349 bool
5350 Arm_exidx_merged_section::do_output_offset(
5351     const Relobj* relobj,
5352     unsigned int shndx,
5353     section_offset_type offset,
5354     section_offset_type* poutput) const
5355 {
5356   // We only handle offsets for the original EXIDX input section.
5357   if (relobj != this->exidx_input_section_.relobj()
5358       || shndx != this->exidx_input_section_.shndx())
5359     return false;
5360
5361   section_offset_type section_size =
5362     convert_types<section_offset_type>(this->exidx_input_section_.size());
5363   if (offset < 0 || offset >= section_size)
5364     // Input offset is out of valid range.
5365     *poutput = -1;
5366   else
5367     {
5368       // We need to look up the section offset map to determine the output
5369       // offset.  Find the reference point in map that is first offset
5370       // bigger than or equal to this offset.
5371       Arm_exidx_section_offset_map::const_iterator p =
5372         this->section_offset_map_.lower_bound(offset);
5373
5374       // The section offset maps are build such that this should not happen if
5375       // input offset is in the valid range.
5376       gold_assert(p != this->section_offset_map_.end());
5377
5378       // We need to check if this is dropped.
5379      section_offset_type ref = p->first;
5380      section_offset_type mapped_ref = p->second;
5381
5382       if (mapped_ref != Arm_exidx_input_section::invalid_offset)
5383         // Offset is present in output.
5384         *poutput = mapped_ref + (offset - ref);
5385       else
5386         // Offset is discarded owing to EXIDX entry merging.
5387         *poutput = -1;
5388     }
5389   
5390   return true;
5391 }
5392
5393 // Write this to output file OF.
5394
5395 void
5396 Arm_exidx_merged_section::do_write(Output_file* of)
5397 {
5398   off_t offset = this->offset();
5399   const section_size_type oview_size = this->data_size();
5400   unsigned char* const oview = of->get_output_view(offset, oview_size);
5401   
5402   Output_section* os = this->relobj()->output_section(this->shndx());
5403   gold_assert(os != NULL);
5404
5405   memcpy(oview, this->section_contents_, oview_size);
5406   of->write_output_view(this->offset(), oview_size, oview);
5407 }
5408
5409 // Arm_exidx_fixup methods.
5410
5411 // Append an EXIDX_CANTUNWIND in the current output section if the last entry
5412 // is not an EXIDX_CANTUNWIND entry already.  The new EXIDX_CANTUNWIND entry
5413 // points to the end of the last seen EXIDX section.
5414
5415 void
5416 Arm_exidx_fixup::add_exidx_cantunwind_as_needed()
5417 {
5418   if (this->last_unwind_type_ != UT_EXIDX_CANTUNWIND
5419       && this->last_input_section_ != NULL)
5420     {
5421       Relobj* relobj = this->last_input_section_->relobj();
5422       unsigned int text_shndx = this->last_input_section_->link();
5423       Arm_exidx_cantunwind* cantunwind =
5424         new Arm_exidx_cantunwind(relobj, text_shndx);
5425       this->exidx_output_section_->add_output_section_data(cantunwind);
5426       this->last_unwind_type_ = UT_EXIDX_CANTUNWIND;
5427     }
5428 }
5429
5430 // Process an EXIDX section entry in input.  Return whether this entry
5431 // can be deleted in the output.  SECOND_WORD in the second word of the
5432 // EXIDX entry.
5433
5434 bool
5435 Arm_exidx_fixup::process_exidx_entry(uint32_t second_word)
5436 {
5437   bool delete_entry;
5438   if (second_word == elfcpp::EXIDX_CANTUNWIND)
5439     {
5440       // Merge if previous entry is also an EXIDX_CANTUNWIND.
5441       delete_entry = this->last_unwind_type_ == UT_EXIDX_CANTUNWIND;
5442       this->last_unwind_type_ = UT_EXIDX_CANTUNWIND;
5443     }
5444   else if ((second_word & 0x80000000) != 0)
5445     {
5446       // Inlined unwinding data.  Merge if equal to previous.
5447       delete_entry = (merge_exidx_entries_
5448                       && this->last_unwind_type_ == UT_INLINED_ENTRY
5449                       && this->last_inlined_entry_ == second_word);
5450       this->last_unwind_type_ = UT_INLINED_ENTRY;
5451       this->last_inlined_entry_ = second_word;
5452     }
5453   else
5454     {
5455       // Normal table entry.  In theory we could merge these too,
5456       // but duplicate entries are likely to be much less common.
5457       delete_entry = false;
5458       this->last_unwind_type_ = UT_NORMAL_ENTRY;
5459     }
5460   return delete_entry;
5461 }
5462
5463 // Update the current section offset map during EXIDX section fix-up.
5464 // If there is no map, create one.  INPUT_OFFSET is the offset of a
5465 // reference point, DELETED_BYTES is the number of deleted by in the
5466 // section so far.  If DELETE_ENTRY is true, the reference point and
5467 // all offsets after the previous reference point are discarded.
5468
5469 void
5470 Arm_exidx_fixup::update_offset_map(
5471     section_offset_type input_offset,
5472     section_size_type deleted_bytes,
5473     bool delete_entry)
5474 {
5475   if (this->section_offset_map_ == NULL)
5476     this->section_offset_map_ = new Arm_exidx_section_offset_map();
5477   section_offset_type output_offset;
5478   if (delete_entry)
5479     output_offset = Arm_exidx_input_section::invalid_offset;
5480   else
5481     output_offset = input_offset - deleted_bytes;
5482   (*this->section_offset_map_)[input_offset] = output_offset;
5483 }
5484
5485 // Process EXIDX_INPUT_SECTION for EXIDX entry merging.  Return the number of
5486 // bytes deleted.  SECTION_CONTENTS points to the contents of the EXIDX
5487 // section and SECTION_SIZE is the number of bytes pointed by SECTION_CONTENTS.
5488 // If some entries are merged, also store a pointer to a newly created
5489 // Arm_exidx_section_offset_map object in *PSECTION_OFFSET_MAP.  The caller
5490 // owns the map and is responsible for releasing it after use.
5491
5492 template<bool big_endian>
5493 uint32_t
5494 Arm_exidx_fixup::process_exidx_section(
5495     const Arm_exidx_input_section* exidx_input_section,
5496     const unsigned char* section_contents,
5497     section_size_type section_size,
5498     Arm_exidx_section_offset_map** psection_offset_map)
5499 {
5500   Relobj* relobj = exidx_input_section->relobj();
5501   unsigned shndx = exidx_input_section->shndx();
5502
5503   if ((section_size % 8) != 0)
5504     {
5505       // Something is wrong with this section.  Better not touch it.
5506       gold_error(_("uneven .ARM.exidx section size in %s section %u"),
5507                  relobj->name().c_str(), shndx);
5508       this->last_input_section_ = exidx_input_section;
5509       this->last_unwind_type_ = UT_NONE;
5510       return 0;
5511     }
5512   
5513   uint32_t deleted_bytes = 0;
5514   bool prev_delete_entry = false;
5515   gold_assert(this->section_offset_map_ == NULL);
5516
5517   for (section_size_type i = 0; i < section_size; i += 8)
5518     {
5519       typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
5520       const Valtype* wv =
5521           reinterpret_cast<const Valtype*>(section_contents + i + 4);
5522       uint32_t second_word = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
5523
5524       bool delete_entry = this->process_exidx_entry(second_word);
5525
5526       // Entry deletion causes changes in output offsets.  We use a std::map
5527       // to record these.  And entry (x, y) means input offset x
5528       // is mapped to output offset y.  If y is invalid_offset, then x is
5529       // dropped in the output.  Because of the way std::map::lower_bound
5530       // works, we record the last offset in a region w.r.t to keeping or
5531       // dropping.  If there is no entry (x0, y0) for an input offset x0,
5532       // the output offset y0 of it is determined by the output offset y1 of
5533       // the smallest input offset x1 > x0 that there is an (x1, y1) entry
5534       // in the map.  If y1 is not -1, then y0 = y1 + x0 - x1.  Otherwise, y1
5535       // y0 is also -1.
5536       if (delete_entry != prev_delete_entry && i != 0)
5537         this->update_offset_map(i - 1, deleted_bytes, prev_delete_entry);
5538
5539       // Update total deleted bytes for this entry.
5540       if (delete_entry)
5541         deleted_bytes += 8;
5542
5543       prev_delete_entry = delete_entry;
5544     }
5545   
5546   // If section offset map is not NULL, make an entry for the end of
5547   // section.
5548   if (this->section_offset_map_ != NULL)
5549     update_offset_map(section_size - 1, deleted_bytes, prev_delete_entry);
5550
5551   *psection_offset_map = this->section_offset_map_;
5552   this->section_offset_map_ = NULL;
5553   this->last_input_section_ = exidx_input_section;
5554   
5555   // Set the first output text section so that we can link the EXIDX output
5556   // section to it.  Ignore any EXIDX input section that is completely merged.
5557   if (this->first_output_text_section_ == NULL
5558       && deleted_bytes != section_size)
5559     {
5560       unsigned int link = exidx_input_section->link();
5561       Output_section* os = relobj->output_section(link);
5562       gold_assert(os != NULL);
5563       this->first_output_text_section_ = os;
5564     }
5565
5566   return deleted_bytes;
5567 }
5568
5569 // Arm_output_section methods.
5570
5571 // Create a stub group for input sections from BEGIN to END.  OWNER
5572 // points to the input section to be the owner a new stub table.
5573
5574 template<bool big_endian>
5575 void
5576 Arm_output_section<big_endian>::create_stub_group(
5577   Input_section_list::const_iterator begin,
5578   Input_section_list::const_iterator end,
5579   Input_section_list::const_iterator owner,
5580   Target_arm<big_endian>* target,
5581   std::vector<Output_relaxed_input_section*>* new_relaxed_sections,
5582   const Task* task)
5583 {
5584   // We use a different kind of relaxed section in an EXIDX section.
5585   // The static casting from Output_relaxed_input_section to
5586   // Arm_input_section is invalid in an EXIDX section.  We are okay
5587   // because we should not be calling this for an EXIDX section. 
5588   gold_assert(this->type() != elfcpp::SHT_ARM_EXIDX);
5589
5590   // Currently we convert ordinary input sections into relaxed sections only
5591   // at this point but we may want to support creating relaxed input section
5592   // very early.  So we check here to see if owner is already a relaxed
5593   // section.
5594   
5595   Arm_input_section<big_endian>* arm_input_section;
5596   if (owner->is_relaxed_input_section())
5597     {
5598       arm_input_section =
5599         Arm_input_section<big_endian>::as_arm_input_section(
5600           owner->relaxed_input_section());
5601     }
5602   else
5603     {
5604       gold_assert(owner->is_input_section());
5605       // Create a new relaxed input section.  We need to lock the original
5606       // file.
5607       Task_lock_obj<Object> tl(task, owner->relobj());
5608       arm_input_section =
5609         target->new_arm_input_section(owner->relobj(), owner->shndx());
5610       new_relaxed_sections->push_back(arm_input_section);
5611     }
5612
5613   // Create a stub table.
5614   Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table =
5615     target->new_stub_table(arm_input_section);
5616
5617   arm_input_section->set_stub_table(stub_table);
5618   
5619   Input_section_list::const_iterator p = begin;
5620   Input_section_list::const_iterator prev_p;
5621
5622   // Look for input sections or relaxed input sections in [begin ... end].
5623   do
5624     {
5625       if (p->is_input_section() || p->is_relaxed_input_section())
5626         {
5627           // The stub table information for input sections live
5628           // in their objects.
5629           Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
5630             Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(p->relobj());
5631           arm_relobj->set_stub_table(p->shndx(), stub_table);
5632         }
5633       prev_p = p++;
5634     }
5635   while (prev_p != end);
5636 }
5637
5638 // Group input sections for stub generation.  GROUP_SIZE is roughly the limit
5639 // of stub groups.  We grow a stub group by adding input section until the
5640 // size is just below GROUP_SIZE.  The last input section will be converted
5641 // into a stub table.  If STUB_ALWAYS_AFTER_BRANCH is false, we also add
5642 // input section after the stub table, effectively double the group size.
5643 // 
5644 // This is similar to the group_sections() function in elf32-arm.c but is
5645 // implemented differently.
5646
5647 template<bool big_endian>
5648 void
5649 Arm_output_section<big_endian>::group_sections(
5650     section_size_type group_size,
5651     bool stubs_always_after_branch,
5652     Target_arm<big_endian>* target,
5653     const Task* task)
5654 {
5655   // We only care about sections containing code.
5656   if ((this->flags() & elfcpp::SHF_EXECINSTR) == 0)
5657     return;
5658
5659   // States for grouping.
5660   typedef enum
5661   {
5662     // No group is being built.
5663     NO_GROUP,
5664     // A group is being built but the stub table is not found yet.
5665     // We keep group a stub group until the size is just under GROUP_SIZE.
5666     // The last input section in the group will be used as the stub table.
5667     FINDING_STUB_SECTION,
5668     // A group is being built and we have already found a stub table.
5669     // We enter this state to grow a stub group by adding input section
5670     // after the stub table.  This effectively doubles the group size.
5671     HAS_STUB_SECTION
5672   } State;
5673
5674   // Any newly created relaxed sections are stored here.
5675   std::vector<Output_relaxed_input_section*> new_relaxed_sections;
5676
5677   State state = NO_GROUP;
5678   section_size_type off = 0;
5679   section_size_type group_begin_offset = 0;
5680   section_size_type group_end_offset = 0;
5681   section_size_type stub_table_end_offset = 0;
5682   Input_section_list::const_iterator group_begin =
5683     this->input_sections().end();
5684   Input_section_list::const_iterator stub_table =
5685     this->input_sections().end();
5686   Input_section_list::const_iterator group_end = this->input_sections().end();
5687   for (Input_section_list::const_iterator p = this->input_sections().begin();
5688        p != this->input_sections().end();
5689        ++p)
5690     {
5691       section_size_type section_begin_offset =
5692         align_address(off, p->addralign());
5693       section_size_type section_end_offset =
5694         section_begin_offset + p->data_size(); 
5695       
5696       // Check to see if we should group the previously seen sections.
5697       switch (state)
5698         {
5699         case NO_GROUP:
5700           break;
5701
5702         case FINDING_STUB_SECTION:
5703           // Adding this section makes the group larger than GROUP_SIZE.
5704           if (section_end_offset - group_begin_offset >= group_size)
5705             {
5706               if (stubs_always_after_branch)
5707                 {       
5708                   gold_assert(group_end != this->input_sections().end());
5709                   this->create_stub_group(group_begin, group_end, group_end,
5710                                           target, &new_relaxed_sections,
5711                                           task);
5712                   state = NO_GROUP;
5713                 }
5714               else
5715                 {
5716                   // But wait, there's more!  Input sections up to
5717                   // stub_group_size bytes after the stub table can be
5718                   // handled by it too.
5719                   state = HAS_STUB_SECTION;
5720                   stub_table = group_end;
5721                   stub_table_end_offset = group_end_offset;
5722                 }
5723             }
5724             break;
5725
5726         case HAS_STUB_SECTION:
5727           // Adding this section makes the post stub-section group larger
5728           // than GROUP_SIZE.
5729           if (section_end_offset - stub_table_end_offset >= group_size)
5730            {
5731              gold_assert(group_end != this->input_sections().end());
5732              this->create_stub_group(group_begin, group_end, stub_table,
5733                                      target, &new_relaxed_sections, task);
5734              state = NO_GROUP;
5735            }
5736            break;
5737
5738           default:
5739             gold_unreachable();
5740         }       
5741
5742       // If we see an input section and currently there is no group, start
5743       // a new one.  Skip any empty sections.  We look at the data size
5744       // instead of calling p->relobj()->section_size() to avoid locking.
5745       if ((p->is_input_section() || p->is_relaxed_input_section())
5746           && (p->data_size() != 0))
5747         {
5748           if (state == NO_GROUP)
5749             {
5750               state = FINDING_STUB_SECTION;
5751               group_begin = p;
5752               group_begin_offset = section_begin_offset;
5753             }
5754
5755           // Keep track of the last input section seen.
5756           group_end = p;
5757           group_end_offset = section_end_offset;
5758         }
5759
5760       off = section_end_offset;
5761     }
5762
5763   // Create a stub group for any ungrouped sections.
5764   if (state == FINDING_STUB_SECTION || state == HAS_STUB_SECTION)
5765     {
5766       gold_assert(group_end != this->input_sections().end());
5767       this->create_stub_group(group_begin, group_end,
5768                               (state == FINDING_STUB_SECTION
5769                                ? group_end
5770                                : stub_table),
5771                                target, &new_relaxed_sections, task);
5772     }
5773
5774   // Convert input section into relaxed input section in a batch.
5775   if (!new_relaxed_sections.empty())
5776     this->convert_input_sections_to_relaxed_sections(new_relaxed_sections);
5777
5778   // Update the section offsets
5779   for (size_t i = 0; i < new_relaxed_sections.size(); ++i)
5780     {
5781       Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
5782         Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(
5783           new_relaxed_sections[i]->relobj());
5784       unsigned int shndx = new_relaxed_sections[i]->shndx();
5785       // Tell Arm_relobj that this input section is converted.
5786       arm_relobj->convert_input_section_to_relaxed_section(shndx);
5787     }
5788 }
5789
5790 // Append non empty text sections in this to LIST in ascending
5791 // order of their position in this.
5792
5793 template<bool big_endian>
5794 void
5795 Arm_output_section<big_endian>::append_text_sections_to_list(
5796     Text_section_list* list)
5797 {
5798   gold_assert((this->flags() & elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC) != 0);
5799
5800   for (Input_section_list::const_iterator p = this->input_sections().begin();
5801        p != this->input_sections().end();
5802        ++p)
5803     {
5804       // We only care about plain or relaxed input sections.  We also
5805       // ignore any merged sections.
5806       if ((p->is_input_section() || p->is_relaxed_input_section())
5807           && p->data_size() != 0)
5808         list->push_back(Text_section_list::value_type(p->relobj(),
5809                                                       p->shndx()));
5810     }
5811 }
5812
5813 template<bool big_endian>
5814 void
5815 Arm_output_section<big_endian>::fix_exidx_coverage(
5816     Layout* layout,
5817     const Text_section_list& sorted_text_sections,
5818     Symbol_table* symtab,
5819     bool merge_exidx_entries,
5820     const Task* task)
5821 {
5822   // We should only do this for the EXIDX output section.
5823   gold_assert(this->type() == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_EXIDX);
5824
5825   // We don't want the relaxation loop to undo these changes, so we discard
5826   // the current saved states and take another one after the fix-up.
5827   this->discard_states();
5828
5829   // Remove all input sections.
5830   uint64_t address = this->address();
5831   typedef std::list<Output_section::Input_section> Input_section_list;
5832   Input_section_list input_sections;
5833   this->reset_address_and_file_offset();
5834   this->get_input_sections(address, std::string(""), &input_sections);
5835
5836   if (!this->input_sections().empty())
5837     gold_error(_("Found non-EXIDX input sections in EXIDX output section"));
5838   
5839   // Go through all the known input sections and record them.
5840   typedef Unordered_set<Section_id, Section_id_hash> Section_id_set;
5841   typedef Unordered_map<Section_id, const Output_section::Input_section*,
5842                         Section_id_hash> Text_to_exidx_map;
5843   Text_to_exidx_map text_to_exidx_map;
5844   for (Input_section_list::const_iterator p = input_sections.begin();
5845        p != input_sections.end();
5846        ++p)
5847     {
5848       // This should never happen.  At this point, we should only see
5849       // plain EXIDX input sections.
5850       gold_assert(!p->is_relaxed_input_section());
5851       text_to_exidx_map[Section_id(p->relobj(), p->shndx())] = &(*p);
5852     }
5853
5854   Arm_exidx_fixup exidx_fixup(this, merge_exidx_entries);
5855
5856   // Go over the sorted text sections.
5857   typedef Unordered_set<Section_id, Section_id_hash> Section_id_set;
5858   Section_id_set processed_input_sections;
5859   for (Text_section_list::const_iterator p = sorted_text_sections.begin();
5860        p != sorted_text_sections.end();
5861        ++p)
5862     {
5863       Relobj* relobj = p->first;
5864       unsigned int shndx = p->second;
5865
5866       Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
5867          Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(relobj);
5868       const Arm_exidx_input_section* exidx_input_section =
5869          arm_relobj->exidx_input_section_by_link(shndx);
5870
5871       // If this text section has no EXIDX section or if the EXIDX section
5872       // has errors, force an EXIDX_CANTUNWIND entry pointing to the end
5873       // of the last seen EXIDX section.
5874       if (exidx_input_section == NULL || exidx_input_section->has_errors())
5875         {
5876           exidx_fixup.add_exidx_cantunwind_as_needed();
5877           continue;
5878         }
5879
5880       Relobj* exidx_relobj = exidx_input_section->relobj();
5881       unsigned int exidx_shndx = exidx_input_section->shndx();
5882       Section_id sid(exidx_relobj, exidx_shndx);
5883       Text_to_exidx_map::const_iterator iter = text_to_exidx_map.find(sid);
5884       if (iter == text_to_exidx_map.end())
5885         {
5886           // This is odd.  We have not seen this EXIDX input section before.
5887           // We cannot do fix-up.  If we saw a SECTIONS clause in a script,
5888           // issue a warning instead.  We assume the user knows what he
5889           // or she is doing.  Otherwise, this is an error.
5890           if (layout->script_options()->saw_sections_clause())
5891             gold_warning(_("unwinding may not work because EXIDX input section"
5892                            " %u of %s is not in EXIDX output section"),
5893                          exidx_shndx, exidx_relobj->name().c_str());
5894           else
5895             gold_error(_("unwinding may not work because EXIDX input section"
5896                          " %u of %s is not in EXIDX output section"),
5897                        exidx_shndx, exidx_relobj->name().c_str());
5898
5899           exidx_fixup.add_exidx_cantunwind_as_needed();
5900           continue;
5901         }
5902
5903       // We need to access the contents of the EXIDX section, lock the
5904       // object here.
5905       Task_lock_obj<Object> tl(task, exidx_relobj);
5906       section_size_type exidx_size;
5907       const unsigned char* exidx_contents =
5908         exidx_relobj->section_contents(exidx_shndx, &exidx_size, false); 
5909
5910       // Fix up coverage and append input section to output data list.
5911       Arm_exidx_section_offset_map* section_offset_map = NULL;
5912       uint32_t deleted_bytes =
5913         exidx_fixup.process_exidx_section<big_endian>(exidx_input_section,
5914                                                       exidx_contents,
5915                                                       exidx_size,
5916                                                       &section_offset_map);
5917
5918       if (deleted_bytes == exidx_input_section->size())
5919         {
5920           // The whole EXIDX section got merged.  Remove it from output.
5921           gold_assert(section_offset_map == NULL);
5922           exidx_relobj->set_output_section(exidx_shndx, NULL);
5923
5924           // All local symbols defined in this input section will be dropped.
5925           // We need to adjust output local symbol count.
5926           arm_relobj->set_output_local_symbol_count_needs_update();
5927         }
5928       else if (deleted_bytes > 0)
5929         {
5930           // Some entries are merged.  We need to convert this EXIDX input
5931           // section into a relaxed section.
5932           gold_assert(section_offset_map != NULL);
5933
5934           Arm_exidx_merged_section* merged_section =
5935             new Arm_exidx_merged_section(*exidx_input_section,
5936                                          *section_offset_map, deleted_bytes);
5937           merged_section->build_contents(exidx_contents, exidx_size);
5938
5939           const std::string secname = exidx_relobj->section_name(exidx_shndx);
5940           this->add_relaxed_input_section(layout, merged_section, secname);
5941           arm_relobj->convert_input_section_to_relaxed_section(exidx_shndx);
5942
5943           // All local symbols defined in discarded portions of this input
5944           // section will be dropped.  We need to adjust output local symbol
5945           // count.
5946           arm_relobj->set_output_local_symbol_count_needs_update();
5947         }
5948       else
5949         {
5950           // Just add back the EXIDX input section.
5951           gold_assert(section_offset_map == NULL);
5952           const Output_section::Input_section* pis = iter->second;
5953           gold_assert(pis->is_input_section());
5954           this->add_script_input_section(*pis);
5955         }
5956
5957       processed_input_sections.insert(Section_id(exidx_relobj, exidx_shndx)); 
5958     }
5959
5960   // Insert an EXIDX_CANTUNWIND entry at the end of output if necessary.
5961   exidx_fixup.add_exidx_cantunwind_as_needed();
5962
5963   // Remove any known EXIDX input sections that are not processed.
5964   for (Input_section_list::const_iterator p = input_sections.begin();
5965        p != input_sections.end();
5966        ++p)
5967     {
5968       if (processed_input_sections.find(Section_id(p->relobj(), p->shndx()))
5969           == processed_input_sections.end())
5970         {
5971           // We discard a known EXIDX section because its linked
5972           // text section has been folded by ICF.  We also discard an
5973           // EXIDX section with error, the output does not matter in this
5974           // case.  We do this to avoid triggering asserts.
5975           Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
5976             Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(p->relobj());
5977           const Arm_exidx_input_section* exidx_input_section =
5978             arm_relobj->exidx_input_section_by_shndx(p->shndx());
5979           gold_assert(exidx_input_section != NULL);
5980           if (!exidx_input_section->has_errors())
5981             {
5982               unsigned int text_shndx = exidx_input_section->link();
5983               gold_assert(symtab->is_section_folded(p->relobj(), text_shndx));
5984             }
5985
5986           // Remove this from link.  We also need to recount the
5987           // local symbols.
5988           p->relobj()->set_output_section(p->shndx(), NULL);
5989           arm_relobj->set_output_local_symbol_count_needs_update();
5990         }
5991     }
5992     
5993   // Link exidx output section to the first seen output section and
5994   // set correct entry size.
5995   this->set_link_section(exidx_fixup.first_output_text_section());
5996   this->set_entsize(8);
5997
5998   // Make changes permanent.
5999   this->save_states();
6000   this->set_section_offsets_need_adjustment();
6001 }
6002
6003 // Link EXIDX output sections to text output sections.
6004
6005 template<bool big_endian>
6006 void
6007 Arm_output_section<big_endian>::set_exidx_section_link()
6008 {
6009   gold_assert(this->type() == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_EXIDX);
6010   if (!this->input_sections().empty())
6011     {
6012       Input_section_list::const_iterator p = this->input_sections().begin();
6013       Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
6014         Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(p->relobj());
6015       unsigned exidx_shndx = p->shndx();
6016       const Arm_exidx_input_section* exidx_input_section =
6017         arm_relobj->exidx_input_section_by_shndx(exidx_shndx);
6018       gold_assert(exidx_input_section != NULL);
6019       unsigned int text_shndx = exidx_input_section->link();
6020       Output_section* os = arm_relobj->output_section(text_shndx);
6021       this->set_link_section(os);
6022     }
6023 }
6024
6025 // Arm_relobj methods.
6026
6027 // Determine if an input section is scannable for stub processing.  SHDR is
6028 // the header of the section and SHNDX is the section index.  OS is the output
6029 // section for the input section and SYMTAB is the global symbol table used to
6030 // look up ICF information.
6031
6032 template<bool big_endian>
6033 bool
6034 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::section_is_scannable(
6035     const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>& shdr,
6036     unsigned int shndx,
6037     const Output_section* os,
6038     const Symbol_table* symtab)
6039 {
6040   // Skip any empty sections, unallocated sections or sections whose
6041   // type are not SHT_PROGBITS.
6042   if (shdr.get_sh_size() == 0
6043       || (shdr.get_sh_flags() & elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC) == 0
6044       || shdr.get_sh_type() != elfcpp::SHT_PROGBITS)
6045     return false;
6046
6047   // Skip any discarded or ICF'ed sections.
6048   if (os == NULL || symtab->is_section_folded(this, shndx))
6049     return false;
6050
6051   // If this requires special offset handling, check to see if it is
6052   // a relaxed section.  If this is not, then it is a merged section that
6053   // we cannot handle.
6054   if (this->is_output_section_offset_invalid(shndx))
6055     {
6056       const Output_relaxed_input_section* poris =
6057         os->find_relaxed_input_section(this, shndx);
6058       if (poris == NULL)
6059         return false;
6060     }
6061
6062   return true;
6063 }
6064
6065 // Determine if we want to scan the SHNDX-th section for relocation stubs.
6066 // This is a helper for Arm_relobj::scan_sections_for_stubs() below.
6067
6068 template<bool big_endian>
6069 bool
6070 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::section_needs_reloc_stub_scanning(
6071     const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>& shdr,
6072     const Relobj::Output_sections& out_sections,
6073     const Symbol_table* symtab,
6074     const unsigned char* pshdrs)
6075 {
6076   unsigned int sh_type = shdr.get_sh_type();
6077   if (sh_type != elfcpp::SHT_REL && sh_type != elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
6078     return false;
6079
6080   // Ignore empty section.
6081   off_t sh_size = shdr.get_sh_size();
6082   if (sh_size == 0)
6083     return false;
6084
6085   // Ignore reloc section with unexpected symbol table.  The
6086   // error will be reported in the final link.
6087   if (this->adjust_shndx(shdr.get_sh_link()) != this->symtab_shndx())
6088     return false;
6089
6090   unsigned int reloc_size;
6091   if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
6092     reloc_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::rel_size;
6093   else
6094     reloc_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::rela_size;
6095
6096   // Ignore reloc section with unexpected entsize or uneven size.
6097   // The error will be reported in the final link.
6098   if (reloc_size != shdr.get_sh_entsize() || sh_size % reloc_size != 0)
6099     return false;
6100
6101   // Ignore reloc section with bad info.  This error will be
6102   // reported in the final link.
6103   unsigned int index = this->adjust_shndx(shdr.get_sh_info());
6104   if (index >= this->shnum())
6105     return false;
6106
6107   const unsigned int shdr_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::shdr_size;
6108   const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> text_shdr(pshdrs + index * shdr_size);
6109   return this->section_is_scannable(text_shdr, index,
6110                                    out_sections[index], symtab);
6111 }
6112
6113 // Return the output address of either a plain input section or a relaxed
6114 // input section.  SHNDX is the section index.  We define and use this
6115 // instead of calling Output_section::output_address because that is slow
6116 // for large output.
6117
6118 template<bool big_endian>
6119 Arm_address
6120 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::simple_input_section_output_address(
6121     unsigned int shndx,
6122     Output_section* os)
6123 {
6124   if (this->is_output_section_offset_invalid(shndx))
6125     {
6126       const Output_relaxed_input_section* poris =
6127         os->find_relaxed_input_section(this, shndx);
6128       // We do not handle merged sections here.
6129       gold_assert(poris != NULL);
6130       return poris->address();
6131     }
6132   else
6133     return os->address() + this->get_output_section_offset(shndx);
6134 }
6135
6136 // Determine if we want to scan the SHNDX-th section for non-relocation stubs.
6137 // This is a helper for Arm_relobj::scan_sections_for_stubs() below.
6138
6139 template<bool big_endian>
6140 bool
6141 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::section_needs_cortex_a8_stub_scanning(
6142     const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>& shdr,
6143     unsigned int shndx,
6144     Output_section* os,
6145     const Symbol_table* symtab)
6146 {
6147   if (!this->section_is_scannable(shdr, shndx, os, symtab))
6148     return false;
6149
6150   // If the section does not cross any 4K-boundaries, it does not need to
6151   // be scanned.
6152   Arm_address address = this->simple_input_section_output_address(shndx, os);
6153   if ((address & ~0xfffU) == ((address + shdr.get_sh_size() - 1) & ~0xfffU))
6154     return false;
6155
6156   return true;
6157 }
6158
6159 // Scan a section for Cortex-A8 workaround.
6160
6161 template<bool big_endian>
6162 void
6163 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::scan_section_for_cortex_a8_erratum(
6164     const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>& shdr,
6165     unsigned int shndx,
6166     Output_section* os,
6167     Target_arm<big_endian>* arm_target)
6168 {
6169   // Look for the first mapping symbol in this section.  It should be
6170   // at (shndx, 0).
6171   Mapping_symbol_position section_start(shndx, 0);
6172   typename Mapping_symbols_info::const_iterator p =
6173     this->mapping_symbols_info_.lower_bound(section_start);
6174
6175   // There are no mapping symbols for this section.  Treat it as a data-only
6176   // section.  Issue a warning if section is marked as containing
6177   // instructions.
6178   if (p == this->mapping_symbols_info_.end() || p->first.first != shndx)
6179     {
6180       if ((this->section_flags(shndx) & elfcpp::SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
6181         gold_warning(_("cannot scan executable section %u of %s for Cortex-A8 "
6182                        "erratum because it has no mapping symbols."),
6183                      shndx, this->name().c_str());
6184       return;
6185     }
6186
6187   Arm_address output_address =
6188     this->simple_input_section_output_address(shndx, os);
6189
6190   // Get the section contents.
6191   section_size_type input_view_size = 0;
6192   const unsigned char* input_view =
6193     this->section_contents(shndx, &input_view_size, false);
6194
6195   // We need to go through the mapping symbols to determine what to
6196   // scan.  There are two reasons.  First, we should look at THUMB code and
6197   // THUMB code only.  Second, we only want to look at the 4K-page boundary
6198   // to speed up the scanning.
6199   
6200   while (p != this->mapping_symbols_info_.end()
6201         && p->first.first == shndx)
6202     {
6203       typename Mapping_symbols_info::const_iterator next =
6204         this->mapping_symbols_info_.upper_bound(p->first);
6205
6206       // Only scan part of a section with THUMB code.
6207       if (p->second == 't')
6208         {
6209           // Determine the end of this range.
6210           section_size_type span_start =
6211             convert_to_section_size_type(p->first.second);
6212           section_size_type span_end;
6213           if (next != this->mapping_symbols_info_.end()
6214               && next->first.first == shndx)
6215             span_end = convert_to_section_size_type(next->first.second);
6216           else
6217             span_end = convert_to_section_size_type(shdr.get_sh_size());
6218           
6219           if (((span_start + output_address) & ~0xfffUL)
6220               != ((span_end + output_address - 1) & ~0xfffUL))
6221             {
6222               arm_target->scan_span_for_cortex_a8_erratum(this, shndx,
6223                                                           span_start, span_end,
6224                                                           input_view,
6225                                                           output_address);
6226             }
6227         }
6228
6229       p = next; 
6230     }
6231 }
6232
6233 // Scan relocations for stub generation.
6234
6235 template<bool big_endian>
6236 void
6237 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::scan_sections_for_stubs(
6238     Target_arm<big_endian>* arm_target,
6239     const Symbol_table* symtab,
6240     const Layout* layout)
6241 {
6242   unsigned int shnum = this->shnum();
6243   const unsigned int shdr_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::shdr_size;
6244
6245   // Read the section headers.
6246   const unsigned char* pshdrs = this->get_view(this->elf_file()->shoff(),
6247                                                shnum * shdr_size,
6248                                                true, true);
6249
6250   // To speed up processing, we set up hash tables for fast lookup of
6251   // input offsets to output addresses.
6252   this->initialize_input_to_output_maps();
6253
6254   const Relobj::Output_sections& out_sections(this->output_sections());
6255
6256   Relocate_info<32, big_endian> relinfo;
6257   relinfo.symtab = symtab;
6258   relinfo.layout = layout;
6259   relinfo.object = this;
6260
6261   // Do relocation stubs scanning.
6262   const unsigned char* p = pshdrs + shdr_size;
6263   for (unsigned int i = 1; i < shnum; ++i, p += shdr_size)
6264     {
6265       const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> shdr(p);
6266       if (this->section_needs_reloc_stub_scanning(shdr, out_sections, symtab,
6267                                                   pshdrs))
6268         {
6269           unsigned int index = this->adjust_shndx(shdr.get_sh_info());
6270           Arm_address output_offset = this->get_output_section_offset(index);
6271           Arm_address output_address;
6272           if (output_offset != invalid_address)
6273             output_address = out_sections[index]->address() + output_offset;
6274           else
6275             {
6276               // Currently this only happens for a relaxed section.
6277               const Output_relaxed_input_section* poris =
6278               out_sections[index]->find_relaxed_input_section(this, index);
6279               gold_assert(poris != NULL);
6280               output_address = poris->address();
6281             }
6282
6283           // Get the relocations.
6284           const unsigned char* prelocs = this->get_view(shdr.get_sh_offset(),
6285                                                         shdr.get_sh_size(),
6286                                                         true, false);
6287
6288           // Get the section contents.  This does work for the case in which
6289           // we modify the contents of an input section.  We need to pass the
6290           // output view under such circumstances.
6291           section_size_type input_view_size = 0;
6292           const unsigned char* input_view =
6293             this->section_contents(index, &input_view_size, false);
6294
6295           relinfo.reloc_shndx = i;
6296           relinfo.data_shndx = index;
6297           unsigned int sh_type = shdr.get_sh_type();
6298           unsigned int reloc_size;
6299           if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
6300             reloc_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::rel_size;
6301           else
6302             reloc_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::rela_size;
6303
6304           Output_section* os = out_sections[index];
6305           arm_target->scan_section_for_stubs(&relinfo, sh_type, prelocs,
6306                                              shdr.get_sh_size() / reloc_size,
6307                                              os,
6308                                              output_offset == invalid_address,
6309                                              input_view, output_address,
6310                                              input_view_size);
6311         }
6312     }
6313
6314   // Do Cortex-A8 erratum stubs scanning.  This has to be done for a section
6315   // after its relocation section, if there is one, is processed for
6316   // relocation stubs.  Merging this loop with the one above would have been
6317   // complicated since we would have had to make sure that relocation stub
6318   // scanning is done first.
6319   if (arm_target->fix_cortex_a8())
6320     {
6321       const unsigned char* p = pshdrs + shdr_size;
6322       for (unsigned int i = 1; i < shnum; ++i, p += shdr_size)
6323         {
6324           const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> shdr(p);
6325           if (this->section_needs_cortex_a8_stub_scanning(shdr, i,
6326                                                           out_sections[i],
6327                                                           symtab))
6328             this->scan_section_for_cortex_a8_erratum(shdr, i, out_sections[i],
6329                                                      arm_target);
6330         }
6331     }
6332
6333   // After we've done the relocations, we release the hash tables,
6334   // since we no longer need them.
6335   this->free_input_to_output_maps();
6336 }
6337
6338 // Count the local symbols.  The ARM backend needs to know if a symbol
6339 // is a THUMB function or not.  For global symbols, it is easy because
6340 // the Symbol object keeps the ELF symbol type.  For local symbol it is
6341 // harder because we cannot access this information.   So we override the
6342 // do_count_local_symbol in parent and scan local symbols to mark
6343 // THUMB functions.  This is not the most efficient way but I do not want to
6344 // slow down other ports by calling a per symbol target hook inside
6345 // Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>::do_count_local_symbols. 
6346
6347 template<bool big_endian>
6348 void
6349 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::do_count_local_symbols(
6350     Stringpool_template<char>* pool,
6351     Stringpool_template<char>* dynpool)
6352 {
6353   // We need to fix-up the values of any local symbols whose type are
6354   // STT_ARM_TFUNC.
6355   
6356   // Ask parent to count the local symbols.
6357   Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>::do_count_local_symbols(pool, dynpool);
6358   const unsigned int loccount = this->local_symbol_count();
6359   if (loccount == 0)
6360     return;
6361
6362   // Initialize the thumb function bit-vector.
6363   std::vector<bool> empty_vector(loccount, false);
6364   this->local_symbol_is_thumb_function_.swap(empty_vector);
6365
6366   // Read the symbol table section header.
6367   const unsigned int symtab_shndx = this->symtab_shndx();
6368   elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>
6369       symtabshdr(this, this->elf_file()->section_header(symtab_shndx));
6370   gold_assert(symtabshdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_SYMTAB);
6371
6372   // Read the local symbols.
6373   const int sym_size =elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::sym_size;
6374   gold_assert(loccount == symtabshdr.get_sh_info());
6375   off_t locsize = loccount * sym_size;
6376   const unsigned char* psyms = this->get_view(symtabshdr.get_sh_offset(),
6377                                               locsize, true, true);
6378
6379   // For mapping symbol processing, we need to read the symbol names.
6380   unsigned int strtab_shndx = this->adjust_shndx(symtabshdr.get_sh_link());
6381   if (strtab_shndx >= this->shnum())
6382     {
6383       this->error(_("invalid symbol table name index: %u"), strtab_shndx);
6384       return;
6385     }
6386
6387   elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>
6388     strtabshdr(this, this->elf_file()->section_header(strtab_shndx));
6389   if (strtabshdr.get_sh_type() != elfcpp::SHT_STRTAB)
6390     {
6391       this->error(_("symbol table name section has wrong type: %u"),
6392                   static_cast<unsigned int>(strtabshdr.get_sh_type()));
6393       return;
6394     }
6395   const char* pnames =
6396     reinterpret_cast<const char*>(this->get_view(strtabshdr.get_sh_offset(),
6397                                                  strtabshdr.get_sh_size(),
6398                                                  false, false));
6399
6400   // Loop over the local symbols and mark any local symbols pointing
6401   // to THUMB functions.
6402
6403   // Skip the first dummy symbol.
6404   psyms += sym_size;
6405   typename Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>::Local_values* plocal_values =
6406     this->local_values();
6407   for (unsigned int i = 1; i < loccount; ++i, psyms += sym_size)
6408     {
6409       elfcpp::Sym<32, big_endian> sym(psyms);
6410       elfcpp::STT st_type = sym.get_st_type();
6411       Symbol_value<32>& lv((*plocal_values)[i]);
6412       Arm_address input_value = lv.input_value();
6413
6414       // Check to see if this is a mapping symbol.
6415       const char* sym_name = pnames + sym.get_st_name();
6416       if (Target_arm<big_endian>::is_mapping_symbol_name(sym_name))
6417         {
6418           bool is_ordinary;
6419           unsigned int input_shndx =
6420             this->adjust_sym_shndx(i, sym.get_st_shndx(), &is_ordinary);
6421           gold_assert(is_ordinary);
6422
6423           // Strip of LSB in case this is a THUMB symbol.
6424           Mapping_symbol_position msp(input_shndx, input_value & ~1U);
6425           this->mapping_symbols_info_[msp] = sym_name[1];
6426         }
6427
6428       if (st_type == elfcpp::STT_ARM_TFUNC
6429           || (st_type == elfcpp::STT_FUNC && ((input_value & 1) != 0)))
6430         {
6431           // This is a THUMB function.  Mark this and canonicalize the
6432           // symbol value by setting LSB.
6433           this->local_symbol_is_thumb_function_[i] = true;
6434           if ((input_value & 1) == 0)
6435             lv.set_input_value(input_value | 1);
6436         }
6437     }
6438 }
6439
6440 // Relocate sections.
6441 template<bool big_endian>
6442 void
6443 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::do_relocate_sections(
6444     const Symbol_table* symtab,
6445     const Layout* layout,
6446     const unsigned char* pshdrs,
6447     Output_file* of,
6448     typename Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>::Views* pviews)
6449 {
6450   // Call parent to relocate sections.
6451   Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>::do_relocate_sections(symtab, layout,
6452                                                           pshdrs, of, pviews); 
6453
6454   // We do not generate stubs if doing a relocatable link.
6455   if (parameters->options().relocatable())
6456     return;
6457
6458   // Relocate stub tables.
6459   unsigned int shnum = this->shnum();
6460
6461   Target_arm<big_endian>* arm_target =
6462     Target_arm<big_endian>::default_target();
6463
6464   Relocate_info<32, big_endian> relinfo;
6465   relinfo.symtab = symtab;
6466   relinfo.layout = layout;
6467   relinfo.object = this;
6468
6469   for (unsigned int i = 1; i < shnum; ++i)
6470     {
6471       Arm_input_section<big_endian>* arm_input_section =
6472         arm_target->find_arm_input_section(this, i);
6473
6474       if (arm_input_section != NULL
6475           && arm_input_section->is_stub_table_owner()
6476           && !arm_input_section->stub_table()->empty())
6477         {
6478           // We cannot discard a section if it owns a stub table.
6479           Output_section* os = this->output_section(i);
6480           gold_assert(os != NULL);
6481
6482           relinfo.reloc_shndx = elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF;
6483           relinfo.reloc_shdr = NULL;
6484           relinfo.data_shndx = i;
6485           relinfo.data_shdr = pshdrs + i * elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::shdr_size;
6486
6487           gold_assert((*pviews)[i].view != NULL);
6488
6489           // We are passed the output section view.  Adjust it to cover the
6490           // stub table only.
6491           Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table = arm_input_section->stub_table();
6492           gold_assert((stub_table->address() >= (*pviews)[i].address)
6493                       && ((stub_table->address() + stub_table->data_size())
6494                           <= (*pviews)[i].address + (*pviews)[i].view_size));
6495
6496           off_t offset = stub_table->address() - (*pviews)[i].address;
6497           unsigned char* view = (*pviews)[i].view + offset;
6498           Arm_address address = stub_table->address();
6499           section_size_type view_size = stub_table->data_size();
6500  
6501           stub_table->relocate_stubs(&relinfo, arm_target, os, view, address,
6502                                      view_size);
6503         }
6504
6505       // Apply Cortex A8 workaround if applicable.
6506       if (this->section_has_cortex_a8_workaround(i))
6507         {
6508           unsigned char* view = (*pviews)[i].view;
6509           Arm_address view_address = (*pviews)[i].address;
6510           section_size_type view_size = (*pviews)[i].view_size;
6511           Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table = this->stub_tables_[i];
6512
6513           // Adjust view to cover section.
6514           Output_section* os = this->output_section(i);
6515           gold_assert(os != NULL);
6516           Arm_address section_address =
6517             this->simple_input_section_output_address(i, os);
6518           uint64_t section_size = this->section_size(i);
6519
6520           gold_assert(section_address >= view_address
6521                       && ((section_address + section_size)
6522                           <= (view_address + view_size)));
6523
6524           unsigned char* section_view = view + (section_address - view_address);
6525
6526           // Apply the Cortex-A8 workaround to the output address range
6527           // corresponding to this input section.
6528           stub_table->apply_cortex_a8_workaround_to_address_range(
6529               arm_target,
6530               section_view,
6531               section_address,
6532               section_size);
6533         }
6534     }
6535 }
6536
6537 // Find the linked text section of an EXIDX section by looking at the first
6538 // relocation.  4.4.1 of the EHABI specifications says that an EXIDX section
6539 // must be linked to its associated code section via the sh_link field of
6540 // its section header.  However, some tools are broken and the link is not
6541 // always set.  LD just drops such an EXIDX section silently, causing the
6542 // associated code not unwindabled.   Here we try a little bit harder to
6543 // discover the linked code section.
6544 //
6545 // PSHDR points to the section header of a relocation section of an EXIDX
6546 // section.  If we can find a linked text section, return true and
6547 // store the text section index in the location PSHNDX.  Otherwise
6548 // return false.
6549
6550 template<bool big_endian>
6551 bool
6552 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::find_linked_text_section(
6553     const unsigned char* pshdr,
6554     const unsigned char* psyms,
6555     unsigned int* pshndx)
6556 {
6557   elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> shdr(pshdr);
6558   
6559   // If there is no relocation, we cannot find the linked text section.
6560   size_t reloc_size;
6561   if (shdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
6562       reloc_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::rel_size;
6563   else
6564       reloc_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::rela_size;
6565   size_t reloc_count = shdr.get_sh_size() / reloc_size;
6566  
6567   // Get the relocations.
6568   const unsigned char* prelocs =
6569       this->get_view(shdr.get_sh_offset(), shdr.get_sh_size(), true, false); 
6570
6571   // Find the REL31 relocation for the first word of the first EXIDX entry.
6572   for (size_t i = 0; i < reloc_count; ++i, prelocs += reloc_size)
6573     {
6574       Arm_address r_offset;
6575       typename elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_WXword r_info;
6576       if (shdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
6577         {
6578           typename elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian> reloc(prelocs);
6579           r_info = reloc.get_r_info();
6580           r_offset = reloc.get_r_offset();
6581         }
6582       else
6583         {
6584           typename elfcpp::Rela<32, big_endian> reloc(prelocs);
6585           r_info = reloc.get_r_info();
6586           r_offset = reloc.get_r_offset();
6587         }
6588
6589       unsigned int r_type = elfcpp::elf_r_type<32>(r_info);
6590       if (r_type != elfcpp::R_ARM_PREL31 && r_type != elfcpp::R_ARM_SBREL31)
6591         continue;
6592
6593       unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(r_info);
6594       if (r_sym == 0
6595           || r_sym >= this->local_symbol_count()
6596           || r_offset != 0)
6597         continue;
6598
6599       // This is the relocation for the first word of the first EXIDX entry.
6600       // We expect to see a local section symbol.
6601       const int sym_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::sym_size;
6602       elfcpp::Sym<32, big_endian> sym(psyms + r_sym * sym_size);
6603       if (sym.get_st_type() == elfcpp::STT_SECTION)
6604         {
6605           bool is_ordinary;
6606           *pshndx =
6607             this->adjust_sym_shndx(r_sym, sym.get_st_shndx(), &is_ordinary);
6608           gold_assert(is_ordinary);
6609           return true;
6610         }
6611       else
6612         return false;
6613     }
6614
6615   return false;
6616 }
6617
6618 // Make an EXIDX input section object for an EXIDX section whose index is
6619 // SHNDX.  SHDR is the section header of the EXIDX section and TEXT_SHNDX
6620 // is the section index of the linked text section.
6621
6622 template<bool big_endian>
6623 void
6624 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::make_exidx_input_section(
6625     unsigned int shndx,
6626     const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>& shdr,
6627     unsigned int text_shndx,
6628     const elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>& text_shdr)
6629 {
6630   // Create an Arm_exidx_input_section object for this EXIDX section.
6631   Arm_exidx_input_section* exidx_input_section =
6632     new Arm_exidx_input_section(this, shndx, text_shndx, shdr.get_sh_size(),
6633                                 shdr.get_sh_addralign(),
6634                                 text_shdr.get_sh_size());
6635
6636   gold_assert(this->exidx_section_map_[shndx] == NULL);
6637   this->exidx_section_map_[shndx] = exidx_input_section;
6638
6639   if (text_shndx == elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF || text_shndx >= this->shnum())
6640     {
6641       gold_error(_("EXIDX section %s(%u) links to invalid section %u in %s"),
6642                  this->section_name(shndx).c_str(), shndx, text_shndx,
6643                  this->name().c_str());
6644       exidx_input_section->set_has_errors();
6645     } 
6646   else if (this->exidx_section_map_[text_shndx] != NULL)
6647     {
6648       unsigned other_exidx_shndx =
6649         this->exidx_section_map_[text_shndx]->shndx();
6650       gold_error(_("EXIDX sections %s(%u) and %s(%u) both link to text section"
6651                    "%s(%u) in %s"),
6652                  this->section_name(shndx).c_str(), shndx,
6653                  this->section_name(other_exidx_shndx).c_str(),
6654                  other_exidx_shndx, this->section_name(text_shndx).c_str(),
6655                  text_shndx, this->name().c_str());
6656       exidx_input_section->set_has_errors();
6657     }
6658   else
6659      this->exidx_section_map_[text_shndx] = exidx_input_section;
6660
6661   // Check section flags of text section.
6662   if ((text_shdr.get_sh_flags() & elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC) == 0)
6663     {
6664       gold_error(_("EXIDX section %s(%u) links to non-allocated section %s(%u) "
6665                    " in %s"),
6666                  this->section_name(shndx).c_str(), shndx,
6667                  this->section_name(text_shndx).c_str(), text_shndx,
6668                  this->name().c_str());
6669       exidx_input_section->set_has_errors();
6670     }
6671   else if ((text_shdr.get_sh_flags() & elfcpp::SHF_EXECINSTR) == 0)
6672     // I would like to make this an error but currently ld just ignores
6673     // this.
6674     gold_warning(_("EXIDX section %s(%u) links to non-executable section "
6675                    "%s(%u) in %s"),
6676                  this->section_name(shndx).c_str(), shndx,
6677                  this->section_name(text_shndx).c_str(), text_shndx,
6678                  this->name().c_str());
6679 }
6680
6681 // Read the symbol information.
6682
6683 template<bool big_endian>
6684 void
6685 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::do_read_symbols(Read_symbols_data* sd)
6686 {
6687   // Call parent class to read symbol information.
6688   Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>::do_read_symbols(sd);
6689
6690   // If this input file is a binary file, it has no processor
6691   // specific flags and attributes section.
6692   Input_file::Format format = this->input_file()->format();
6693   if (format != Input_file::FORMAT_ELF)
6694     {
6695       gold_assert(format == Input_file::FORMAT_BINARY);
6696       this->merge_flags_and_attributes_ = false;
6697       return;
6698     }
6699
6700   // Read processor-specific flags in ELF file header.
6701   const unsigned char* pehdr = this->get_view(elfcpp::file_header_offset,
6702                                               elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::ehdr_size,
6703                                               true, false);
6704   elfcpp::Ehdr<32, big_endian> ehdr(pehdr);
6705   this->processor_specific_flags_ = ehdr.get_e_flags();
6706
6707   // Go over the section headers and look for .ARM.attributes and .ARM.exidx
6708   // sections.
6709   std::vector<unsigned int> deferred_exidx_sections;
6710   const size_t shdr_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::shdr_size;
6711   const unsigned char* pshdrs = sd->section_headers->data();
6712   const unsigned char* ps = pshdrs + shdr_size;
6713   bool must_merge_flags_and_attributes = false;
6714   for (unsigned int i = 1; i < this->shnum(); ++i, ps += shdr_size)
6715     {
6716       elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> shdr(ps);
6717
6718       // Sometimes an object has no contents except the section name string
6719       // table and an empty symbol table with the undefined symbol.  We
6720       // don't want to merge processor-specific flags from such an object.
6721       if (shdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_SYMTAB)
6722         {
6723           // Symbol table is not empty.
6724           const elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_WXword sym_size =
6725              elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::sym_size;
6726           if (shdr.get_sh_size() > sym_size)
6727             must_merge_flags_and_attributes = true;
6728         }
6729       else if (shdr.get_sh_type() != elfcpp::SHT_STRTAB)
6730         // If this is neither an empty symbol table nor a string table,
6731         // be conservative.
6732         must_merge_flags_and_attributes = true;
6733
6734       if (shdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_ATTRIBUTES)
6735         {
6736           gold_assert(this->attributes_section_data_ == NULL);
6737           section_offset_type section_offset = shdr.get_sh_offset();
6738           section_size_type section_size =
6739             convert_to_section_size_type(shdr.get_sh_size());
6740           const unsigned char* view =
6741              this->get_view(section_offset, section_size, true, false);
6742           this->attributes_section_data_ =
6743             new Attributes_section_data(view, section_size);
6744         }
6745       else if (shdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_EXIDX)
6746         {
6747           unsigned int text_shndx = this->adjust_shndx(shdr.get_sh_link());
6748           if (text_shndx == elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF)
6749             deferred_exidx_sections.push_back(i);
6750           else
6751             {
6752               elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> text_shdr(pshdrs
6753                                                      + text_shndx * shdr_size);
6754               this->make_exidx_input_section(i, shdr, text_shndx, text_shdr);
6755             }
6756           // EHABI 4.4.1 requires that SHF_LINK_ORDER flag to be set.
6757           if ((shdr.get_sh_flags() & elfcpp::SHF_LINK_ORDER) == 0)
6758             gold_warning(_("SHF_LINK_ORDER not set in EXIDX section %s of %s"),
6759                          this->section_name(i).c_str(), this->name().c_str());
6760         }
6761     }
6762
6763   // This is rare.
6764   if (!must_merge_flags_and_attributes)
6765     {
6766       gold_assert(deferred_exidx_sections.empty());
6767       this->merge_flags_and_attributes_ = false;
6768       return;
6769     }
6770
6771   // Some tools are broken and they do not set the link of EXIDX sections. 
6772   // We look at the first relocation to figure out the linked sections.
6773   if (!deferred_exidx_sections.empty())
6774     {
6775       // We need to go over the section headers again to find the mapping
6776       // from sections being relocated to their relocation sections.  This is
6777       // a bit inefficient as we could do that in the loop above.  However,
6778       // we do not expect any deferred EXIDX sections normally.  So we do not
6779       // want to slow down the most common path.
6780       typedef Unordered_map<unsigned int, unsigned int> Reloc_map;
6781       Reloc_map reloc_map;
6782       ps = pshdrs + shdr_size;
6783       for (unsigned int i = 1; i < this->shnum(); ++i, ps += shdr_size)
6784         {
6785           elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> shdr(ps);
6786           elfcpp::Elf_Word sh_type = shdr.get_sh_type();
6787           if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL || sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
6788             {
6789               unsigned int info_shndx = this->adjust_shndx(shdr.get_sh_info());
6790               if (info_shndx >= this->shnum())
6791                 gold_error(_("relocation section %u has invalid info %u"),
6792                            i, info_shndx);
6793               Reloc_map::value_type value(info_shndx, i);
6794               std::pair<Reloc_map::iterator, bool> result =
6795                 reloc_map.insert(value);
6796               if (!result.second)
6797                 gold_error(_("section %u has multiple relocation sections "
6798                              "%u and %u"),
6799                            info_shndx, i, reloc_map[info_shndx]);
6800             }
6801         }
6802
6803       // Read the symbol table section header.
6804       const unsigned int symtab_shndx = this->symtab_shndx();
6805       elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>
6806           symtabshdr(this, this->elf_file()->section_header(symtab_shndx));
6807       gold_assert(symtabshdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_SYMTAB);
6808
6809       // Read the local symbols.
6810       const int sym_size =elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::sym_size;
6811       const unsigned int loccount = this->local_symbol_count();
6812       gold_assert(loccount == symtabshdr.get_sh_info());
6813       off_t locsize = loccount * sym_size;
6814       const unsigned char* psyms = this->get_view(symtabshdr.get_sh_offset(),
6815                                                   locsize, true, true);
6816
6817       // Process the deferred EXIDX sections. 
6818       for (unsigned int i = 0; i < deferred_exidx_sections.size(); ++i)
6819         {
6820           unsigned int shndx = deferred_exidx_sections[i];
6821           elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> shdr(pshdrs + shndx * shdr_size);
6822           unsigned int text_shndx = elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF;
6823           Reloc_map::const_iterator it = reloc_map.find(shndx);
6824           if (it != reloc_map.end())
6825             find_linked_text_section(pshdrs + it->second * shdr_size,
6826                                      psyms, &text_shndx);
6827           elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> text_shdr(pshdrs
6828                                                  + text_shndx * shdr_size);
6829           this->make_exidx_input_section(shndx, shdr, text_shndx, text_shdr);
6830         }
6831     }
6832 }
6833
6834 // Process relocations for garbage collection.  The ARM target uses .ARM.exidx
6835 // sections for unwinding.  These sections are referenced implicitly by 
6836 // text sections linked in the section headers.  If we ignore these implicit
6837 // references, the .ARM.exidx sections and any .ARM.extab sections they use
6838 // will be garbage-collected incorrectly.  Hence we override the same function
6839 // in the base class to handle these implicit references.
6840
6841 template<bool big_endian>
6842 void
6843 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::do_gc_process_relocs(Symbol_table* symtab,
6844                                              Layout* layout,
6845                                              Read_relocs_data* rd)
6846 {
6847   // First, call base class method to process relocations in this object.
6848   Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>::do_gc_process_relocs(symtab, layout, rd);
6849
6850   // If --gc-sections is not specified, there is nothing more to do.
6851   // This happens when --icf is used but --gc-sections is not.
6852   if (!parameters->options().gc_sections())
6853     return;
6854   
6855   unsigned int shnum = this->shnum();
6856   const unsigned int shdr_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::shdr_size;
6857   const unsigned char* pshdrs = this->get_view(this->elf_file()->shoff(),
6858                                                shnum * shdr_size,
6859                                                true, true);
6860
6861   // Scan section headers for sections of type SHT_ARM_EXIDX.  Add references
6862   // to these from the linked text sections.
6863   const unsigned char* ps = pshdrs + shdr_size;
6864   for (unsigned int i = 1; i < shnum; ++i, ps += shdr_size)
6865     {
6866       elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> shdr(ps);
6867       if (shdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_EXIDX)
6868         {
6869           // Found an .ARM.exidx section, add it to the set of reachable
6870           // sections from its linked text section.
6871           unsigned int text_shndx = this->adjust_shndx(shdr.get_sh_link());
6872           symtab->gc()->add_reference(this, text_shndx, this, i);
6873         }
6874     }
6875 }
6876
6877 // Update output local symbol count.  Owing to EXIDX entry merging, some local
6878 // symbols  will be removed in output.  Adjust output local symbol count
6879 // accordingly.  We can only changed the static output local symbol count.  It
6880 // is too late to change the dynamic symbols.
6881
6882 template<bool big_endian>
6883 void
6884 Arm_relobj<big_endian>::update_output_local_symbol_count()
6885 {
6886   // Caller should check that this needs updating.  We want caller checking
6887   // because output_local_symbol_count_needs_update() is most likely inlined.
6888   gold_assert(this->output_local_symbol_count_needs_update_);
6889
6890   gold_assert(this->symtab_shndx() != -1U);
6891   if (this->symtab_shndx() == 0)
6892     {
6893       // This object has no symbols.  Weird but legal.
6894       return;
6895     }
6896
6897   // Read the symbol table section header.
6898   const unsigned int symtab_shndx = this->symtab_shndx();
6899   elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian>
6900     symtabshdr(this, this->elf_file()->section_header(symtab_shndx));
6901   gold_assert(symtabshdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_SYMTAB);
6902
6903   // Read the local symbols.
6904   const int sym_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::sym_size;
6905   const unsigned int loccount = this->local_symbol_count();
6906   gold_assert(loccount == symtabshdr.get_sh_info());
6907   off_t locsize = loccount * sym_size;
6908   const unsigned char* psyms = this->get_view(symtabshdr.get_sh_offset(),
6909                                               locsize, true, true);
6910
6911   // Loop over the local symbols.
6912
6913   typedef typename Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>::Output_sections
6914      Output_sections;
6915   const Output_sections& out_sections(this->output_sections());
6916   unsigned int shnum = this->shnum();
6917   unsigned int count = 0;
6918   // Skip the first, dummy, symbol.
6919   psyms += sym_size;
6920   for (unsigned int i = 1; i < loccount; ++i, psyms += sym_size)
6921     {
6922       elfcpp::Sym<32, big_endian> sym(psyms);
6923
6924       Symbol_value<32>& lv((*this->local_values())[i]);
6925
6926       // This local symbol was already discarded by do_count_local_symbols.
6927       if (lv.is_output_symtab_index_set() && !lv.has_output_symtab_entry())
6928         continue;
6929
6930       bool is_ordinary;
6931       unsigned int shndx = this->adjust_sym_shndx(i, sym.get_st_shndx(),
6932                                                   &is_ordinary);
6933
6934       if (shndx < shnum)
6935         {
6936           Output_section* os = out_sections[shndx];
6937
6938           // This local symbol no longer has an output section.  Discard it.
6939           if (os == NULL)
6940             {
6941               lv.set_no_output_symtab_entry();
6942               continue;
6943             }
6944
6945           // Currently we only discard parts of EXIDX input sections.
6946           // We explicitly check for a merged EXIDX input section to avoid
6947           // calling Output_section_data::output_offset unless necessary.
6948           if ((this->get_output_section_offset(shndx) == invalid_address)
6949               && (this->exidx_input_section_by_shndx(shndx) != NULL))
6950             {
6951               section_offset_type output_offset =
6952                 os->output_offset(this, shndx, lv.input_value());
6953               if (output_offset == -1)
6954                 {
6955                   // This symbol is defined in a part of an EXIDX input section
6956                   // that is discarded due to entry merging.
6957                   lv.set_no_output_symtab_entry();
6958                   continue;
6959                 }       
6960             }
6961         }
6962
6963       ++count;
6964     }
6965
6966   this->set_output_local_symbol_count(count);
6967   this->output_local_symbol_count_needs_update_ = false;
6968 }
6969
6970 // Arm_dynobj methods.
6971
6972 // Read the symbol information.
6973
6974 template<bool big_endian>
6975 void
6976 Arm_dynobj<big_endian>::do_read_symbols(Read_symbols_data* sd)
6977 {
6978   // Call parent class to read symbol information.
6979   Sized_dynobj<32, big_endian>::do_read_symbols(sd);
6980
6981   // Read processor-specific flags in ELF file header.
6982   const unsigned char* pehdr = this->get_view(elfcpp::file_header_offset,
6983                                               elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::ehdr_size,
6984                                               true, false);
6985   elfcpp::Ehdr<32, big_endian> ehdr(pehdr);
6986   this->processor_specific_flags_ = ehdr.get_e_flags();
6987
6988   // Read the attributes section if there is one.
6989   // We read from the end because gas seems to put it near the end of
6990   // the section headers.
6991   const size_t shdr_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::shdr_size;
6992   const unsigned char* ps =
6993     sd->section_headers->data() + shdr_size * (this->shnum() - 1);
6994   for (unsigned int i = this->shnum(); i > 0; --i, ps -= shdr_size)
6995     {
6996       elfcpp::Shdr<32, big_endian> shdr(ps);
6997       if (shdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_ATTRIBUTES)
6998         {
6999           section_offset_type section_offset = shdr.get_sh_offset();
7000           section_size_type section_size =
7001             convert_to_section_size_type(shdr.get_sh_size());
7002           const unsigned char* view =
7003             this->get_view(section_offset, section_size, true, false);
7004           this->attributes_section_data_ =
7005             new Attributes_section_data(view, section_size);
7006           break;
7007         }
7008     }
7009 }
7010
7011 // Stub_addend_reader methods.
7012
7013 // Read the addend of a REL relocation of type R_TYPE at VIEW.
7014
7015 template<bool big_endian>
7016 elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword
7017 Stub_addend_reader<elfcpp::SHT_REL, big_endian>::operator()(
7018     unsigned int r_type,
7019     const unsigned char* view,
7020     const typename Reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_REL, 32, big_endian>::Reloc&) const
7021 {
7022   typedef struct Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian> RelocFuncs;
7023   
7024   switch (r_type)
7025     {
7026     case elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL:
7027     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24:
7028     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32:
7029       {
7030         typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
7031         const Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<const Valtype*>(view);
7032         Valtype val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
7033         return utils::sign_extend<26>(val << 2);
7034       }
7035
7036     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL:
7037     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
7038     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_XPC22:
7039       {
7040         typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
7041         const Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<const Valtype*>(view);
7042         Valtype upper_insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
7043         Valtype lower_insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv + 1);
7044         return RelocFuncs::thumb32_branch_offset(upper_insn, lower_insn);
7045       }
7046
7047     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
7048       {
7049         typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
7050         const Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<const Valtype*>(view);
7051         Valtype upper_insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
7052         Valtype lower_insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv + 1);
7053         return RelocFuncs::thumb32_cond_branch_offset(upper_insn, lower_insn);
7054       }
7055
7056     default:
7057       gold_unreachable();
7058     }
7059 }
7060
7061 // Arm_output_data_got methods.
7062
7063 // Add a GOT pair for R_ARM_TLS_GD32.  The creates a pair of GOT entries.
7064 // The first one is initialized to be 1, which is the module index for
7065 // the main executable and the second one 0.  A reloc of the type
7066 // R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32 will be created for the second GOT entry and will
7067 // be applied by gold.  GSYM is a global symbol.
7068 //
7069 template<bool big_endian>
7070 void
7071 Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>::add_tls_gd32_with_static_reloc(
7072     unsigned int got_type,
7073     Symbol* gsym)
7074 {
7075   if (gsym->has_got_offset(got_type))
7076     return;
7077
7078   // We are doing a static link.  Just mark it as belong to module 1,
7079   // the executable.
7080   unsigned int got_offset = this->add_constant(1);
7081   gsym->set_got_offset(got_type, got_offset); 
7082   got_offset = this->add_constant(0);
7083   this->static_relocs_.push_back(Static_reloc(got_offset,
7084                                               elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32,
7085                                               gsym));
7086 }
7087
7088 // Same as the above but for a local symbol.
7089
7090 template<bool big_endian>
7091 void
7092 Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>::add_tls_gd32_with_static_reloc(
7093   unsigned int got_type,
7094   Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
7095   unsigned int index)
7096 {
7097   if (object->local_has_got_offset(index, got_type))
7098     return;
7099
7100   // We are doing a static link.  Just mark it as belong to module 1,
7101   // the executable.
7102   unsigned int got_offset = this->add_constant(1);
7103   object->set_local_got_offset(index, got_type, got_offset);
7104   got_offset = this->add_constant(0);
7105   this->static_relocs_.push_back(Static_reloc(got_offset, 
7106                                               elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32, 
7107                                               object, index));
7108 }
7109
7110 template<bool big_endian>
7111 void
7112 Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>::do_write(Output_file* of)
7113 {
7114   // Call parent to write out GOT.
7115   Output_data_got<32, big_endian>::do_write(of);
7116
7117   // We are done if there is no fix up.
7118   if (this->static_relocs_.empty())
7119     return;
7120
7121   gold_assert(parameters->doing_static_link());
7122
7123   const off_t offset = this->offset();
7124   const section_size_type oview_size =
7125     convert_to_section_size_type(this->data_size());
7126   unsigned char* const oview = of->get_output_view(offset, oview_size);
7127
7128   Output_segment* tls_segment = this->layout_->tls_segment();
7129   gold_assert(tls_segment != NULL);
7130   
7131   // The thread pointer $tp points to the TCB, which is followed by the
7132   // TLS.  So we need to adjust $tp relative addressing by this amount.
7133   Arm_address aligned_tcb_size =
7134     align_address(ARM_TCB_SIZE, tls_segment->maximum_alignment());
7135
7136   for (size_t i = 0; i < this->static_relocs_.size(); ++i)
7137     {
7138       Static_reloc& reloc(this->static_relocs_[i]);
7139       
7140       Arm_address value;
7141       if (!reloc.symbol_is_global())
7142         {
7143           Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object = reloc.relobj();
7144           const Symbol_value<32>* psymval =
7145             reloc.relobj()->local_symbol(reloc.index());
7146
7147           // We are doing static linking.  Issue an error and skip this
7148           // relocation if the symbol is undefined or in a discarded_section.
7149           bool is_ordinary;
7150           unsigned int shndx = psymval->input_shndx(&is_ordinary);
7151           if ((shndx == elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF)
7152               || (is_ordinary
7153                   && shndx != elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF
7154                   && !object->is_section_included(shndx)
7155                   && !this->symbol_table_->is_section_folded(object, shndx)))
7156             {
7157               gold_error(_("undefined or discarded local symbol %u from "
7158                            " object %s in GOT"),
7159                          reloc.index(), reloc.relobj()->name().c_str());
7160               continue;
7161             }
7162           
7163           value = psymval->value(object, 0);
7164         }
7165       else
7166         {
7167           const Symbol* gsym = reloc.symbol();
7168           gold_assert(gsym != NULL);
7169           if (gsym->is_forwarder())
7170             gsym = this->symbol_table_->resolve_forwards(gsym);
7171
7172           // We are doing static linking.  Issue an error and skip this
7173           // relocation if the symbol is undefined or in a discarded_section
7174           // unless it is a weakly_undefined symbol.
7175           if ((gsym->is_defined_in_discarded_section()
7176                || gsym->is_undefined())
7177               && !gsym->is_weak_undefined())
7178             {
7179               gold_error(_("undefined or discarded symbol %s in GOT"),
7180                          gsym->name());
7181               continue;
7182             }
7183
7184           if (!gsym->is_weak_undefined())
7185             {
7186               const Sized_symbol<32>* sym =
7187                 static_cast<const Sized_symbol<32>*>(gsym);
7188               value = sym->value();
7189             }
7190           else
7191               value = 0;
7192         }
7193
7194       unsigned got_offset = reloc.got_offset();
7195       gold_assert(got_offset < oview_size);
7196
7197       typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
7198       Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(oview + got_offset);
7199       Valtype x;
7200       switch (reloc.r_type())
7201         {
7202         case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32:
7203           x = value;
7204           break;
7205         case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32:
7206           x = value + aligned_tcb_size;
7207           break;
7208         default:
7209           gold_unreachable();
7210         }
7211       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
7212     }
7213
7214   of->write_output_view(offset, oview_size, oview);
7215 }
7216
7217 // A class to handle the PLT data.
7218
7219 template<bool big_endian>
7220 class Output_data_plt_arm : public Output_section_data
7221 {
7222  public:
7223   typedef Output_data_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, true, 32, big_endian>
7224     Reloc_section;
7225
7226   Output_data_plt_arm(Layout*, Output_data_space*);
7227
7228   // Add an entry to the PLT.
7229   void
7230   add_entry(Symbol* gsym);
7231
7232   // Return the .rel.plt section data.
7233   const Reloc_section*
7234   rel_plt() const
7235   { return this->rel_; }
7236
7237   // Return the number of PLT entries.
7238   unsigned int
7239   entry_count() const
7240   { return this->count_; }
7241
7242   // Return the offset of the first non-reserved PLT entry.
7243   static unsigned int
7244   first_plt_entry_offset()
7245   { return sizeof(first_plt_entry); }
7246
7247   // Return the size of a PLT entry.
7248   static unsigned int
7249   get_plt_entry_size()
7250   { return sizeof(plt_entry); }
7251
7252  protected:
7253   void
7254   do_adjust_output_section(Output_section* os);
7255
7256   // Write to a map file.
7257   void
7258   do_print_to_mapfile(Mapfile* mapfile) const
7259   { mapfile->print_output_data(this, _("** PLT")); }
7260
7261  private:
7262   // Template for the first PLT entry.
7263   static const uint32_t first_plt_entry[5];
7264
7265   // Template for subsequent PLT entries. 
7266   static const uint32_t plt_entry[3];
7267
7268   // Set the final size.
7269   void
7270   set_final_data_size()
7271   {
7272     this->set_data_size(sizeof(first_plt_entry)
7273                         + this->count_ * sizeof(plt_entry));
7274   }
7275
7276   // Write out the PLT data.
7277   void
7278   do_write(Output_file*);
7279
7280   // The reloc section.
7281   Reloc_section* rel_;
7282   // The .got.plt section.
7283   Output_data_space* got_plt_;
7284   // The number of PLT entries.
7285   unsigned int count_;
7286 };
7287
7288 // Create the PLT section.  The ordinary .got section is an argument,
7289 // since we need to refer to the start.  We also create our own .got
7290 // section just for PLT entries.
7291
7292 template<bool big_endian>
7293 Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>::Output_data_plt_arm(Layout* layout,
7294                                                      Output_data_space* got_plt)
7295   : Output_section_data(4), got_plt_(got_plt), count_(0)
7296 {
7297   this->rel_ = new Reloc_section(false);
7298   layout->add_output_section_data(".rel.plt", elfcpp::SHT_REL,
7299                                   elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC, this->rel_,
7300                                   ORDER_DYNAMIC_PLT_RELOCS, false);
7301 }
7302
7303 template<bool big_endian>
7304 void
7305 Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>::do_adjust_output_section(Output_section* os)
7306 {
7307   os->set_entsize(0);
7308 }
7309
7310 // Add an entry to the PLT.
7311
7312 template<bool big_endian>
7313 void
7314 Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>::add_entry(Symbol* gsym)
7315 {
7316   gold_assert(!gsym->has_plt_offset());
7317
7318   // Note that when setting the PLT offset we skip the initial
7319   // reserved PLT entry.
7320   gsym->set_plt_offset((this->count_) * sizeof(plt_entry)
7321                        + sizeof(first_plt_entry));
7322
7323   ++this->count_;
7324
7325   section_offset_type got_offset = this->got_plt_->current_data_size();
7326
7327   // Every PLT entry needs a GOT entry which points back to the PLT
7328   // entry (this will be changed by the dynamic linker, normally
7329   // lazily when the function is called).
7330   this->got_plt_->set_current_data_size(got_offset + 4);
7331
7332   // Every PLT entry needs a reloc.
7333   gsym->set_needs_dynsym_entry();
7334   this->rel_->add_global(gsym, elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT, this->got_plt_,
7335                          got_offset);
7336
7337   // Note that we don't need to save the symbol.  The contents of the
7338   // PLT are independent of which symbols are used.  The symbols only
7339   // appear in the relocations.
7340 }
7341
7342 // ARM PLTs.
7343 // FIXME:  This is not very flexible.  Right now this has only been tested
7344 // on armv5te.  If we are to support additional architecture features like
7345 // Thumb-2 or BE8, we need to make this more flexible like GNU ld.
7346
7347 // The first entry in the PLT.
7348 template<bool big_endian>
7349 const uint32_t Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>::first_plt_entry[5] =
7350 {
7351   0xe52de004,   // str   lr, [sp, #-4]!
7352   0xe59fe004,   // ldr   lr, [pc, #4]
7353   0xe08fe00e,   // add   lr, pc, lr 
7354   0xe5bef008,   // ldr   pc, [lr, #8]!
7355   0x00000000,   // &GOT[0] - .
7356 };
7357
7358 // Subsequent entries in the PLT.
7359
7360 template<bool big_endian>
7361 const uint32_t Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>::plt_entry[3] =
7362 {
7363   0xe28fc600,   // add   ip, pc, #0xNN00000
7364   0xe28cca00,   // add   ip, ip, #0xNN000
7365   0xe5bcf000,   // ldr   pc, [ip, #0xNNN]!
7366 };
7367
7368 // Write out the PLT.  This uses the hand-coded instructions above,
7369 // and adjusts them as needed.  This is all specified by the arm ELF
7370 // Processor Supplement.
7371
7372 template<bool big_endian>
7373 void
7374 Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>::do_write(Output_file* of)
7375 {
7376   const off_t offset = this->offset();
7377   const section_size_type oview_size =
7378     convert_to_section_size_type(this->data_size());
7379   unsigned char* const oview = of->get_output_view(offset, oview_size);
7380
7381   const off_t got_file_offset = this->got_plt_->offset();
7382   const section_size_type got_size =
7383     convert_to_section_size_type(this->got_plt_->data_size());
7384   unsigned char* const got_view = of->get_output_view(got_file_offset,
7385                                                       got_size);
7386   unsigned char* pov = oview;
7387
7388   Arm_address plt_address = this->address();
7389   Arm_address got_address = this->got_plt_->address();
7390
7391   // Write first PLT entry.  All but the last word are constants.
7392   const size_t num_first_plt_words = (sizeof(first_plt_entry)
7393                                       / sizeof(plt_entry[0]));
7394   for (size_t i = 0; i < num_first_plt_words - 1; i++)
7395     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + i * 4, first_plt_entry[i]);
7396   // Last word in first PLT entry is &GOT[0] - .
7397   elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 16,
7398                                          got_address - (plt_address + 16));
7399   pov += sizeof(first_plt_entry);
7400
7401   unsigned char* got_pov = got_view;
7402
7403   memset(got_pov, 0, 12);
7404   got_pov += 12;
7405
7406   const int rel_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::rel_size;
7407   unsigned int plt_offset = sizeof(first_plt_entry);
7408   unsigned int plt_rel_offset = 0;
7409   unsigned int got_offset = 12;
7410   const unsigned int count = this->count_;
7411   for (unsigned int i = 0;
7412        i < count;
7413        ++i,
7414          pov += sizeof(plt_entry),
7415          got_pov += 4,
7416          plt_offset += sizeof(plt_entry),
7417          plt_rel_offset += rel_size,
7418          got_offset += 4)
7419     {
7420       // Set and adjust the PLT entry itself.
7421       int32_t offset = ((got_address + got_offset)
7422                          - (plt_address + plt_offset + 8));
7423
7424       gold_assert(offset >= 0 && offset < 0x0fffffff);
7425       uint32_t plt_insn0 = plt_entry[0] | ((offset >> 20) & 0xff);
7426       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov, plt_insn0);
7427       uint32_t plt_insn1 = plt_entry[1] | ((offset >> 12) & 0xff);
7428       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4, plt_insn1);
7429       uint32_t plt_insn2 = plt_entry[2] | (offset & 0xfff);
7430       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 8, plt_insn2);
7431
7432       // Set the entry in the GOT.
7433       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(got_pov, plt_address);
7434     }
7435
7436   gold_assert(static_cast<section_size_type>(pov - oview) == oview_size);
7437   gold_assert(static_cast<section_size_type>(got_pov - got_view) == got_size);
7438
7439   of->write_output_view(offset, oview_size, oview);
7440   of->write_output_view(got_file_offset, got_size, got_view);
7441 }
7442
7443 // Create a PLT entry for a global symbol.
7444
7445 template<bool big_endian>
7446 void
7447 Target_arm<big_endian>::make_plt_entry(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout,
7448                                        Symbol* gsym)
7449 {
7450   if (gsym->has_plt_offset())
7451     return;
7452
7453   if (this->plt_ == NULL)
7454     {
7455       // Create the GOT sections first.
7456       this->got_section(symtab, layout);
7457
7458       this->plt_ = new Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>(layout, this->got_plt_);
7459       layout->add_output_section_data(".plt", elfcpp::SHT_PROGBITS,
7460                                       (elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC
7461                                        | elfcpp::SHF_EXECINSTR),
7462                                       this->plt_, ORDER_PLT, false);
7463     }
7464   this->plt_->add_entry(gsym);
7465 }
7466
7467 // Return the number of entries in the PLT.
7468
7469 template<bool big_endian>
7470 unsigned int
7471 Target_arm<big_endian>::plt_entry_count() const
7472 {
7473   if (this->plt_ == NULL)
7474     return 0;
7475   return this->plt_->entry_count();
7476 }
7477
7478 // Return the offset of the first non-reserved PLT entry.
7479
7480 template<bool big_endian>
7481 unsigned int
7482 Target_arm<big_endian>::first_plt_entry_offset() const
7483 {
7484   return Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>::first_plt_entry_offset();
7485 }
7486
7487 // Return the size of each PLT entry.
7488
7489 template<bool big_endian>
7490 unsigned int
7491 Target_arm<big_endian>::plt_entry_size() const
7492 {
7493   return Output_data_plt_arm<big_endian>::get_plt_entry_size();
7494 }
7495
7496 // Get the section to use for TLS_DESC relocations.
7497
7498 template<bool big_endian>
7499 typename Target_arm<big_endian>::Reloc_section*
7500 Target_arm<big_endian>::rel_tls_desc_section(Layout* layout) const
7501 {
7502   return this->plt_section()->rel_tls_desc(layout);
7503 }
7504
7505 // Define the _TLS_MODULE_BASE_ symbol in the TLS segment.
7506
7507 template<bool big_endian>
7508 void
7509 Target_arm<big_endian>::define_tls_base_symbol(
7510     Symbol_table* symtab,
7511     Layout* layout)
7512 {
7513   if (this->tls_base_symbol_defined_)
7514     return;
7515
7516   Output_segment* tls_segment = layout->tls_segment();
7517   if (tls_segment != NULL)
7518     {
7519       bool is_exec = parameters->options().output_is_executable();
7520       symtab->define_in_output_segment("_TLS_MODULE_BASE_", NULL,
7521                                        Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
7522                                        tls_segment, 0, 0,
7523                                        elfcpp::STT_TLS,
7524                                        elfcpp::STB_LOCAL,
7525                                        elfcpp::STV_HIDDEN, 0,
7526                                        (is_exec
7527                                         ? Symbol::SEGMENT_END
7528                                         : Symbol::SEGMENT_START),
7529                                        true);
7530     }
7531   this->tls_base_symbol_defined_ = true;
7532 }
7533
7534 // Create a GOT entry for the TLS module index.
7535
7536 template<bool big_endian>
7537 unsigned int
7538 Target_arm<big_endian>::got_mod_index_entry(
7539     Symbol_table* symtab,
7540     Layout* layout,
7541     Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object)
7542 {
7543   if (this->got_mod_index_offset_ == -1U)
7544     {
7545       gold_assert(symtab != NULL && layout != NULL && object != NULL);
7546       Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>* got = this->got_section(symtab, layout);
7547       unsigned int got_offset;
7548       if (!parameters->doing_static_link())
7549         {
7550           got_offset = got->add_constant(0);
7551           Reloc_section* rel_dyn = this->rel_dyn_section(layout);
7552           rel_dyn->add_local(object, 0, elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32, got,
7553                              got_offset);
7554         }
7555       else
7556         {
7557           // We are doing a static link.  Just mark it as belong to module 1,
7558           // the executable.
7559           got_offset = got->add_constant(1);
7560         }
7561
7562       got->add_constant(0);
7563       this->got_mod_index_offset_ = got_offset;
7564     }
7565   return this->got_mod_index_offset_;
7566 }
7567
7568 // Optimize the TLS relocation type based on what we know about the
7569 // symbol.  IS_FINAL is true if the final address of this symbol is
7570 // known at link time.
7571
7572 template<bool big_endian>
7573 tls::Tls_optimization
7574 Target_arm<big_endian>::optimize_tls_reloc(bool, int)
7575 {
7576   // FIXME: Currently we do not do any TLS optimization.
7577   return tls::TLSOPT_NONE;
7578 }
7579
7580 // Get the Reference_flags for a particular relocation.
7581
7582 template<bool big_endian>
7583 int
7584 Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan::get_reference_flags(unsigned int r_type)
7585 {
7586   switch (r_type)
7587     {
7588     case elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE:
7589     case elfcpp::R_ARM_V4BX:
7590     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY:
7591     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7592       // No symbol reference.
7593       return 0;
7594
7595     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32:
7596     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS16:
7597     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS12:
7598     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_ABS5:
7599     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS8:
7600     case elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_ABS:
7601     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
7602     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_ABS:
7603     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
7604     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS:
7605     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32_NOI:
7606       return Symbol::ABSOLUTE_REF;
7607
7608     case elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32:
7609     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0:
7610     case elfcpp::R_ARM_SBREL32:
7611     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_PC8:
7612     case elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_PREL:
7613     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
7614     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_PREL:
7615     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
7616     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL:
7617     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_ALU_PREL_11_0:
7618     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_PC12:
7619     case elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32_NOI:
7620     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC:
7621     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0:
7622     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC:
7623     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1:
7624     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2:
7625     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1:
7626     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2:
7627     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0:
7628     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1:
7629     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2:
7630     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0:
7631     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1:
7632     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2:
7633     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC:
7634     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0:
7635     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC:
7636     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1:
7637     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2:
7638     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0:
7639     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1:
7640     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2:
7641     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0:
7642     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1:
7643     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2:
7644     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0:
7645     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1:
7646     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2:
7647     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
7648     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_BREL:
7649     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_BREL:
7650     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
7651     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL:
7652     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL:
7653     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOTOFF32:
7654     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOTOFF12:
7655     case elfcpp::R_ARM_SBREL31:
7656       return Symbol::RELATIVE_REF;
7657
7658     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32:
7659     case elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL:
7660     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24:
7661     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL:
7662     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
7663     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
7664     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP6:
7665     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP11:
7666     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP8:
7667     // R_ARM_PREL31 is not used to relocate call/jump instructions but
7668     // in unwind tables. It may point to functions via PLTs.
7669     // So we treat it like call/jump relocations above.
7670     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PREL31:
7671       return Symbol::FUNCTION_CALL | Symbol::RELATIVE_REF;
7672
7673     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_BREL:
7674     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_ABS:
7675     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_PREL:
7676       // Absolute in GOT.
7677       return Symbol::ABSOLUTE_REF;
7678
7679     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_GD32:        // Global-dynamic
7680     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:       // Local-dynamic
7681     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDO32:       // Alternate local-dynamic
7682     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_IE32:        // Initial-exec
7683     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LE32:        // Local-exec
7684       return Symbol::TLS_REF;
7685
7686     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET1:
7687     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET2:
7688     case elfcpp::R_ARM_COPY:
7689     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GLOB_DAT:
7690     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT:
7691     case elfcpp::R_ARM_RELATIVE:
7692     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PC24:
7693     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SBREL_11_0_NC:
7694     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_19_12_NC:
7695     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_27_20_CK:
7696     default:
7697       // Not expected.  We will give an error later.
7698       return 0;
7699     }
7700 }
7701
7702 // Report an unsupported relocation against a local symbol.
7703
7704 template<bool big_endian>
7705 void
7706 Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan::unsupported_reloc_local(
7707     Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
7708     unsigned int r_type)
7709 {
7710   gold_error(_("%s: unsupported reloc %u against local symbol"),
7711              object->name().c_str(), r_type);
7712 }
7713
7714 // We are about to emit a dynamic relocation of type R_TYPE.  If the
7715 // dynamic linker does not support it, issue an error.  The GNU linker
7716 // only issues a non-PIC error for an allocated read-only section.
7717 // Here we know the section is allocated, but we don't know that it is
7718 // read-only.  But we check for all the relocation types which the
7719 // glibc dynamic linker supports, so it seems appropriate to issue an
7720 // error even if the section is not read-only.
7721
7722 template<bool big_endian>
7723 void
7724 Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan::check_non_pic(Relobj* object,
7725                                             unsigned int r_type)
7726 {
7727   switch (r_type)
7728     {
7729     // These are the relocation types supported by glibc for ARM.
7730     case elfcpp::R_ARM_RELATIVE:
7731     case elfcpp::R_ARM_COPY:
7732     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GLOB_DAT:
7733     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT:
7734     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32:
7735     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32_NOI:
7736     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PC24:
7737     // FIXME: The following 3 types are not supported by Android's dynamic
7738     // linker.
7739     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32:
7740     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32:
7741     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32:
7742       return;
7743
7744     default:
7745       {
7746         // This prevents us from issuing more than one error per reloc
7747         // section.  But we can still wind up issuing more than one
7748         // error per object file.
7749         if (this->issued_non_pic_error_)
7750           return;
7751         const Arm_reloc_property* reloc_property =
7752           arm_reloc_property_table->get_reloc_property(r_type);
7753         gold_assert(reloc_property != NULL);
7754         object->error(_("requires unsupported dynamic reloc %s; "
7755                       "recompile with -fPIC"),
7756                       reloc_property->name().c_str());
7757         this->issued_non_pic_error_ = true;
7758         return;
7759       }
7760
7761     case elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE:
7762       gold_unreachable();
7763     }
7764 }
7765
7766 // Scan a relocation for a local symbol.
7767 // FIXME: This only handles a subset of relocation types used by Android
7768 // on ARM v5te devices.
7769
7770 template<bool big_endian>
7771 inline void
7772 Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan::local(Symbol_table* symtab,
7773                                     Layout* layout,
7774                                     Target_arm* target,
7775                                     Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
7776                                     unsigned int data_shndx,
7777                                     Output_section* output_section,
7778                                     const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>& reloc,
7779                                     unsigned int r_type,
7780                                     const elfcpp::Sym<32, big_endian>& lsym)
7781 {
7782   r_type = get_real_reloc_type(r_type);
7783   switch (r_type)
7784     {
7785     case elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE:
7786     case elfcpp::R_ARM_V4BX:
7787     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY:
7788     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7789       break;
7790
7791     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32:
7792     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32_NOI:
7793       // If building a shared library (or a position-independent
7794       // executable), we need to create a dynamic relocation for
7795       // this location. The relocation applied at link time will
7796       // apply the link-time value, so we flag the location with
7797       // an R_ARM_RELATIVE relocation so the dynamic loader can
7798       // relocate it easily.
7799       if (parameters->options().output_is_position_independent())
7800         {
7801           Reloc_section* rel_dyn = target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
7802           unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(reloc.get_r_info());
7803           // If we are to add more other reloc types than R_ARM_ABS32,
7804           // we need to add check_non_pic(object, r_type) here.
7805           rel_dyn->add_local_relative(object, r_sym, elfcpp::R_ARM_RELATIVE,
7806                                       output_section, data_shndx,
7807                                       reloc.get_r_offset());
7808         }
7809       break;
7810
7811     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS16:
7812     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS12:
7813     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_ABS5:
7814     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS8:
7815     case elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_ABS:
7816     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
7817     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_ABS:
7818     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
7819     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS:
7820       // If building a shared library (or a position-independent
7821       // executable), we need to create a dynamic relocation for
7822       // this location. Because the addend needs to remain in the
7823       // data section, we need to be careful not to apply this
7824       // relocation statically.
7825       if (parameters->options().output_is_position_independent())
7826         {
7827           check_non_pic(object, r_type);
7828           Reloc_section* rel_dyn = target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
7829           unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(reloc.get_r_info());
7830           if (lsym.get_st_type() != elfcpp::STT_SECTION)
7831             rel_dyn->add_local(object, r_sym, r_type, output_section,
7832                                data_shndx, reloc.get_r_offset());
7833           else
7834             {
7835               gold_assert(lsym.get_st_value() == 0);
7836               unsigned int shndx = lsym.get_st_shndx();
7837               bool is_ordinary;
7838               shndx = object->adjust_sym_shndx(r_sym, shndx,
7839                                                &is_ordinary);
7840               if (!is_ordinary)
7841                 object->error(_("section symbol %u has bad shndx %u"),
7842                               r_sym, shndx);
7843               else
7844                 rel_dyn->add_local_section(object, shndx,
7845                                            r_type, output_section,
7846                                            data_shndx, reloc.get_r_offset());
7847             }
7848         }
7849       break;
7850
7851     case elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32:
7852     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0:
7853     case elfcpp::R_ARM_SBREL32:
7854     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL:
7855     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_PC8:
7856     case elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_PREL:
7857     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32:
7858     case elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL:
7859     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24:
7860     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
7861     case elfcpp::R_ARM_SBREL31:
7862     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PREL31:
7863     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
7864     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_PREL:
7865     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
7866     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL:
7867     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
7868     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP6:
7869     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_ALU_PREL_11_0:
7870     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_PC12:
7871     case elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32_NOI:
7872     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC:
7873     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0:
7874     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC:
7875     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1:
7876     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2:
7877     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1:
7878     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2:
7879     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0:
7880     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1:
7881     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2:
7882     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0:
7883     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1:
7884     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2:
7885     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC:
7886     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0:
7887     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC:
7888     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1:
7889     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2:
7890     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0:
7891     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1:
7892     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2:
7893     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0:
7894     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1:
7895     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2:
7896     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0:
7897     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1:
7898     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2:
7899     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
7900     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_BREL:
7901     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_BREL:
7902     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
7903     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL:
7904     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL:
7905     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP11:
7906     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP8:
7907       // We don't need to do anything for a relative addressing relocation
7908       // against a local symbol if it does not reference the GOT.
7909       break;
7910
7911     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOTOFF32:
7912     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOTOFF12:
7913       // We need a GOT section:
7914       target->got_section(symtab, layout);
7915       break;
7916
7917     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_BREL:
7918     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_PREL:
7919       {
7920         // The symbol requires a GOT entry.
7921         Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>* got =
7922           target->got_section(symtab, layout);
7923         unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(reloc.get_r_info());
7924         if (got->add_local(object, r_sym, GOT_TYPE_STANDARD))
7925           {
7926             // If we are generating a shared object, we need to add a
7927             // dynamic RELATIVE relocation for this symbol's GOT entry.
7928             if (parameters->options().output_is_position_independent())
7929               {
7930                 Reloc_section* rel_dyn = target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
7931                 unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(reloc.get_r_info());
7932                 rel_dyn->add_local_relative(
7933                     object, r_sym, elfcpp::R_ARM_RELATIVE, got,
7934                     object->local_got_offset(r_sym, GOT_TYPE_STANDARD));
7935               }
7936           }
7937       }
7938       break;
7939
7940     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET1:
7941     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET2:
7942       // This should have been mapped to another type already.
7943       // Fall through.
7944     case elfcpp::R_ARM_COPY:
7945     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GLOB_DAT:
7946     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT:
7947     case elfcpp::R_ARM_RELATIVE:
7948       // These are relocations which should only be seen by the
7949       // dynamic linker, and should never be seen here.
7950       gold_error(_("%s: unexpected reloc %u in object file"),
7951                  object->name().c_str(), r_type);
7952       break;
7953
7954
7955       // These are initial TLS relocs, which are expected when
7956       // linking.
7957     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_GD32:        // Global-dynamic
7958     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:       // Local-dynamic
7959     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDO32:       // Alternate local-dynamic
7960     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_IE32:        // Initial-exec
7961     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LE32:        // Local-exec
7962       {
7963         bool output_is_shared = parameters->options().shared();
7964         const tls::Tls_optimization optimized_type
7965             = Target_arm<big_endian>::optimize_tls_reloc(!output_is_shared,
7966                                                          r_type);
7967         switch (r_type)
7968           {
7969           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_GD32:          // Global-dynamic
7970             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
7971               {
7972                 // Create a pair of GOT entries for the module index and
7973                 // dtv-relative offset.
7974                 Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>* got
7975                     = target->got_section(symtab, layout);
7976                 unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(reloc.get_r_info());
7977                 unsigned int shndx = lsym.get_st_shndx();
7978                 bool is_ordinary;
7979                 shndx = object->adjust_sym_shndx(r_sym, shndx, &is_ordinary);
7980                 if (!is_ordinary)
7981                   {
7982                     object->error(_("local symbol %u has bad shndx %u"),
7983                                   r_sym, shndx);
7984                     break;
7985                   }
7986
7987                 if (!parameters->doing_static_link())
7988                   got->add_local_pair_with_rel(object, r_sym, shndx,
7989                                                GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR,
7990                                                target->rel_dyn_section(layout),
7991                                                elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32, 0);
7992                 else
7993                   got->add_tls_gd32_with_static_reloc(GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR,
7994                                                       object, r_sym);
7995               }
7996             else
7997               // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
7998               gold_unreachable();
7999             break;
8000
8001           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:         // Local-dynamic
8002             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
8003               {
8004                 // Create a GOT entry for the module index.
8005                 target->got_mod_index_entry(symtab, layout, object);
8006               }
8007             else
8008               // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
8009               gold_unreachable();
8010             break;
8011
8012           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDO32:         // Alternate local-dynamic
8013             break;
8014
8015           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_IE32:          // Initial-exec
8016             layout->set_has_static_tls();
8017             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
8018               {
8019                 // Create a GOT entry for the tp-relative offset.
8020                 Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>* got
8021                   = target->got_section(symtab, layout);
8022                 unsigned int r_sym =
8023                    elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(reloc.get_r_info());
8024                 if (!parameters->doing_static_link())
8025                     got->add_local_with_rel(object, r_sym, GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET,
8026                                             target->rel_dyn_section(layout),
8027                                             elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32);
8028                 else if (!object->local_has_got_offset(r_sym,
8029                                                        GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET))
8030                   {
8031                     got->add_local(object, r_sym, GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET);
8032                     unsigned int got_offset =
8033                       object->local_got_offset(r_sym, GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET);
8034                     got->add_static_reloc(got_offset,
8035                                           elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32, object,
8036                                           r_sym);
8037                   }
8038               }
8039             else
8040               // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
8041               gold_unreachable();
8042             break;
8043
8044           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LE32:          // Local-exec
8045             layout->set_has_static_tls();
8046             if (output_is_shared)
8047               {
8048                 // We need to create a dynamic relocation.
8049                 gold_assert(lsym.get_st_type() != elfcpp::STT_SECTION);
8050                 unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(reloc.get_r_info());
8051                 Reloc_section* rel_dyn = target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
8052                 rel_dyn->add_local(object, r_sym, elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32,
8053                                    output_section, data_shndx,
8054                                    reloc.get_r_offset());
8055               }
8056             break;
8057
8058           default:
8059             gold_unreachable();
8060           }
8061       }
8062       break;
8063
8064     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PC24:
8065     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SBREL_11_0_NC:
8066     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_19_12_NC:
8067     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_27_20_CK:
8068     default:
8069       unsupported_reloc_local(object, r_type);
8070       break;
8071     }
8072 }
8073
8074 // Report an unsupported relocation against a global symbol.
8075
8076 template<bool big_endian>
8077 void
8078 Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan::unsupported_reloc_global(
8079     Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
8080     unsigned int r_type,
8081     Symbol* gsym)
8082 {
8083   gold_error(_("%s: unsupported reloc %u against global symbol %s"),
8084              object->name().c_str(), r_type, gsym->demangled_name().c_str());
8085 }
8086
8087 template<bool big_endian>
8088 inline bool
8089 Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan::possible_function_pointer_reloc(
8090     unsigned int r_type)
8091 {
8092   switch (r_type)
8093     {
8094     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PC24:
8095     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL:
8096     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32:
8097     case elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL:
8098     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24:
8099     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
8100     case elfcpp::R_ARM_SBREL31:
8101     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PREL31:
8102     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
8103     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP6:
8104     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP11:
8105     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP8:
8106       // All the relocations above are branches except SBREL31 and PREL31.
8107       return false;
8108
8109     default:
8110       // Be conservative and assume this is a function pointer.
8111       return true;
8112     }
8113 }
8114
8115 template<bool big_endian>
8116 inline bool
8117 Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan::local_reloc_may_be_function_pointer(
8118   Symbol_table*,
8119   Layout*,
8120   Target_arm<big_endian>* target,
8121   Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>*,
8122   unsigned int,
8123   Output_section*,
8124   const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>&,
8125   unsigned int r_type,
8126   const elfcpp::Sym<32, big_endian>&)
8127 {
8128   r_type = target->get_real_reloc_type(r_type);
8129   return possible_function_pointer_reloc(r_type);
8130 }
8131
8132 template<bool big_endian>
8133 inline bool
8134 Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan::global_reloc_may_be_function_pointer(
8135   Symbol_table*,
8136   Layout*,
8137   Target_arm<big_endian>* target,
8138   Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>*,
8139   unsigned int,
8140   Output_section*,
8141   const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>&,
8142   unsigned int r_type,
8143   Symbol* gsym)
8144 {
8145   // GOT is not a function.
8146   if (strcmp(gsym->name(), "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
8147     return false;
8148
8149   r_type = target->get_real_reloc_type(r_type);
8150   return possible_function_pointer_reloc(r_type);
8151 }
8152
8153 // Scan a relocation for a global symbol.
8154
8155 template<bool big_endian>
8156 inline void
8157 Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan::global(Symbol_table* symtab,
8158                                      Layout* layout,
8159                                      Target_arm* target,
8160                                      Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
8161                                      unsigned int data_shndx,
8162                                      Output_section* output_section,
8163                                      const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>& reloc,
8164                                      unsigned int r_type,
8165                                      Symbol* gsym)
8166 {
8167   // A reference to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ implies that we need a got
8168   // section.  We check here to avoid creating a dynamic reloc against
8169   // _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.
8170   if (!target->has_got_section()
8171       && strcmp(gsym->name(), "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
8172     target->got_section(symtab, layout);
8173
8174   r_type = get_real_reloc_type(r_type);
8175   switch (r_type)
8176     {
8177     case elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE:
8178     case elfcpp::R_ARM_V4BX:
8179     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GNU_VTENTRY:
8180     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GNU_VTINHERIT:
8181       break;
8182
8183     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32:
8184     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS16:
8185     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS12:
8186     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_ABS5:
8187     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS8:
8188     case elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_ABS:
8189     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
8190     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_ABS:
8191     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
8192     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS:
8193     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32_NOI:
8194       // Absolute addressing relocations.
8195       {
8196         // Make a PLT entry if necessary.
8197         if (this->symbol_needs_plt_entry(gsym))
8198           {
8199             target->make_plt_entry(symtab, layout, gsym);
8200             // Since this is not a PC-relative relocation, we may be
8201             // taking the address of a function. In that case we need to
8202             // set the entry in the dynamic symbol table to the address of
8203             // the PLT entry.
8204             if (gsym->is_from_dynobj() && !parameters->options().shared())
8205               gsym->set_needs_dynsym_value();
8206           }
8207         // Make a dynamic relocation if necessary.
8208         if (gsym->needs_dynamic_reloc(Scan::get_reference_flags(r_type)))
8209           {
8210             if (gsym->may_need_copy_reloc())
8211               {
8212                 target->copy_reloc(symtab, layout, object,
8213                                    data_shndx, output_section, gsym, reloc);
8214               }
8215             else if ((r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32
8216                       || r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32_NOI)
8217                      && gsym->can_use_relative_reloc(false))
8218               {
8219                 Reloc_section* rel_dyn = target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
8220                 rel_dyn->add_global_relative(gsym, elfcpp::R_ARM_RELATIVE,
8221                                              output_section, object,
8222                                              data_shndx, reloc.get_r_offset());
8223               }
8224             else
8225               {
8226                 check_non_pic(object, r_type);
8227                 Reloc_section* rel_dyn = target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
8228                 rel_dyn->add_global(gsym, r_type, output_section, object,
8229                                     data_shndx, reloc.get_r_offset());
8230               }
8231           }
8232       }
8233       break;
8234
8235     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOTOFF32:
8236     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOTOFF12:
8237       // We need a GOT section.
8238       target->got_section(symtab, layout);
8239       break;
8240       
8241     case elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32:
8242     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0:
8243     case elfcpp::R_ARM_SBREL32:
8244     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_PC8:
8245     case elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_PREL:
8246     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
8247     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_PREL:
8248     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
8249     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL:
8250     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_ALU_PREL_11_0:
8251     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_PC12:
8252     case elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32_NOI:
8253     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC:
8254     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0:
8255     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC:
8256     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1:
8257     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2:
8258     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1:
8259     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2:
8260     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0:
8261     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1:
8262     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2:
8263     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0:
8264     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1:
8265     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2:
8266     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC:
8267     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0:
8268     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC:
8269     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1:
8270     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2:
8271     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0:
8272     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1:
8273     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2:
8274     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0:
8275     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1:
8276     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2:
8277     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0:
8278     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1:
8279     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2:
8280     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
8281     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_BREL:
8282     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_BREL:
8283     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
8284     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL:
8285     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL:
8286       // Relative addressing relocations.
8287       {
8288         // Make a dynamic relocation if necessary.
8289         if (gsym->needs_dynamic_reloc(Scan::get_reference_flags(r_type)))
8290           {
8291             if (target->may_need_copy_reloc(gsym))
8292               {
8293                 target->copy_reloc(symtab, layout, object,
8294                                    data_shndx, output_section, gsym, reloc);
8295               }
8296             else
8297               {
8298                 check_non_pic(object, r_type);
8299                 Reloc_section* rel_dyn = target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
8300                 rel_dyn->add_global(gsym, r_type, output_section, object,
8301                                     data_shndx, reloc.get_r_offset());
8302               }
8303           }
8304       }
8305       break;
8306
8307     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL:
8308     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32:
8309     case elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL:
8310     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24:
8311     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
8312     case elfcpp::R_ARM_SBREL31:
8313     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PREL31:
8314     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
8315     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP6:
8316     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP11:
8317     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP8:
8318       // All the relocation above are branches except for the PREL31 ones.
8319       // A PREL31 relocation can point to a personality function in a shared
8320       // library.  In that case we want to use a PLT because we want to
8321       // call the personality routine and the dynamic linkers we care about
8322       // do not support dynamic PREL31 relocations. An REL31 relocation may
8323       // point to a function whose unwinding behaviour is being described but
8324       // we will not mistakenly generate a PLT for that because we should use
8325       // a local section symbol.
8326
8327       // If the symbol is fully resolved, this is just a relative
8328       // local reloc.  Otherwise we need a PLT entry.
8329       if (gsym->final_value_is_known())
8330         break;
8331       // If building a shared library, we can also skip the PLT entry
8332       // if the symbol is defined in the output file and is protected
8333       // or hidden.
8334       if (gsym->is_defined()
8335           && !gsym->is_from_dynobj()
8336           && !gsym->is_preemptible())
8337         break;
8338       target->make_plt_entry(symtab, layout, gsym);
8339       break;
8340
8341     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_BREL:
8342     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_ABS:
8343     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_PREL:
8344       {
8345         // The symbol requires a GOT entry.
8346         Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>* got =
8347           target->got_section(symtab, layout);
8348         if (gsym->final_value_is_known())
8349           got->add_global(gsym, GOT_TYPE_STANDARD);
8350         else
8351           {
8352             // If this symbol is not fully resolved, we need to add a
8353             // GOT entry with a dynamic relocation.
8354             Reloc_section* rel_dyn = target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
8355             if (gsym->is_from_dynobj()
8356                 || gsym->is_undefined()
8357                 || gsym->is_preemptible())
8358               got->add_global_with_rel(gsym, GOT_TYPE_STANDARD,
8359                                        rel_dyn, elfcpp::R_ARM_GLOB_DAT);
8360             else
8361               {
8362                 if (got->add_global(gsym, GOT_TYPE_STANDARD))
8363                   rel_dyn->add_global_relative(
8364                       gsym, elfcpp::R_ARM_RELATIVE, got,
8365                       gsym->got_offset(GOT_TYPE_STANDARD));
8366               }
8367           }
8368       }
8369       break;
8370
8371     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET1:
8372     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET2:
8373       // These should have been mapped to other types already.
8374       // Fall through.
8375     case elfcpp::R_ARM_COPY:
8376     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GLOB_DAT:
8377     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP_SLOT:
8378     case elfcpp::R_ARM_RELATIVE:
8379       // These are relocations which should only be seen by the
8380       // dynamic linker, and should never be seen here.
8381       gold_error(_("%s: unexpected reloc %u in object file"),
8382                  object->name().c_str(), r_type);
8383       break;
8384
8385       // These are initial tls relocs, which are expected when
8386       // linking.
8387     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_GD32:        // Global-dynamic
8388     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:       // Local-dynamic
8389     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDO32:       // Alternate local-dynamic
8390     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_IE32:        // Initial-exec
8391     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LE32:        // Local-exec
8392       {
8393         const bool is_final = gsym->final_value_is_known();
8394         const tls::Tls_optimization optimized_type
8395             = Target_arm<big_endian>::optimize_tls_reloc(is_final, r_type);
8396         switch (r_type)
8397           {
8398           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_GD32:          // Global-dynamic
8399             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
8400               {
8401                 // Create a pair of GOT entries for the module index and
8402                 // dtv-relative offset.
8403                 Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>* got
8404                     = target->got_section(symtab, layout);
8405                 if (!parameters->doing_static_link())
8406                   got->add_global_pair_with_rel(gsym, GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR,
8407                                                 target->rel_dyn_section(layout),
8408                                                 elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_DTPMOD32,
8409                                                 elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_DTPOFF32);
8410                 else
8411                   got->add_tls_gd32_with_static_reloc(GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR, gsym);
8412               }
8413             else
8414               // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
8415               gold_unreachable();
8416             break;
8417
8418           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:         // Local-dynamic
8419             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
8420               {
8421                 // Create a GOT entry for the module index.
8422                 target->got_mod_index_entry(symtab, layout, object);
8423               }
8424             else
8425               // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
8426               gold_unreachable();
8427             break;
8428
8429           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDO32:         // Alternate local-dynamic
8430             break;
8431
8432           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_IE32:          // Initial-exec
8433             layout->set_has_static_tls();
8434             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
8435               {
8436                 // Create a GOT entry for the tp-relative offset.
8437                 Arm_output_data_got<big_endian>* got
8438                   = target->got_section(symtab, layout);
8439                 if (!parameters->doing_static_link())
8440                   got->add_global_with_rel(gsym, GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET,
8441                                            target->rel_dyn_section(layout),
8442                                            elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32);
8443                 else if (!gsym->has_got_offset(GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET))
8444                   {
8445                     got->add_global(gsym, GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET);
8446                     unsigned int got_offset =
8447                        gsym->got_offset(GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET);
8448                     got->add_static_reloc(got_offset,
8449                                           elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32, gsym);
8450                   }
8451               }
8452             else
8453               // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
8454               gold_unreachable();
8455             break;
8456
8457           case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LE32:  // Local-exec
8458             layout->set_has_static_tls();
8459             if (parameters->options().shared())
8460               {
8461                 // We need to create a dynamic relocation.
8462                 Reloc_section* rel_dyn = target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
8463                 rel_dyn->add_global(gsym, elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_TPOFF32,
8464                                     output_section, object,
8465                                     data_shndx, reloc.get_r_offset());
8466               }
8467             break;
8468
8469           default:
8470             gold_unreachable();
8471           }
8472       }
8473       break;
8474
8475     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PC24:
8476     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SBREL_11_0_NC:
8477     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_19_12_NC:
8478     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_27_20_CK:
8479     default:
8480       unsupported_reloc_global(object, r_type, gsym);
8481       break;
8482     }
8483 }
8484
8485 // Process relocations for gc.
8486
8487 template<bool big_endian>
8488 void
8489 Target_arm<big_endian>::gc_process_relocs(
8490     Symbol_table* symtab,
8491     Layout* layout,
8492     Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
8493     unsigned int data_shndx,
8494     unsigned int,
8495     const unsigned char* prelocs,
8496     size_t reloc_count,
8497     Output_section* output_section,
8498     bool needs_special_offset_handling,
8499     size_t local_symbol_count,
8500     const unsigned char* plocal_symbols)
8501 {
8502   typedef Target_arm<big_endian> Arm;
8503   typedef typename Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan Scan;
8504
8505   gold::gc_process_relocs<32, big_endian, Arm, elfcpp::SHT_REL, Scan,
8506                           typename Target_arm::Relocatable_size_for_reloc>(
8507     symtab,
8508     layout,
8509     this,
8510     object,
8511     data_shndx,
8512     prelocs,
8513     reloc_count,
8514     output_section,
8515     needs_special_offset_handling,
8516     local_symbol_count,
8517     plocal_symbols);
8518 }
8519
8520 // Scan relocations for a section.
8521
8522 template<bool big_endian>
8523 void
8524 Target_arm<big_endian>::scan_relocs(Symbol_table* symtab,
8525                                     Layout* layout,
8526                                     Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
8527                                     unsigned int data_shndx,
8528                                     unsigned int sh_type,
8529                                     const unsigned char* prelocs,
8530                                     size_t reloc_count,
8531                                     Output_section* output_section,
8532                                     bool needs_special_offset_handling,
8533                                     size_t local_symbol_count,
8534                                     const unsigned char* plocal_symbols)
8535 {
8536   typedef typename Target_arm<big_endian>::Scan Scan;
8537   if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
8538     {
8539       gold_error(_("%s: unsupported RELA reloc section"),
8540                  object->name().c_str());
8541       return;
8542     }
8543
8544   gold::scan_relocs<32, big_endian, Target_arm, elfcpp::SHT_REL, Scan>(
8545     symtab,
8546     layout,
8547     this,
8548     object,
8549     data_shndx,
8550     prelocs,
8551     reloc_count,
8552     output_section,
8553     needs_special_offset_handling,
8554     local_symbol_count,
8555     plocal_symbols);
8556 }
8557
8558 // Finalize the sections.
8559
8560 template<bool big_endian>
8561 void
8562 Target_arm<big_endian>::do_finalize_sections(
8563     Layout* layout,
8564     const Input_objects* input_objects,
8565     Symbol_table* symtab)
8566 {
8567   bool merged_any_attributes = false;
8568   // Merge processor-specific flags.
8569   for (Input_objects::Relobj_iterator p = input_objects->relobj_begin();
8570        p != input_objects->relobj_end();
8571        ++p)
8572     {
8573       Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
8574         Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(*p);
8575       if (arm_relobj->merge_flags_and_attributes())
8576         {
8577           this->merge_processor_specific_flags(
8578               arm_relobj->name(),
8579               arm_relobj->processor_specific_flags());
8580           this->merge_object_attributes(arm_relobj->name().c_str(),
8581                                         arm_relobj->attributes_section_data());
8582           merged_any_attributes = true;
8583         }
8584     } 
8585
8586   for (Input_objects::Dynobj_iterator p = input_objects->dynobj_begin();
8587        p != input_objects->dynobj_end();
8588        ++p)
8589     {
8590       Arm_dynobj<big_endian>* arm_dynobj =
8591         Arm_dynobj<big_endian>::as_arm_dynobj(*p);
8592       this->merge_processor_specific_flags(
8593           arm_dynobj->name(),
8594           arm_dynobj->processor_specific_flags());
8595       this->merge_object_attributes(arm_dynobj->name().c_str(),
8596                                     arm_dynobj->attributes_section_data());
8597       merged_any_attributes = true;
8598     }
8599
8600   // Create an empty uninitialized attribute section if we still don't have it
8601   // at this moment.  This happens if there is no attributes sections in all
8602   // inputs.
8603   if (this->attributes_section_data_ == NULL)
8604     this->attributes_section_data_ = new Attributes_section_data(NULL, 0);
8605
8606   // Check BLX use.
8607   const Object_attribute* cpu_arch_attr =
8608     this->get_aeabi_object_attribute(elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch);
8609   if (cpu_arch_attr->int_value() > elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V4)
8610     this->set_may_use_blx(true);
8611  
8612   // Check if we need to use Cortex-A8 workaround.
8613   if (parameters->options().user_set_fix_cortex_a8())
8614     this->fix_cortex_a8_ = parameters->options().fix_cortex_a8();
8615   else
8616     {
8617       // If neither --fix-cortex-a8 nor --no-fix-cortex-a8 is used, turn on
8618       // Cortex-A8 erratum workaround for ARMv7-A or ARMv7 with unknown
8619       // profile.  
8620       const Object_attribute* cpu_arch_profile_attr =
8621         this->get_aeabi_object_attribute(elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch_profile);
8622       this->fix_cortex_a8_ =
8623         (cpu_arch_attr->int_value() == elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V7
8624          && (cpu_arch_profile_attr->int_value() == 'A'
8625              || cpu_arch_profile_attr->int_value() == 0));
8626     }
8627   
8628   // Check if we can use V4BX interworking.
8629   // The V4BX interworking stub contains BX instruction,
8630   // which is not specified for some profiles.
8631   if (this->fix_v4bx() == General_options::FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
8632       && !this->may_use_blx())
8633     gold_error(_("unable to provide V4BX reloc interworking fix up; "
8634                  "the target profile does not support BX instruction"));
8635
8636   // Fill in some more dynamic tags.
8637   const Reloc_section* rel_plt = (this->plt_ == NULL
8638                                   ? NULL
8639                                   : this->plt_->rel_plt());
8640   layout->add_target_dynamic_tags(true, this->got_plt_, rel_plt,
8641                                   this->rel_dyn_, true, false);
8642
8643   // Emit any relocs we saved in an attempt to avoid generating COPY
8644   // relocs.
8645   if (this->copy_relocs_.any_saved_relocs())
8646     this->copy_relocs_.emit(this->rel_dyn_section(layout));
8647
8648   // Handle the .ARM.exidx section.
8649   Output_section* exidx_section = layout->find_output_section(".ARM.exidx");
8650
8651   if (!parameters->options().relocatable())
8652     {
8653       if (exidx_section != NULL
8654           && exidx_section->type() == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_EXIDX)
8655         {
8656           // Create __exidx_start and __exidx_end symbols.
8657           symtab->define_in_output_data("__exidx_start", NULL,
8658                                         Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
8659                                         exidx_section, 0, 0, elfcpp::STT_OBJECT,
8660                                         elfcpp::STB_GLOBAL, elfcpp::STV_HIDDEN,
8661                                         0, false, true);
8662           symtab->define_in_output_data("__exidx_end", NULL,
8663                                         Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
8664                                         exidx_section, 0, 0, elfcpp::STT_OBJECT,
8665                                         elfcpp::STB_GLOBAL, elfcpp::STV_HIDDEN,
8666                                         0, true, true);
8667
8668           // For the ARM target, we need to add a PT_ARM_EXIDX segment for
8669           // the .ARM.exidx section.
8670           if (!layout->script_options()->saw_phdrs_clause())
8671             {
8672               gold_assert(layout->find_output_segment(elfcpp::PT_ARM_EXIDX, 0,
8673                                                       0)
8674                           == NULL);
8675               Output_segment*  exidx_segment =
8676                 layout->make_output_segment(elfcpp::PT_ARM_EXIDX, elfcpp::PF_R);
8677               exidx_segment->add_output_section_to_nonload(exidx_section,
8678                                                            elfcpp::PF_R);
8679             }
8680         }
8681       else
8682         {
8683           symtab->define_as_constant("__exidx_start", NULL,
8684                                      Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
8685                                      0, 0, elfcpp::STT_OBJECT,
8686                                      elfcpp::STB_GLOBAL, elfcpp::STV_HIDDEN, 0,
8687                                      true, false);
8688           symtab->define_as_constant("__exidx_end", NULL,
8689                                      Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
8690                                      0, 0, elfcpp::STT_OBJECT,
8691                                      elfcpp::STB_GLOBAL, elfcpp::STV_HIDDEN, 0,
8692                                      true, false);
8693         }
8694     }
8695
8696   // Create an .ARM.attributes section if we have merged any attributes
8697   // from inputs.
8698   if (merged_any_attributes)
8699     {
8700       Output_attributes_section_data* attributes_section =
8701       new Output_attributes_section_data(*this->attributes_section_data_);
8702       layout->add_output_section_data(".ARM.attributes",
8703                                       elfcpp::SHT_ARM_ATTRIBUTES, 0,
8704                                       attributes_section, ORDER_INVALID,
8705                                       false);
8706     }
8707
8708   // Fix up links in section EXIDX headers.
8709   for (Layout::Section_list::const_iterator p = layout->section_list().begin();
8710        p != layout->section_list().end();
8711        ++p)
8712     if ((*p)->type() == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_EXIDX)
8713       {
8714         Arm_output_section<big_endian>* os =
8715           Arm_output_section<big_endian>::as_arm_output_section(*p);
8716         os->set_exidx_section_link();
8717       }
8718 }
8719
8720 // Return whether a direct absolute static relocation needs to be applied.
8721 // In cases where Scan::local() or Scan::global() has created
8722 // a dynamic relocation other than R_ARM_RELATIVE, the addend
8723 // of the relocation is carried in the data, and we must not
8724 // apply the static relocation.
8725
8726 template<bool big_endian>
8727 inline bool
8728 Target_arm<big_endian>::Relocate::should_apply_static_reloc(
8729     const Sized_symbol<32>* gsym,
8730     unsigned int r_type,
8731     bool is_32bit,
8732     Output_section* output_section)
8733 {
8734   // If the output section is not allocated, then we didn't call
8735   // scan_relocs, we didn't create a dynamic reloc, and we must apply
8736   // the reloc here.
8737   if ((output_section->flags() & elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC) == 0)
8738       return true;
8739
8740   int ref_flags = Scan::get_reference_flags(r_type);
8741
8742   // For local symbols, we will have created a non-RELATIVE dynamic
8743   // relocation only if (a) the output is position independent,
8744   // (b) the relocation is absolute (not pc- or segment-relative), and
8745   // (c) the relocation is not 32 bits wide.
8746   if (gsym == NULL)
8747     return !(parameters->options().output_is_position_independent()
8748              && (ref_flags & Symbol::ABSOLUTE_REF)
8749              && !is_32bit);
8750
8751   // For global symbols, we use the same helper routines used in the
8752   // scan pass.  If we did not create a dynamic relocation, or if we
8753   // created a RELATIVE dynamic relocation, we should apply the static
8754   // relocation.
8755   bool has_dyn = gsym->needs_dynamic_reloc(ref_flags);
8756   bool is_rel = (ref_flags & Symbol::ABSOLUTE_REF)
8757                  && gsym->can_use_relative_reloc(ref_flags
8758                                                  & Symbol::FUNCTION_CALL);
8759   return !has_dyn || is_rel;
8760 }
8761
8762 // Perform a relocation.
8763
8764 template<bool big_endian>
8765 inline bool
8766 Target_arm<big_endian>::Relocate::relocate(
8767     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
8768     Target_arm* target,
8769     Output_section* output_section,
8770     size_t relnum,
8771     const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>& rel,
8772     unsigned int r_type,
8773     const Sized_symbol<32>* gsym,
8774     const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
8775     unsigned char* view,
8776     Arm_address address,
8777     section_size_type view_size)
8778 {
8779   typedef Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian> Arm_relocate_functions;
8780
8781   r_type = get_real_reloc_type(r_type);
8782   const Arm_reloc_property* reloc_property =
8783     arm_reloc_property_table->get_implemented_static_reloc_property(r_type);
8784   if (reloc_property == NULL)
8785     {
8786       std::string reloc_name =
8787         arm_reloc_property_table->reloc_name_in_error_message(r_type);
8788       gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, rel.get_r_offset(),
8789                              _("cannot relocate %s in object file"),
8790                              reloc_name.c_str());
8791       return true;
8792     }
8793
8794   const Arm_relobj<big_endian>* object =
8795     Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(relinfo->object);
8796
8797   // If the final branch target of a relocation is THUMB instruction, this
8798   // is 1.  Otherwise it is 0.
8799   Arm_address thumb_bit = 0;
8800   Symbol_value<32> symval;
8801   bool is_weakly_undefined_without_plt = false;
8802   bool have_got_offset = false;
8803   unsigned int got_offset = 0;
8804
8805   // If the relocation uses the GOT entry of a symbol instead of the symbol
8806   // itself, we don't care about whether the symbol is defined or what kind
8807   // of symbol it is.
8808   if (reloc_property->uses_got_entry())
8809     {
8810       // Get the GOT offset.
8811       // The GOT pointer points to the end of the GOT section.
8812       // We need to subtract the size of the GOT section to get
8813       // the actual offset to use in the relocation.
8814       // TODO: We should move GOT offset computing code in TLS relocations
8815       // to here.
8816       switch (r_type)
8817         {
8818         case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_BREL:
8819         case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_PREL:
8820           if (gsym != NULL)
8821             {
8822               gold_assert(gsym->has_got_offset(GOT_TYPE_STANDARD));
8823               got_offset = (gsym->got_offset(GOT_TYPE_STANDARD)
8824                             - target->got_size());
8825             }
8826           else
8827             {
8828               unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(rel.get_r_info());
8829               gold_assert(object->local_has_got_offset(r_sym,
8830                                                        GOT_TYPE_STANDARD));
8831               got_offset = (object->local_got_offset(r_sym, GOT_TYPE_STANDARD)
8832                             - target->got_size());
8833             }
8834           have_got_offset = true;
8835           break;
8836
8837         default:
8838           break;
8839         }
8840     }
8841   else if (relnum != Target_arm<big_endian>::fake_relnum_for_stubs)
8842     {
8843       if (gsym != NULL)
8844         {
8845           // This is a global symbol.  Determine if we use PLT and if the
8846           // final target is THUMB.
8847           if (gsym->use_plt_offset(Scan::get_reference_flags(r_type)))
8848             {
8849               // This uses a PLT, change the symbol value.
8850               symval.set_output_value(target->plt_section()->address()
8851                                       + gsym->plt_offset());
8852               psymval = &symval;
8853             }
8854           else if (gsym->is_weak_undefined())
8855             {
8856               // This is a weakly undefined symbol and we do not use PLT
8857               // for this relocation.  A branch targeting this symbol will
8858               // be converted into an NOP.
8859               is_weakly_undefined_without_plt = true;
8860             }
8861           else if (gsym->is_undefined() && reloc_property->uses_symbol())
8862             {
8863               // This relocation uses the symbol value but the symbol is
8864               // undefined.  Exit early and have the caller reporting an
8865               // error.
8866               return true;
8867             }
8868           else
8869             {
8870               // Set thumb bit if symbol:
8871               // -Has type STT_ARM_TFUNC or
8872               // -Has type STT_FUNC, is defined and with LSB in value set.
8873               thumb_bit =
8874                 (((gsym->type() == elfcpp::STT_ARM_TFUNC)
8875                  || (gsym->type() == elfcpp::STT_FUNC
8876                      && !gsym->is_undefined()
8877                      && ((psymval->value(object, 0) & 1) != 0)))
8878                 ? 1
8879                 : 0);
8880             }
8881         }
8882       else
8883         {
8884           // This is a local symbol.  Determine if the final target is THUMB.
8885           // We saved this information when all the local symbols were read.
8886           elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_WXword r_info = rel.get_r_info();
8887           unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(r_info);
8888           thumb_bit = object->local_symbol_is_thumb_function(r_sym) ? 1 : 0;
8889         }
8890     }
8891   else
8892     {
8893       // This is a fake relocation synthesized for a stub.  It does not have
8894       // a real symbol.  We just look at the LSB of the symbol value to
8895       // determine if the target is THUMB or not.
8896       thumb_bit = ((psymval->value(object, 0) & 1) != 0);
8897     }
8898
8899   // Strip LSB if this points to a THUMB target.
8900   if (thumb_bit != 0
8901       && reloc_property->uses_thumb_bit() 
8902       && ((psymval->value(object, 0) & 1) != 0))
8903     {
8904       Arm_address stripped_value =
8905         psymval->value(object, 0) & ~static_cast<Arm_address>(1);
8906       symval.set_output_value(stripped_value);
8907       psymval = &symval;
8908     } 
8909
8910   // To look up relocation stubs, we need to pass the symbol table index of
8911   // a local symbol.
8912   unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(rel.get_r_info());
8913
8914   // Get the addressing origin of the output segment defining the
8915   // symbol gsym if needed (AAELF 4.6.1.2 Relocation types).
8916   Arm_address sym_origin = 0;
8917   if (reloc_property->uses_symbol_base())
8918     {
8919       if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_ABS && gsym == NULL)
8920         // R_ARM_BASE_ABS with the NULL symbol will give the
8921         // absolute address of the GOT origin (GOT_ORG) (see ARM IHI
8922         // 0044C (AAELF): 4.6.1.8 Proxy generating relocations).
8923         sym_origin = target->got_plt_section()->address();
8924       else if (gsym == NULL)
8925         sym_origin = 0;
8926       else if (gsym->source() == Symbol::IN_OUTPUT_SEGMENT)
8927         sym_origin = gsym->output_segment()->vaddr();
8928       else if (gsym->source() == Symbol::IN_OUTPUT_DATA)
8929         sym_origin = gsym->output_data()->address();
8930
8931       // TODO: Assumes the segment base to be zero for the global symbols
8932       // till the proper support for the segment-base-relative addressing
8933       // will be implemented.  This is consistent with GNU ld.
8934     }
8935
8936   // For relative addressing relocation, find out the relative address base.
8937   Arm_address relative_address_base = 0;
8938   switch(reloc_property->relative_address_base())
8939     {
8940     case Arm_reloc_property::RAB_NONE:
8941     // Relocations with relative address bases RAB_TLS and RAB_tp are
8942     // handled by relocate_tls.  So we do not need to do anything here.
8943     case Arm_reloc_property::RAB_TLS:
8944     case Arm_reloc_property::RAB_tp:
8945       break;
8946     case Arm_reloc_property::RAB_B_S:
8947       relative_address_base = sym_origin;
8948       break;
8949     case Arm_reloc_property::RAB_GOT_ORG:
8950       relative_address_base = target->got_plt_section()->address();
8951       break;
8952     case Arm_reloc_property::RAB_P:
8953       relative_address_base = address;
8954       break;
8955     case Arm_reloc_property::RAB_Pa:
8956       relative_address_base = address & 0xfffffffcU;
8957       break;
8958     default:
8959       gold_unreachable(); 
8960     }
8961     
8962   typename Arm_relocate_functions::Status reloc_status =
8963         Arm_relocate_functions::STATUS_OKAY;
8964   bool check_overflow = reloc_property->checks_overflow();
8965   switch (r_type)
8966     {
8967     case elfcpp::R_ARM_NONE:
8968       break;
8969
8970     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS8:
8971       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, false, output_section))
8972         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::abs8(view, object, psymval);
8973       break;
8974
8975     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS12:
8976       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, false, output_section))
8977         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::abs12(view, object, psymval);
8978       break;
8979
8980     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS16:
8981       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, false, output_section))
8982         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::abs16(view, object, psymval);
8983       break;
8984
8985     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32:
8986       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, true, output_section))
8987         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::abs32(view, object, psymval,
8988                                                      thumb_bit);
8989       break;
8990
8991     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32_NOI:
8992       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, true, output_section))
8993         // No thumb bit for this relocation: (S + A)
8994         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::abs32(view, object, psymval,
8995                                                      0);
8996       break;
8997
8998     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
8999       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, false, output_section))
9000         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::movw(view, object, psymval,
9001                                                     0, thumb_bit,
9002                                                     check_overflow);
9003       break;
9004
9005     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_ABS:
9006       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, false, output_section))
9007         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::movt(view, object, psymval, 0);
9008       break;
9009
9010     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
9011       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, false, output_section))
9012         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::thm_movw(view, object, psymval,
9013                                                         0, thumb_bit, false);
9014       break;
9015
9016     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS:
9017       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, false, output_section))
9018         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::thm_movt(view, object,
9019                                                         psymval, 0);
9020       break;
9021
9022     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
9023     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
9024     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_BREL:
9025       reloc_status =
9026         Arm_relocate_functions::movw(view, object, psymval,
9027                                      relative_address_base, thumb_bit,
9028                                      check_overflow);
9029       break;
9030
9031     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_PREL:
9032     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_BREL:
9033       reloc_status =
9034         Arm_relocate_functions::movt(view, object, psymval,
9035                                      relative_address_base);
9036       break;
9037
9038     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
9039     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
9040     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL:
9041       reloc_status =
9042         Arm_relocate_functions::thm_movw(view, object, psymval,
9043                                          relative_address_base,
9044                                          thumb_bit, check_overflow);
9045       break;
9046
9047     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL:
9048     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL:
9049       reloc_status =
9050         Arm_relocate_functions::thm_movt(view, object, psymval,
9051                                          relative_address_base);
9052       break;
9053         
9054     case elfcpp::R_ARM_REL32:
9055       reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::rel32(view, object, psymval,
9056                                                    address, thumb_bit);
9057       break;
9058
9059     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_ABS5:
9060       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, false, output_section))
9061         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::thm_abs5(view, object, psymval);
9062       break;
9063
9064     // Thumb long branches.
9065     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL:
9066     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_XPC22:
9067     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
9068       reloc_status =
9069         Arm_relocate_functions::thumb_branch_common(
9070             r_type, relinfo, view, gsym, object, r_sym, psymval, address,
9071             thumb_bit, is_weakly_undefined_without_plt);
9072       break;
9073
9074     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOTOFF32:
9075       {
9076         Arm_address got_origin;
9077         got_origin = target->got_plt_section()->address();
9078         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::rel32(view, object, psymval,
9079                                                      got_origin, thumb_bit);
9080       }
9081       break;
9082
9083     case elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_PREL:
9084       gold_assert(gsym != NULL);
9085       reloc_status =
9086           Arm_relocate_functions::base_prel(view, sym_origin, address);
9087       break;
9088
9089     case elfcpp::R_ARM_BASE_ABS:
9090       if (should_apply_static_reloc(gsym, r_type, false, output_section))
9091         reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::base_abs(view, sym_origin);
9092       break;
9093
9094     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_BREL:
9095       gold_assert(have_got_offset);
9096       reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::got_brel(view, got_offset);
9097       break;
9098
9099     case elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_PREL:
9100       gold_assert(have_got_offset);
9101       // Get the address origin for GOT PLT, which is allocated right
9102       // after the GOT section, to calculate an absolute address of
9103       // the symbol GOT entry (got_origin + got_offset).
9104       Arm_address got_origin;
9105       got_origin = target->got_plt_section()->address();
9106       reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::got_prel(view,
9107                                                       got_origin + got_offset,
9108                                                       address);
9109       break;
9110
9111     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32:
9112     case elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL:
9113     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24:
9114     case elfcpp::R_ARM_XPC25:
9115       gold_assert(gsym == NULL
9116                   || gsym->has_plt_offset()
9117                   || gsym->final_value_is_known()
9118                   || (gsym->is_defined()
9119                       && !gsym->is_from_dynobj()
9120                       && !gsym->is_preemptible()));
9121       reloc_status =
9122         Arm_relocate_functions::arm_branch_common(
9123             r_type, relinfo, view, gsym, object, r_sym, psymval, address,
9124             thumb_bit, is_weakly_undefined_without_plt);
9125       break;
9126
9127     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
9128       reloc_status =
9129         Arm_relocate_functions::thm_jump19(view, object, psymval, address,
9130                                            thumb_bit);
9131       break;
9132
9133     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP6:
9134       reloc_status =
9135         Arm_relocate_functions::thm_jump6(view, object, psymval, address);
9136       break;
9137
9138     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP8:
9139       reloc_status =
9140         Arm_relocate_functions::thm_jump8(view, object, psymval, address);
9141       break;
9142
9143     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP11:
9144       reloc_status =
9145         Arm_relocate_functions::thm_jump11(view, object, psymval, address);
9146       break;
9147
9148     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PREL31:
9149       reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions::prel31(view, object, psymval,
9150                                                     address, thumb_bit);
9151       break;
9152
9153     case elfcpp::R_ARM_V4BX:
9154       if (target->fix_v4bx() > General_options::FIX_V4BX_NONE)
9155         {
9156           const bool is_v4bx_interworking =
9157               (target->fix_v4bx() == General_options::FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING);
9158           reloc_status =
9159             Arm_relocate_functions::v4bx(relinfo, view, object, address,
9160                                          is_v4bx_interworking);
9161         }
9162       break;
9163
9164     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_PC8:
9165       reloc_status =
9166         Arm_relocate_functions::thm_pc8(view, object, psymval, address);
9167       break;
9168
9169     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_PC12:
9170       reloc_status =
9171         Arm_relocate_functions::thm_pc12(view, object, psymval, address);
9172       break;
9173
9174     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_ALU_PREL_11_0:
9175       reloc_status =
9176         Arm_relocate_functions::thm_alu11(view, object, psymval, address,
9177                                           thumb_bit);
9178       break;
9179
9180     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC:
9181     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0:
9182     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC:
9183     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1:
9184     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2:
9185     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC:
9186     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0:
9187     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC:
9188     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1:
9189     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2:
9190       reloc_status =
9191         Arm_relocate_functions::arm_grp_alu(view, object, psymval,
9192                                             reloc_property->group_index(),
9193                                             relative_address_base,
9194                                             thumb_bit, check_overflow);
9195       break;
9196
9197     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0:
9198     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1:
9199     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2:
9200     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0:
9201     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1:
9202     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2:
9203       reloc_status =
9204           Arm_relocate_functions::arm_grp_ldr(view, object, psymval,
9205                                               reloc_property->group_index(),
9206                                               relative_address_base);
9207       break;
9208
9209     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0:
9210     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1:
9211     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2:
9212     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0:
9213     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1:
9214     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2:
9215       reloc_status =
9216           Arm_relocate_functions::arm_grp_ldrs(view, object, psymval,
9217                                                reloc_property->group_index(),
9218                                                relative_address_base);
9219       break;
9220
9221     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0:
9222     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1:
9223     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2:
9224     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0:
9225     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1:
9226     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2:
9227       reloc_status =
9228           Arm_relocate_functions::arm_grp_ldc(view, object, psymval,
9229                                               reloc_property->group_index(),
9230                                               relative_address_base);
9231       break;
9232
9233       // These are initial tls relocs, which are expected when
9234       // linking.
9235     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_GD32:        // Global-dynamic
9236     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:       // Local-dynamic
9237     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDO32:       // Alternate local-dynamic
9238     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_IE32:        // Initial-exec
9239     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LE32:        // Local-exec
9240       reloc_status =
9241         this->relocate_tls(relinfo, target, relnum, rel, r_type, gsym, psymval,
9242                            view, address, view_size);
9243       break;
9244
9245     // The known and unknown unsupported and/or deprecated relocations.
9246     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PC24:
9247     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SBREL_11_0_NC:
9248     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_19_12_NC:
9249     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SBREL_27_20_CK:
9250     default:
9251       // Just silently leave the method. We should get an appropriate error
9252       // message in the scan methods.
9253       break;
9254     }
9255
9256   // Report any errors.
9257   switch (reloc_status)
9258     {
9259     case Arm_relocate_functions::STATUS_OKAY:
9260       break;
9261     case Arm_relocate_functions::STATUS_OVERFLOW:
9262       gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, rel.get_r_offset(),
9263                              _("relocation overflow in %s"),
9264                              reloc_property->name().c_str());
9265       break;
9266     case Arm_relocate_functions::STATUS_BAD_RELOC:
9267       gold_error_at_location(
9268         relinfo,
9269         relnum,
9270         rel.get_r_offset(),
9271         _("unexpected opcode while processing relocation %s"),
9272         reloc_property->name().c_str());
9273       break;
9274     default:
9275       gold_unreachable();
9276     }
9277
9278   return true;
9279 }
9280
9281 // Perform a TLS relocation.
9282
9283 template<bool big_endian>
9284 inline typename Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::Status
9285 Target_arm<big_endian>::Relocate::relocate_tls(
9286     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
9287     Target_arm<big_endian>* target,
9288     size_t relnum,
9289     const elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian>& rel,
9290     unsigned int r_type,
9291     const Sized_symbol<32>* gsym,
9292     const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
9293     unsigned char* view,
9294     elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Addr address,
9295     section_size_type /*view_size*/ )
9296 {
9297   typedef Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian> ArmRelocFuncs;
9298   typedef Relocate_functions<32, big_endian> RelocFuncs;
9299   Output_segment* tls_segment = relinfo->layout->tls_segment();
9300
9301   const Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object = relinfo->object;
9302
9303   elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Addr value = psymval->value(object, 0);
9304
9305   const bool is_final = (gsym == NULL
9306                          ? !parameters->options().shared()
9307                          : gsym->final_value_is_known());
9308   const tls::Tls_optimization optimized_type
9309       = Target_arm<big_endian>::optimize_tls_reloc(is_final, r_type);
9310   switch (r_type)
9311     {
9312     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_GD32:        // Global-dynamic
9313         {
9314           unsigned int got_type = GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR;
9315           unsigned int got_offset;
9316           if (gsym != NULL)
9317             {
9318               gold_assert(gsym->has_got_offset(got_type));
9319               got_offset = gsym->got_offset(got_type) - target->got_size();
9320             }
9321           else
9322             {
9323               unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(rel.get_r_info());
9324               gold_assert(object->local_has_got_offset(r_sym, got_type));
9325               got_offset = (object->local_got_offset(r_sym, got_type)
9326                             - target->got_size());
9327             }
9328           if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
9329             {
9330               Arm_address got_entry =
9331                 target->got_plt_section()->address() + got_offset;
9332               
9333               // Relocate the field with the PC relative offset of the pair of
9334               // GOT entries.
9335               RelocFuncs::pcrel32(view, got_entry, address);
9336               return ArmRelocFuncs::STATUS_OKAY;
9337             }
9338         }
9339       break;
9340
9341     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDM32:       // Local-dynamic
9342       if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
9343         {
9344           // Relocate the field with the offset of the GOT entry for
9345           // the module index.
9346           unsigned int got_offset;
9347           got_offset = (target->got_mod_index_entry(NULL, NULL, NULL)
9348                         - target->got_size());
9349           Arm_address got_entry =
9350             target->got_plt_section()->address() + got_offset;
9351
9352           // Relocate the field with the PC relative offset of the pair of
9353           // GOT entries.
9354           RelocFuncs::pcrel32(view, got_entry, address);
9355           return ArmRelocFuncs::STATUS_OKAY;
9356         }
9357       break;
9358
9359     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LDO32:       // Alternate local-dynamic
9360       RelocFuncs::rel32(view, value);
9361       return ArmRelocFuncs::STATUS_OKAY;
9362
9363     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_IE32:        // Initial-exec
9364       if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
9365         {
9366           // Relocate the field with the offset of the GOT entry for
9367           // the tp-relative offset of the symbol.
9368           unsigned int got_type = GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET;
9369           unsigned int got_offset;
9370           if (gsym != NULL)
9371             {
9372               gold_assert(gsym->has_got_offset(got_type));
9373               got_offset = gsym->got_offset(got_type);
9374             }
9375           else
9376             {
9377               unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(rel.get_r_info());
9378               gold_assert(object->local_has_got_offset(r_sym, got_type));
9379               got_offset = object->local_got_offset(r_sym, got_type);
9380             }
9381
9382           // All GOT offsets are relative to the end of the GOT.
9383           got_offset -= target->got_size();
9384
9385           Arm_address got_entry =
9386             target->got_plt_section()->address() + got_offset;
9387
9388           // Relocate the field with the PC relative offset of the GOT entry.
9389           RelocFuncs::pcrel32(view, got_entry, address);
9390           return ArmRelocFuncs::STATUS_OKAY;
9391         }
9392       break;
9393
9394     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TLS_LE32:        // Local-exec
9395       // If we're creating a shared library, a dynamic relocation will
9396       // have been created for this location, so do not apply it now.
9397       if (!parameters->options().shared())
9398         {
9399           gold_assert(tls_segment != NULL);
9400
9401           // $tp points to the TCB, which is followed by the TLS, so we
9402           // need to add TCB size to the offset.
9403           Arm_address aligned_tcb_size =
9404             align_address(ARM_TCB_SIZE, tls_segment->maximum_alignment());
9405           RelocFuncs::rel32(view, value + aligned_tcb_size);
9406
9407         }
9408       return ArmRelocFuncs::STATUS_OKAY;
9409     
9410     default:
9411       gold_unreachable();
9412     }
9413
9414   gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, rel.get_r_offset(),
9415                          _("unsupported reloc %u"),
9416                          r_type);
9417   return ArmRelocFuncs::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
9418 }
9419
9420 // Relocate section data.
9421
9422 template<bool big_endian>
9423 void
9424 Target_arm<big_endian>::relocate_section(
9425     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
9426     unsigned int sh_type,
9427     const unsigned char* prelocs,
9428     size_t reloc_count,
9429     Output_section* output_section,
9430     bool needs_special_offset_handling,
9431     unsigned char* view,
9432     Arm_address address,
9433     section_size_type view_size,
9434     const Reloc_symbol_changes* reloc_symbol_changes)
9435 {
9436   typedef typename Target_arm<big_endian>::Relocate Arm_relocate;
9437   gold_assert(sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL);
9438
9439   // See if we are relocating a relaxed input section.  If so, the view
9440   // covers the whole output section and we need to adjust accordingly.
9441   if (needs_special_offset_handling)
9442     {
9443       const Output_relaxed_input_section* poris =
9444         output_section->find_relaxed_input_section(relinfo->object,
9445                                                    relinfo->data_shndx);
9446       if (poris != NULL)
9447         {
9448           Arm_address section_address = poris->address();
9449           section_size_type section_size = poris->data_size();
9450
9451           gold_assert((section_address >= address)
9452                       && ((section_address + section_size)
9453                           <= (address + view_size)));
9454
9455           off_t offset = section_address - address;
9456           view += offset;
9457           address += offset;
9458           view_size = section_size;
9459         }
9460     }
9461
9462   gold::relocate_section<32, big_endian, Target_arm, elfcpp::SHT_REL,
9463                          Arm_relocate>(
9464     relinfo,
9465     this,
9466     prelocs,
9467     reloc_count,
9468     output_section,
9469     needs_special_offset_handling,
9470     view,
9471     address,
9472     view_size,
9473     reloc_symbol_changes);
9474 }
9475
9476 // Return the size of a relocation while scanning during a relocatable
9477 // link.
9478
9479 template<bool big_endian>
9480 unsigned int
9481 Target_arm<big_endian>::Relocatable_size_for_reloc::get_size_for_reloc(
9482     unsigned int r_type,
9483     Relobj* object)
9484 {
9485   r_type = get_real_reloc_type(r_type);
9486   const Arm_reloc_property* arp =
9487       arm_reloc_property_table->get_implemented_static_reloc_property(r_type);
9488   if (arp != NULL)
9489     return arp->size();
9490   else
9491     {
9492       std::string reloc_name =
9493         arm_reloc_property_table->reloc_name_in_error_message(r_type);
9494       gold_error(_("%s: unexpected %s in object file"),
9495                  object->name().c_str(), reloc_name.c_str());
9496       return 0;
9497     }
9498 }
9499
9500 // Scan the relocs during a relocatable link.
9501
9502 template<bool big_endian>
9503 void
9504 Target_arm<big_endian>::scan_relocatable_relocs(
9505     Symbol_table* symtab,
9506     Layout* layout,
9507     Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian>* object,
9508     unsigned int data_shndx,
9509     unsigned int sh_type,
9510     const unsigned char* prelocs,
9511     size_t reloc_count,
9512     Output_section* output_section,
9513     bool needs_special_offset_handling,
9514     size_t local_symbol_count,
9515     const unsigned char* plocal_symbols,
9516     Relocatable_relocs* rr)
9517 {
9518   gold_assert(sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL);
9519
9520   typedef Arm_scan_relocatable_relocs<big_endian, elfcpp::SHT_REL,
9521     Relocatable_size_for_reloc> Scan_relocatable_relocs;
9522
9523   gold::scan_relocatable_relocs<32, big_endian, elfcpp::SHT_REL,
9524       Scan_relocatable_relocs>(
9525     symtab,
9526     layout,
9527     object,
9528     data_shndx,
9529     prelocs,
9530     reloc_count,
9531     output_section,
9532     needs_special_offset_handling,
9533     local_symbol_count,
9534     plocal_symbols,
9535     rr);
9536 }
9537
9538 // Relocate a section during a relocatable link.
9539
9540 template<bool big_endian>
9541 void
9542 Target_arm<big_endian>::relocate_for_relocatable(
9543     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
9544     unsigned int sh_type,
9545     const unsigned char* prelocs,
9546     size_t reloc_count,
9547     Output_section* output_section,
9548     off_t offset_in_output_section,
9549     const Relocatable_relocs* rr,
9550     unsigned char* view,
9551     Arm_address view_address,
9552     section_size_type view_size,
9553     unsigned char* reloc_view,
9554     section_size_type reloc_view_size)
9555 {
9556   gold_assert(sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL);
9557
9558   gold::relocate_for_relocatable<32, big_endian, elfcpp::SHT_REL>(
9559     relinfo,
9560     prelocs,
9561     reloc_count,
9562     output_section,
9563     offset_in_output_section,
9564     rr,
9565     view,
9566     view_address,
9567     view_size,
9568     reloc_view,
9569     reloc_view_size);
9570 }
9571
9572 // Perform target-specific processing in a relocatable link.  This is
9573 // only used if we use the relocation strategy RELOC_SPECIAL.
9574
9575 template<bool big_endian>
9576 void
9577 Target_arm<big_endian>::relocate_special_relocatable(
9578     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
9579     unsigned int sh_type,
9580     const unsigned char* preloc_in,
9581     size_t relnum,
9582     Output_section* output_section,
9583     off_t offset_in_output_section,
9584     unsigned char* view,
9585     elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Addr view_address,
9586     section_size_type,
9587     unsigned char* preloc_out)
9588 {
9589   // We can only handle REL type relocation sections.
9590   gold_assert(sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL);
9591
9592   typedef typename Reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_REL, 32, big_endian>::Reloc Reltype;
9593   typedef typename Reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_REL, 32, big_endian>::Reloc_write
9594     Reltype_write;
9595   const Arm_address invalid_address = static_cast<Arm_address>(0) - 1;
9596
9597   const Arm_relobj<big_endian>* object =
9598     Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(relinfo->object);
9599   const unsigned int local_count = object->local_symbol_count();
9600
9601   Reltype reloc(preloc_in);
9602   Reltype_write reloc_write(preloc_out);
9603
9604   elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_WXword r_info = reloc.get_r_info();
9605   const unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(r_info);
9606   const unsigned int r_type = elfcpp::elf_r_type<32>(r_info);
9607
9608   const Arm_reloc_property* arp =
9609     arm_reloc_property_table->get_implemented_static_reloc_property(r_type);
9610   gold_assert(arp != NULL);
9611
9612   // Get the new symbol index.
9613   // We only use RELOC_SPECIAL strategy in local relocations.
9614   gold_assert(r_sym < local_count);
9615
9616   // We are adjusting a section symbol.  We need to find
9617   // the symbol table index of the section symbol for
9618   // the output section corresponding to input section
9619   // in which this symbol is defined.
9620   bool is_ordinary;
9621   unsigned int shndx = object->local_symbol_input_shndx(r_sym, &is_ordinary);
9622   gold_assert(is_ordinary);
9623   Output_section* os = object->output_section(shndx);
9624   gold_assert(os != NULL);
9625   gold_assert(os->needs_symtab_index());
9626   unsigned int new_symndx = os->symtab_index();
9627
9628   // Get the new offset--the location in the output section where
9629   // this relocation should be applied.
9630
9631   Arm_address offset = reloc.get_r_offset();
9632   Arm_address new_offset;
9633   if (offset_in_output_section != invalid_address)
9634     new_offset = offset + offset_in_output_section;
9635   else
9636     {
9637       section_offset_type sot_offset =
9638           convert_types<section_offset_type, Arm_address>(offset);
9639       section_offset_type new_sot_offset =
9640           output_section->output_offset(object, relinfo->data_shndx,
9641                                         sot_offset);
9642       gold_assert(new_sot_offset != -1);
9643       new_offset = new_sot_offset;
9644     }
9645
9646   // In an object file, r_offset is an offset within the section.
9647   // In an executable or dynamic object, generated by
9648   // --emit-relocs, r_offset is an absolute address.
9649   if (!parameters->options().relocatable())
9650     {
9651       new_offset += view_address;
9652       if (offset_in_output_section != invalid_address)
9653         new_offset -= offset_in_output_section;
9654     }
9655
9656   reloc_write.put_r_offset(new_offset);
9657   reloc_write.put_r_info(elfcpp::elf_r_info<32>(new_symndx, r_type));
9658
9659   // Handle the reloc addend.
9660   // The relocation uses a section symbol in the input file.
9661   // We are adjusting it to use a section symbol in the output
9662   // file.  The input section symbol refers to some address in
9663   // the input section.  We need the relocation in the output
9664   // file to refer to that same address.  This adjustment to
9665   // the addend is the same calculation we use for a simple
9666   // absolute relocation for the input section symbol.
9667
9668   const Symbol_value<32>* psymval = object->local_symbol(r_sym);
9669
9670   // Handle THUMB bit.
9671   Symbol_value<32> symval;
9672   Arm_address thumb_bit =
9673      object->local_symbol_is_thumb_function(r_sym) ? 1 : 0;
9674   if (thumb_bit != 0
9675       && arp->uses_thumb_bit() 
9676       && ((psymval->value(object, 0) & 1) != 0))
9677     {
9678       Arm_address stripped_value =
9679         psymval->value(object, 0) & ~static_cast<Arm_address>(1);
9680       symval.set_output_value(stripped_value);
9681       psymval = &symval;
9682     } 
9683
9684   unsigned char* paddend = view + offset;
9685   typename Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::Status reloc_status =
9686         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::STATUS_OKAY;
9687   switch (r_type)
9688     {
9689     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS8:
9690       reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::abs8(paddend, object,
9691                                                               psymval);
9692       break;
9693
9694     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS12:
9695       reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::abs12(paddend, object,
9696                                                                psymval);
9697       break;
9698
9699     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS16:
9700       reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::abs16(paddend, object,
9701                                                                psymval);
9702       break;
9703
9704     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_ABS5:
9705       reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thm_abs5(paddend,
9706                                                                   object,
9707                                                                   psymval);
9708       break;
9709
9710     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
9711     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
9712     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
9713     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVW_BREL:
9714       reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::movw(
9715           paddend, object, psymval, 0, thumb_bit, arp->checks_overflow());
9716       break;
9717
9718     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_ABS_NC:
9719     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_PREL_NC:
9720     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL_NC:
9721     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVW_BREL:
9722       reloc_status = Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thm_movw(
9723           paddend, object, psymval, 0, thumb_bit, arp->checks_overflow());
9724       break;
9725
9726     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL:
9727     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_XPC22:
9728     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
9729       reloc_status =
9730         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thumb_branch_common(
9731             r_type, relinfo, paddend, NULL, object, 0, psymval, 0, thumb_bit,
9732             false);
9733       break;
9734
9735     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32:
9736     case elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL:
9737     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24:
9738     case elfcpp::R_ARM_XPC25:
9739       reloc_status =
9740         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::arm_branch_common(
9741             r_type, relinfo, paddend, NULL, object, 0, psymval, 0, thumb_bit,
9742             false);
9743       break;
9744
9745     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
9746       reloc_status =
9747         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thm_jump19(paddend, object,
9748                                                        psymval, 0, thumb_bit);
9749       break;
9750
9751     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP6:
9752       reloc_status =
9753         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thm_jump6(paddend, object, psymval,
9754                                                       0);
9755       break;
9756
9757     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP8:
9758       reloc_status =
9759         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thm_jump8(paddend, object, psymval,
9760                                                       0);
9761       break;
9762
9763     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP11:
9764       reloc_status =
9765         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thm_jump11(paddend, object, psymval,
9766                                                        0);
9767       break;
9768
9769     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PREL31:
9770       reloc_status =
9771         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::prel31(paddend, object, psymval, 0,
9772                                                    thumb_bit);
9773       break;
9774
9775     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_PC8:
9776       reloc_status =
9777         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thm_pc8(paddend, object, psymval,
9778                                                     0);
9779       break;
9780
9781     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_PC12:
9782       reloc_status =
9783         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thm_pc12(paddend, object, psymval,
9784                                                      0);
9785       break;
9786
9787     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_ALU_PREL_11_0:
9788       reloc_status =
9789         Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::thm_alu11(paddend, object, psymval,
9790                                                       0, thumb_bit);
9791       break;
9792
9793     // These relocation truncate relocation results so we cannot handle them
9794     // in a relocatable link.
9795     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_ABS:
9796     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_ABS:
9797     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_PREL:
9798     case elfcpp::R_ARM_MOVT_BREL:
9799     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_PREL:
9800     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_MOVT_BREL:
9801     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0_NC:
9802     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G0:
9803     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1_NC:
9804     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G1:
9805     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_PC_G2:
9806     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0_NC:
9807     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G0:
9808     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1_NC:
9809     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G1:
9810     case elfcpp::R_ARM_ALU_SB_G2:
9811     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G0:
9812     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G1:
9813     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_PC_G2:
9814     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G0:
9815     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G1:
9816     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDR_SB_G2:
9817     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G0:
9818     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G1:
9819     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_PC_G2:
9820     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G0:
9821     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G1:
9822     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDRS_SB_G2:
9823     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G0:
9824     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G1:
9825     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_PC_G2:
9826     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G0:
9827     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G1:
9828     case elfcpp::R_ARM_LDC_SB_G2:
9829       gold_error(_("cannot handle %s in a relocatable link"),
9830                  arp->name().c_str());
9831       break;
9832
9833     default:
9834       gold_unreachable();
9835     }
9836
9837   // Report any errors.
9838   switch (reloc_status)
9839     {
9840     case Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::STATUS_OKAY:
9841       break;
9842     case Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::STATUS_OVERFLOW:
9843       gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, reloc.get_r_offset(),
9844                              _("relocation overflow in %s"),
9845                              arp->name().c_str());
9846       break;
9847     case Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian>::STATUS_BAD_RELOC:
9848       gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, reloc.get_r_offset(),
9849         _("unexpected opcode while processing relocation %s"),
9850         arp->name().c_str());
9851       break;
9852     default:
9853       gold_unreachable();
9854     }
9855 }
9856
9857 // Return the value to use for a dynamic symbol which requires special
9858 // treatment.  This is how we support equality comparisons of function
9859 // pointers across shared library boundaries, as described in the
9860 // processor specific ABI supplement.
9861
9862 template<bool big_endian>
9863 uint64_t
9864 Target_arm<big_endian>::do_dynsym_value(const Symbol* gsym) const
9865 {
9866   gold_assert(gsym->is_from_dynobj() && gsym->has_plt_offset());
9867   return this->plt_section()->address() + gsym->plt_offset();
9868 }
9869
9870 // Map platform-specific relocs to real relocs
9871 //
9872 template<bool big_endian>
9873 unsigned int
9874 Target_arm<big_endian>::get_real_reloc_type(unsigned int r_type)
9875 {
9876   switch (r_type)
9877     {
9878     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET1:
9879       // This is either R_ARM_ABS32 or R_ARM_REL32;
9880       return elfcpp::R_ARM_ABS32;
9881
9882     case elfcpp::R_ARM_TARGET2:
9883       // This can be any reloc type but usually is R_ARM_GOT_PREL
9884       return elfcpp::R_ARM_GOT_PREL;
9885
9886     default:
9887       return r_type;
9888     }
9889 }
9890
9891 // Whether if two EABI versions V1 and V2 are compatible.
9892
9893 template<bool big_endian>
9894 bool
9895 Target_arm<big_endian>::are_eabi_versions_compatible(
9896     elfcpp::Elf_Word v1,
9897     elfcpp::Elf_Word v2)
9898 {
9899   // v4 and v5 are the same spec before and after it was released,
9900   // so allow mixing them.
9901   if ((v1 == elfcpp::EF_ARM_EABI_UNKNOWN || v2 == elfcpp::EF_ARM_EABI_UNKNOWN)
9902       || (v1 == elfcpp::EF_ARM_EABI_VER4 && v2 == elfcpp::EF_ARM_EABI_VER5)
9903       || (v1 == elfcpp::EF_ARM_EABI_VER5 && v2 == elfcpp::EF_ARM_EABI_VER4))
9904     return true;
9905
9906   return v1 == v2;
9907 }
9908
9909 // Combine FLAGS from an input object called NAME and the processor-specific
9910 // flags in the ELF header of the output.  Much of this is adapted from the
9911 // processor-specific flags merging code in elf32_arm_merge_private_bfd_data
9912 // in bfd/elf32-arm.c.
9913
9914 template<bool big_endian>
9915 void
9916 Target_arm<big_endian>::merge_processor_specific_flags(
9917     const std::string& name,
9918     elfcpp::Elf_Word flags)
9919 {
9920   if (this->are_processor_specific_flags_set())
9921     {
9922       elfcpp::Elf_Word out_flags = this->processor_specific_flags();
9923
9924       // Nothing to merge if flags equal to those in output.
9925       if (flags == out_flags)
9926         return;
9927
9928       // Complain about various flag mismatches.
9929       elfcpp::Elf_Word version1 = elfcpp::arm_eabi_version(flags);
9930       elfcpp::Elf_Word version2 = elfcpp::arm_eabi_version(out_flags);
9931       if (!this->are_eabi_versions_compatible(version1, version2)
9932           && parameters->options().warn_mismatch())
9933         gold_error(_("Source object %s has EABI version %d but output has "
9934                      "EABI version %d."),
9935                    name.c_str(),
9936                    (flags & elfcpp::EF_ARM_EABIMASK) >> 24,
9937                    (out_flags & elfcpp::EF_ARM_EABIMASK) >> 24);
9938     }
9939   else
9940     {
9941       // If the input is the default architecture and had the default
9942       // flags then do not bother setting the flags for the output
9943       // architecture, instead allow future merges to do this.  If no
9944       // future merges ever set these flags then they will retain their
9945       // uninitialised values, which surprise surprise, correspond
9946       // to the default values.
9947       if (flags == 0)
9948         return;
9949
9950       // This is the first time, just copy the flags.
9951       // We only copy the EABI version for now.
9952       this->set_processor_specific_flags(flags & elfcpp::EF_ARM_EABIMASK);
9953     }
9954 }
9955
9956 // Adjust ELF file header.
9957 template<bool big_endian>
9958 void
9959 Target_arm<big_endian>::do_adjust_elf_header(
9960     unsigned char* view,
9961     int len) const
9962 {
9963   gold_assert(len == elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::ehdr_size);
9964
9965   elfcpp::Ehdr<32, big_endian> ehdr(view);
9966   unsigned char e_ident[elfcpp::EI_NIDENT];
9967   memcpy(e_ident, ehdr.get_e_ident(), elfcpp::EI_NIDENT);
9968
9969   if (elfcpp::arm_eabi_version(this->processor_specific_flags())
9970       == elfcpp::EF_ARM_EABI_UNKNOWN)
9971     e_ident[elfcpp::EI_OSABI] = elfcpp::ELFOSABI_ARM;
9972   else
9973     e_ident[elfcpp::EI_OSABI] = 0;
9974   e_ident[elfcpp::EI_ABIVERSION] = 0;
9975
9976   // FIXME: Do EF_ARM_BE8 adjustment.
9977
9978   elfcpp::Ehdr_write<32, big_endian> oehdr(view);
9979   oehdr.put_e_ident(e_ident);
9980 }
9981
9982 // do_make_elf_object to override the same function in the base class.
9983 // We need to use a target-specific sub-class of
9984 // Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian> to store ARM specific information.
9985 // Hence we need to have our own ELF object creation.
9986
9987 template<bool big_endian>
9988 Object*
9989 Target_arm<big_endian>::do_make_elf_object(
9990     const std::string& name,
9991     Input_file* input_file,
9992     off_t offset, const elfcpp::Ehdr<32, big_endian>& ehdr)
9993 {
9994   int et = ehdr.get_e_type();
9995   if (et == elfcpp::ET_REL)
9996     {
9997       Arm_relobj<big_endian>* obj =
9998         new Arm_relobj<big_endian>(name, input_file, offset, ehdr);
9999       obj->setup();
10000       return obj;
10001     }
10002   else if (et == elfcpp::ET_DYN)
10003     {
10004       Sized_dynobj<32, big_endian>* obj =
10005         new Arm_dynobj<big_endian>(name, input_file, offset, ehdr);
10006       obj->setup();
10007       return obj;
10008     }
10009   else
10010     {
10011       gold_error(_("%s: unsupported ELF file type %d"),
10012                  name.c_str(), et);
10013       return NULL;
10014     }
10015 }
10016
10017 // Read the architecture from the Tag_also_compatible_with attribute, if any.
10018 // Returns -1 if no architecture could be read.
10019 // This is adapted from get_secondary_compatible_arch() in bfd/elf32-arm.c.
10020
10021 template<bool big_endian>
10022 int
10023 Target_arm<big_endian>::get_secondary_compatible_arch(
10024     const Attributes_section_data* pasd)
10025 {
10026   const Object_attribute* known_attributes =
10027     pasd->known_attributes(Object_attribute::OBJ_ATTR_PROC);
10028
10029   // Note: the tag and its argument below are uleb128 values, though
10030   // currently-defined values fit in one byte for each.
10031   const std::string& sv =
10032     known_attributes[elfcpp::Tag_also_compatible_with].string_value();
10033   if (sv.size() == 2
10034       && sv.data()[0] == elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch
10035       && (sv.data()[1] & 128) != 128)
10036    return sv.data()[1];
10037
10038   // This tag is "safely ignorable", so don't complain if it looks funny.
10039   return -1;
10040 }
10041
10042 // Set, or unset, the architecture of the Tag_also_compatible_with attribute.
10043 // The tag is removed if ARCH is -1.
10044 // This is adapted from set_secondary_compatible_arch() in bfd/elf32-arm.c.
10045
10046 template<bool big_endian>
10047 void
10048 Target_arm<big_endian>::set_secondary_compatible_arch(
10049     Attributes_section_data* pasd,
10050     int arch)
10051 {
10052   Object_attribute* known_attributes =
10053     pasd->known_attributes(Object_attribute::OBJ_ATTR_PROC);
10054
10055   if (arch == -1)
10056     {
10057       known_attributes[elfcpp::Tag_also_compatible_with].set_string_value("");
10058       return;
10059     }
10060
10061   // Note: the tag and its argument below are uleb128 values, though
10062   // currently-defined values fit in one byte for each.
10063   char sv[3];
10064   sv[0] = elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch;
10065   gold_assert(arch != 0);
10066   sv[1] = arch;
10067   sv[2] = '\0';
10068
10069   known_attributes[elfcpp::Tag_also_compatible_with].set_string_value(sv);
10070 }
10071
10072 // Combine two values for Tag_CPU_arch, taking secondary compatibility tags
10073 // into account.
10074 // This is adapted from tag_cpu_arch_combine() in bfd/elf32-arm.c.
10075
10076 template<bool big_endian>
10077 int
10078 Target_arm<big_endian>::tag_cpu_arch_combine(
10079     const char* name,
10080     int oldtag,
10081     int* secondary_compat_out,
10082     int newtag,
10083     int secondary_compat)
10084 {
10085 #define T(X) elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_##X
10086   static const int v6t2[] =
10087     {
10088       T(V6T2),   // PRE_V4.
10089       T(V6T2),   // V4.
10090       T(V6T2),   // V4T.
10091       T(V6T2),   // V5T.
10092       T(V6T2),   // V5TE.
10093       T(V6T2),   // V5TEJ.
10094       T(V6T2),   // V6.
10095       T(V7),     // V6KZ.
10096       T(V6T2)    // V6T2.
10097     };
10098   static const int v6k[] =
10099     {
10100       T(V6K),    // PRE_V4.
10101       T(V6K),    // V4.
10102       T(V6K),    // V4T.
10103       T(V6K),    // V5T.
10104       T(V6K),    // V5TE.
10105       T(V6K),    // V5TEJ.
10106       T(V6K),    // V6.
10107       T(V6KZ),   // V6KZ.
10108       T(V7),     // V6T2.
10109       T(V6K)     // V6K.
10110     };
10111   static const int v7[] =
10112     {
10113       T(V7),     // PRE_V4.
10114       T(V7),     // V4.
10115       T(V7),     // V4T.
10116       T(V7),     // V5T.
10117       T(V7),     // V5TE.
10118       T(V7),     // V5TEJ.
10119       T(V7),     // V6.
10120       T(V7),     // V6KZ.
10121       T(V7),     // V6T2.
10122       T(V7),     // V6K.
10123       T(V7)      // V7.
10124     };
10125   static const int v6_m[] =
10126     {
10127       -1,        // PRE_V4.
10128       -1,        // V4.
10129       T(V6K),    // V4T.
10130       T(V6K),    // V5T.
10131       T(V6K),    // V5TE.
10132       T(V6K),    // V5TEJ.
10133       T(V6K),    // V6.
10134       T(V6KZ),   // V6KZ.
10135       T(V7),     // V6T2.
10136       T(V6K),    // V6K.
10137       T(V7),     // V7.
10138       T(V6_M)    // V6_M.
10139     };
10140   static const int v6s_m[] =
10141     {
10142       -1,        // PRE_V4.
10143       -1,        // V4.
10144       T(V6K),    // V4T.
10145       T(V6K),    // V5T.
10146       T(V6K),    // V5TE.
10147       T(V6K),    // V5TEJ.
10148       T(V6K),    // V6.
10149       T(V6KZ),   // V6KZ.
10150       T(V7),     // V6T2.
10151       T(V6K),    // V6K.
10152       T(V7),     // V7.
10153       T(V6S_M),  // V6_M.
10154       T(V6S_M)   // V6S_M.
10155     };
10156   static const int v7e_m[] =
10157     {
10158       -1,       // PRE_V4.
10159       -1,       // V4.
10160       T(V7E_M), // V4T.
10161       T(V7E_M), // V5T.
10162       T(V7E_M), // V5TE.
10163       T(V7E_M), // V5TEJ.
10164       T(V7E_M), // V6.
10165       T(V7E_M), // V6KZ.
10166       T(V7E_M), // V6T2.
10167       T(V7E_M), // V6K.
10168       T(V7E_M), // V7.
10169       T(V7E_M), // V6_M.
10170       T(V7E_M), // V6S_M.
10171       T(V7E_M)  // V7E_M.
10172     };
10173   static const int v4t_plus_v6_m[] =
10174     {
10175       -1,               // PRE_V4.
10176       -1,               // V4.
10177       T(V4T),           // V4T.
10178       T(V5T),           // V5T.
10179       T(V5TE),          // V5TE.
10180       T(V5TEJ),         // V5TEJ.
10181       T(V6),            // V6.
10182       T(V6KZ),          // V6KZ.
10183       T(V6T2),          // V6T2.
10184       T(V6K),           // V6K.
10185       T(V7),            // V7.
10186       T(V6_M),          // V6_M.
10187       T(V6S_M),         // V6S_M.
10188       T(V7E_M),         // V7E_M.
10189       T(V4T_PLUS_V6_M)  // V4T plus V6_M.
10190     };
10191   static const int* comb[] =
10192     {
10193       v6t2,
10194       v6k,
10195       v7,
10196       v6_m,
10197       v6s_m,
10198       v7e_m,
10199       // Pseudo-architecture.
10200       v4t_plus_v6_m
10201     };
10202
10203   // Check we've not got a higher architecture than we know about.
10204
10205   if (oldtag > elfcpp::MAX_TAG_CPU_ARCH || newtag > elfcpp::MAX_TAG_CPU_ARCH)
10206     {
10207       gold_error(_("%s: unknown CPU architecture"), name);
10208       return -1;
10209     }
10210
10211   // Override old tag if we have a Tag_also_compatible_with on the output.
10212
10213   if ((oldtag == T(V6_M) && *secondary_compat_out == T(V4T))
10214       || (oldtag == T(V4T) && *secondary_compat_out == T(V6_M)))
10215     oldtag = T(V4T_PLUS_V6_M);
10216
10217   // And override the new tag if we have a Tag_also_compatible_with on the
10218   // input.
10219
10220   if ((newtag == T(V6_M) && secondary_compat == T(V4T))
10221       || (newtag == T(V4T) && secondary_compat == T(V6_M)))
10222     newtag = T(V4T_PLUS_V6_M);
10223
10224   // Architectures before V6KZ add features monotonically.
10225   int tagh = std::max(oldtag, newtag);
10226   if (tagh <= elfcpp::TAG_CPU_ARCH_V6KZ)
10227     return tagh;
10228
10229   int tagl = std::min(oldtag, newtag);
10230   int result = comb[tagh - T(V6T2)][tagl];
10231
10232   // Use Tag_CPU_arch == V4T and Tag_also_compatible_with (Tag_CPU_arch V6_M)
10233   // as the canonical version.
10234   if (result == T(V4T_PLUS_V6_M))
10235     {
10236       result = T(V4T);
10237       *secondary_compat_out = T(V6_M);
10238     }
10239   else
10240     *secondary_compat_out = -1;
10241
10242   if (result == -1)
10243     {
10244       gold_error(_("%s: conflicting CPU architectures %d/%d"),
10245                  name, oldtag, newtag);
10246       return -1;
10247     }
10248
10249   return result;
10250 #undef T
10251 }
10252
10253 // Helper to print AEABI enum tag value.
10254
10255 template<bool big_endian>
10256 std::string
10257 Target_arm<big_endian>::aeabi_enum_name(unsigned int value)
10258 {
10259   static const char* aeabi_enum_names[] =
10260     { "", "variable-size", "32-bit", "" };
10261   const size_t aeabi_enum_names_size =
10262     sizeof(aeabi_enum_names) / sizeof(aeabi_enum_names[0]);
10263
10264   if (value < aeabi_enum_names_size)
10265     return std::string(aeabi_enum_names[value]);
10266   else
10267     {
10268       char buffer[100];
10269       sprintf(buffer, "<unknown value %u>", value);
10270       return std::string(buffer);
10271     }
10272 }
10273
10274 // Return the string value to store in TAG_CPU_name.
10275
10276 template<bool big_endian>
10277 std::string
10278 Target_arm<big_endian>::tag_cpu_name_value(unsigned int value)
10279 {
10280   static const char* name_table[] = {
10281     // These aren't real CPU names, but we can't guess
10282     // that from the architecture version alone.
10283    "Pre v4",
10284    "ARM v4",
10285    "ARM v4T",
10286    "ARM v5T",
10287    "ARM v5TE",
10288    "ARM v5TEJ",
10289    "ARM v6",
10290    "ARM v6KZ",
10291    "ARM v6T2",
10292    "ARM v6K",
10293    "ARM v7",
10294    "ARM v6-M",
10295    "ARM v6S-M",
10296    "ARM v7E-M"
10297  };
10298  const size_t name_table_size = sizeof(name_table) / sizeof(name_table[0]);
10299
10300   if (value < name_table_size)
10301     return std::string(name_table[value]);
10302   else
10303     {
10304       char buffer[100];
10305       sprintf(buffer, "<unknown CPU value %u>", value);
10306       return std::string(buffer);
10307     } 
10308 }
10309
10310 // Merge object attributes from input file called NAME with those of the
10311 // output.  The input object attributes are in the object pointed by PASD.
10312
10313 template<bool big_endian>
10314 void
10315 Target_arm<big_endian>::merge_object_attributes(
10316     const char* name,
10317     const Attributes_section_data* pasd)
10318 {
10319   // Return if there is no attributes section data.
10320   if (pasd == NULL)
10321     return;
10322
10323   // If output has no object attributes, just copy.
10324   const int vendor = Object_attribute::OBJ_ATTR_PROC;
10325   if (this->attributes_section_data_ == NULL)
10326     {
10327       this->attributes_section_data_ = new Attributes_section_data(*pasd);
10328       Object_attribute* out_attr =
10329         this->attributes_section_data_->known_attributes(vendor);
10330
10331       // We do not output objects with Tag_MPextension_use_legacy - we move
10332       //  the attribute's value to Tag_MPextension_use.  */
10333       if (out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use_legacy].int_value() != 0)
10334         {
10335           if (out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use].int_value() != 0
10336               && out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use_legacy].int_value()
10337                 != out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use].int_value())
10338             {
10339               gold_error(_("%s has both the current and legacy "
10340                            "Tag_MPextension_use attributes"),
10341                          name);
10342             }
10343
10344           out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use] =
10345             out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use_legacy];
10346           out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use_legacy].set_type(0);
10347           out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use_legacy].set_int_value(0);
10348         }
10349
10350       return;
10351     }
10352
10353   const Object_attribute* in_attr = pasd->known_attributes(vendor);
10354   Object_attribute* out_attr =
10355     this->attributes_section_data_->known_attributes(vendor);
10356
10357   // This needs to happen before Tag_ABI_FP_number_model is merged.  */
10358   if (in_attr[elfcpp::Tag_ABI_VFP_args].int_value()
10359       != out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_ABI_VFP_args].int_value())
10360     {
10361       // Ignore mismatches if the object doesn't use floating point.  */
10362       if (out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_ABI_FP_number_model].int_value() == 0)
10363         out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_ABI_VFP_args].set_int_value(
10364             in_attr[elfcpp::Tag_ABI_VFP_args].int_value());
10365       else if (in_attr[elfcpp::Tag_ABI_FP_number_model].int_value() != 0
10366                && parameters->options().warn_mismatch())
10367         gold_error(_("%s uses VFP register arguments, output does not"),
10368                    name);
10369     }
10370
10371   for (int i = 4; i < Vendor_object_attributes::NUM_KNOWN_ATTRIBUTES; ++i)
10372     {
10373       // Merge this attribute with existing attributes.
10374       switch (i)
10375         {
10376         case elfcpp::Tag_CPU_raw_name:
10377         case elfcpp::Tag_CPU_name:
10378           // These are merged after Tag_CPU_arch.
10379           break;
10380
10381         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_optimization_goals:
10382         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_FP_optimization_goals:
10383           // Use the first value seen.
10384           break;
10385
10386         case elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch:
10387           {
10388             unsigned int saved_out_attr = out_attr->int_value();
10389             // Merge Tag_CPU_arch and Tag_also_compatible_with.
10390             int secondary_compat =
10391               this->get_secondary_compatible_arch(pasd);
10392             int secondary_compat_out =
10393               this->get_secondary_compatible_arch(
10394                   this->attributes_section_data_);
10395             out_attr[i].set_int_value(
10396                 tag_cpu_arch_combine(name, out_attr[i].int_value(),
10397                                      &secondary_compat_out,
10398                                      in_attr[i].int_value(),
10399                                      secondary_compat));
10400             this->set_secondary_compatible_arch(this->attributes_section_data_,
10401                                                 secondary_compat_out);
10402
10403             // Merge Tag_CPU_name and Tag_CPU_raw_name.
10404             if (out_attr[i].int_value() == saved_out_attr)
10405               ; // Leave the names alone.
10406             else if (out_attr[i].int_value() == in_attr[i].int_value())
10407               {
10408                 // The output architecture has been changed to match the
10409                 // input architecture.  Use the input names.
10410                 out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_CPU_name].set_string_value(
10411                     in_attr[elfcpp::Tag_CPU_name].string_value());
10412                 out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_CPU_raw_name].set_string_value(
10413                     in_attr[elfcpp::Tag_CPU_raw_name].string_value());
10414               }
10415             else
10416               {
10417                 out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_CPU_name].set_string_value("");
10418                 out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_CPU_raw_name].set_string_value("");
10419               }
10420
10421             // If we still don't have a value for Tag_CPU_name,
10422             // make one up now.  Tag_CPU_raw_name remains blank.
10423             if (out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_CPU_name].string_value() == "")
10424               {
10425                 const std::string cpu_name =
10426                   this->tag_cpu_name_value(out_attr[i].int_value());
10427                 // FIXME:  If we see an unknown CPU, this will be set
10428                 // to "<unknown CPU n>", where n is the attribute value.
10429                 // This is different from BFD, which leaves the name alone.
10430                 out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_CPU_name].set_string_value(cpu_name);
10431               }
10432           }
10433           break;
10434
10435         case elfcpp::Tag_ARM_ISA_use:
10436         case elfcpp::Tag_THUMB_ISA_use:
10437         case elfcpp::Tag_WMMX_arch:
10438         case elfcpp::Tag_Advanced_SIMD_arch:
10439           // ??? Do Advanced_SIMD (NEON) and WMMX conflict?
10440         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_FP_rounding:
10441         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_FP_exceptions:
10442         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_FP_user_exceptions:
10443         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_FP_number_model:
10444         case elfcpp::Tag_VFP_HP_extension:
10445         case elfcpp::Tag_CPU_unaligned_access:
10446         case elfcpp::Tag_T2EE_use:
10447         case elfcpp::Tag_Virtualization_use:
10448         case elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use:
10449           // Use the largest value specified.
10450           if (in_attr[i].int_value() > out_attr[i].int_value())
10451             out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10452           break;
10453
10454         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_align8_preserved:
10455         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_PCS_RO_data:
10456           // Use the smallest value specified.
10457           if (in_attr[i].int_value() < out_attr[i].int_value())
10458             out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10459           break;
10460
10461         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_align8_needed:
10462           if ((in_attr[i].int_value() > 0 || out_attr[i].int_value() > 0)
10463               && (in_attr[elfcpp::Tag_ABI_align8_preserved].int_value() == 0
10464                   || (out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_ABI_align8_preserved].int_value()
10465                       == 0)))
10466             {
10467               // This error message should be enabled once all non-conforming
10468               // binaries in the toolchain have had the attributes set
10469               // properly.
10470               // gold_error(_("output 8-byte data alignment conflicts with %s"),
10471               //            name);
10472             }
10473           // Fall through.
10474         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_FP_denormal:
10475         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_PCS_GOT_use:
10476           {
10477             // These tags have 0 = don't care, 1 = strong requirement,
10478             // 2 = weak requirement.
10479             static const int order_021[3] = {0, 2, 1};
10480
10481             // Use the "greatest" from the sequence 0, 2, 1, or the largest
10482             // value if greater than 2 (for future-proofing).
10483             if ((in_attr[i].int_value() > 2
10484                  && in_attr[i].int_value() > out_attr[i].int_value())
10485                 || (in_attr[i].int_value() <= 2
10486                     && out_attr[i].int_value() <= 2
10487                     && (order_021[in_attr[i].int_value()]
10488                         > order_021[out_attr[i].int_value()])))
10489               out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10490           }
10491           break;
10492
10493         case elfcpp::Tag_CPU_arch_profile:
10494           if (out_attr[i].int_value() != in_attr[i].int_value())
10495             {
10496               // 0 will merge with anything.
10497               // 'A' and 'S' merge to 'A'.
10498               // 'R' and 'S' merge to 'R'.
10499               // 'M' and 'A|R|S' is an error.
10500               if (out_attr[i].int_value() == 0
10501                   || (out_attr[i].int_value() == 'S'
10502                       && (in_attr[i].int_value() == 'A'
10503                           || in_attr[i].int_value() == 'R')))
10504                 out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10505               else if (in_attr[i].int_value() == 0
10506                        || (in_attr[i].int_value() == 'S'
10507                            && (out_attr[i].int_value() == 'A'
10508                                || out_attr[i].int_value() == 'R')))
10509                 ; // Do nothing.
10510               else if (parameters->options().warn_mismatch())
10511                 {
10512                   gold_error
10513                     (_("conflicting architecture profiles %c/%c"),
10514                      in_attr[i].int_value() ? in_attr[i].int_value() : '0',
10515                      out_attr[i].int_value() ? out_attr[i].int_value() : '0');
10516                 }
10517             }
10518           break;
10519         case elfcpp::Tag_VFP_arch:
10520             {
10521               static const struct
10522               {
10523                   int ver;
10524                   int regs;
10525               } vfp_versions[7] =
10526                 {
10527                   {0, 0},
10528                   {1, 16},
10529                   {2, 16},
10530                   {3, 32},
10531                   {3, 16},
10532                   {4, 32},
10533                   {4, 16}
10534                 };
10535
10536               // Values greater than 6 aren't defined, so just pick the
10537               // biggest.
10538               if (in_attr[i].int_value() > 6
10539                   && in_attr[i].int_value() > out_attr[i].int_value())
10540                 {
10541                   *out_attr = *in_attr;
10542                   break;
10543                 }
10544               // The output uses the superset of input features
10545               // (ISA version) and registers.
10546               int ver = std::max(vfp_versions[in_attr[i].int_value()].ver,
10547                                  vfp_versions[out_attr[i].int_value()].ver);
10548               int regs = std::max(vfp_versions[in_attr[i].int_value()].regs,
10549                                   vfp_versions[out_attr[i].int_value()].regs);
10550               // This assumes all possible supersets are also a valid
10551               // options.
10552               int newval;
10553               for (newval = 6; newval > 0; newval--)
10554                 {
10555                   if (regs == vfp_versions[newval].regs
10556                       && ver == vfp_versions[newval].ver)
10557                     break;
10558                 }
10559               out_attr[i].set_int_value(newval);
10560             }
10561           break;
10562         case elfcpp::Tag_PCS_config:
10563           if (out_attr[i].int_value() == 0)
10564             out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10565           else if (in_attr[i].int_value() != 0
10566                    && out_attr[i].int_value() != 0
10567                    && parameters->options().warn_mismatch())
10568             {
10569               // It's sometimes ok to mix different configs, so this is only
10570               // a warning.
10571               gold_warning(_("%s: conflicting platform configuration"), name);
10572             }
10573           break;
10574         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_PCS_R9_use:
10575           if (in_attr[i].int_value() != out_attr[i].int_value()
10576               && out_attr[i].int_value() != elfcpp::AEABI_R9_unused
10577               && in_attr[i].int_value() != elfcpp::AEABI_R9_unused
10578               && parameters->options().warn_mismatch())
10579             {
10580               gold_error(_("%s: conflicting use of R9"), name);
10581             }
10582           if (out_attr[i].int_value() == elfcpp::AEABI_R9_unused)
10583             out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10584           break;
10585         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_PCS_RW_data:
10586           if (in_attr[i].int_value() == elfcpp::AEABI_PCS_RW_data_SBrel
10587               && (in_attr[elfcpp::Tag_ABI_PCS_R9_use].int_value()
10588                   != elfcpp::AEABI_R9_SB)
10589               && (out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_ABI_PCS_R9_use].int_value()
10590                   != elfcpp::AEABI_R9_unused)
10591               && parameters->options().warn_mismatch())
10592             {
10593               gold_error(_("%s: SB relative addressing conflicts with use "
10594                            "of R9"),
10595                            name);
10596             }
10597           // Use the smallest value specified.
10598           if (in_attr[i].int_value() < out_attr[i].int_value())
10599             out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10600           break;
10601         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_PCS_wchar_t:
10602           if (out_attr[i].int_value()
10603               && in_attr[i].int_value()
10604               && out_attr[i].int_value() != in_attr[i].int_value()
10605               && parameters->options().warn_mismatch()
10606               && parameters->options().wchar_size_warning())
10607             {
10608               gold_warning(_("%s uses %u-byte wchar_t yet the output is to "
10609                              "use %u-byte wchar_t; use of wchar_t values "
10610                              "across objects may fail"),
10611                            name, in_attr[i].int_value(),
10612                            out_attr[i].int_value());
10613             }
10614           else if (in_attr[i].int_value() && !out_attr[i].int_value())
10615             out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10616           break;
10617         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_enum_size:
10618           if (in_attr[i].int_value() != elfcpp::AEABI_enum_unused)
10619             {
10620               if (out_attr[i].int_value() == elfcpp::AEABI_enum_unused
10621                   || out_attr[i].int_value() == elfcpp::AEABI_enum_forced_wide)
10622                 {
10623                   // The existing object is compatible with anything.
10624                   // Use whatever requirements the new object has.
10625                   out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10626                 }
10627               else if (in_attr[i].int_value() != elfcpp::AEABI_enum_forced_wide
10628                        && out_attr[i].int_value() != in_attr[i].int_value()
10629                        && parameters->options().warn_mismatch()
10630                        && parameters->options().enum_size_warning())
10631                 {
10632                   unsigned int in_value = in_attr[i].int_value();
10633                   unsigned int out_value = out_attr[i].int_value();
10634                   gold_warning(_("%s uses %s enums yet the output is to use "
10635                                  "%s enums; use of enum values across objects "
10636                                  "may fail"),
10637                                name,
10638                                this->aeabi_enum_name(in_value).c_str(),
10639                                this->aeabi_enum_name(out_value).c_str());
10640                 }
10641             }
10642           break;
10643         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_VFP_args:
10644           // Already done.
10645           break;
10646         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_WMMX_args:
10647           if (in_attr[i].int_value() != out_attr[i].int_value()
10648               && parameters->options().warn_mismatch())
10649             {
10650               gold_error(_("%s uses iWMMXt register arguments, output does "
10651                            "not"),
10652                          name);
10653             }
10654           break;
10655         case Object_attribute::Tag_compatibility:
10656           // Merged in target-independent code.
10657           break;
10658         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_HardFP_use:
10659           // 1 (SP) and 2 (DP) conflict, so combine to 3 (SP & DP).
10660           if ((in_attr[i].int_value() == 1 && out_attr[i].int_value() == 2)
10661               || (in_attr[i].int_value() == 2 && out_attr[i].int_value() == 1))
10662             out_attr[i].set_int_value(3);
10663           else if (in_attr[i].int_value() > out_attr[i].int_value())
10664             out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10665           break;
10666         case elfcpp::Tag_ABI_FP_16bit_format:
10667           if (in_attr[i].int_value() != 0 && out_attr[i].int_value() != 0)
10668             {
10669               if (in_attr[i].int_value() != out_attr[i].int_value()
10670                   && parameters->options().warn_mismatch())
10671                 gold_error(_("fp16 format mismatch between %s and output"),
10672                            name);
10673             }
10674           if (in_attr[i].int_value() != 0)
10675             out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value());
10676           break;
10677
10678         case elfcpp::Tag_DIV_use:
10679           // This tag is set to zero if we can use UDIV and SDIV in Thumb
10680           // mode on a v7-M or v7-R CPU; to one if we can not use UDIV or
10681           // SDIV at all; and to two if we can use UDIV or SDIV on a v7-A
10682           // CPU.  We will merge as follows: If the input attribute's value
10683           // is one then the output attribute's value remains unchanged.  If
10684           // the input attribute's value is zero or two then if the output
10685           // attribute's value is one the output value is set to the input
10686           // value, otherwise the output value must be the same as the
10687           // inputs.  */ 
10688           if (in_attr[i].int_value() != 1 && out_attr[i].int_value() != 1) 
10689             { 
10690               if (in_attr[i].int_value() != out_attr[i].int_value())
10691                 {
10692                   gold_error(_("DIV usage mismatch between %s and output"),
10693                              name);
10694                 }
10695             } 
10696
10697           if (in_attr[i].int_value() != 1)
10698             out_attr[i].set_int_value(in_attr[i].int_value()); 
10699           
10700           break;
10701
10702         case elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use_legacy:
10703           // We don't output objects with Tag_MPextension_use_legacy - we
10704           // move the value to Tag_MPextension_use.
10705           if (in_attr[i].int_value() != 0
10706               && in_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use].int_value() != 0)
10707             {
10708               if (in_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use].int_value()
10709                   != in_attr[i].int_value())
10710                 {
10711                   gold_error(_("%s has has both the current and legacy "
10712                                "Tag_MPextension_use attributes"), 
10713                              name);
10714                 }
10715             }
10716
10717           if (in_attr[i].int_value()
10718               > out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use].int_value())
10719             out_attr[elfcpp::Tag_MPextension_use] = in_attr[i];
10720
10721           break;
10722
10723         case elfcpp::Tag_nodefaults:
10724           // This tag is set if it exists, but the value is unused (and is
10725           // typically zero).  We don't actually need to do anything here -
10726           // the merge happens automatically when the type flags are merged
10727           // below.
10728           break;
10729         case elfcpp::Tag_also_compatible_with:
10730           // Already done in Tag_CPU_arch.
10731           break;
10732         case elfcpp::Tag_conformance:
10733           // Keep the attribute if it matches.  Throw it away otherwise.
10734           // No attribute means no claim to conform.
10735           if (in_attr[i].string_value() != out_attr[i].string_value())
10736             out_attr[i].set_string_value("");
10737           break;
10738
10739         default:
10740           {
10741             const char* err_object = NULL;
10742
10743             // The "known_obj_attributes" table does contain some undefined
10744             // attributes.  Ensure that there are unused.
10745             if (out_attr[i].int_value() != 0
10746                 || out_attr[i].string_value() != "")
10747               err_object = "output";
10748             else if (in_attr[i].int_value() != 0
10749                      || in_attr[i].string_value() != "")
10750               err_object = name;
10751
10752             if (err_object != NULL
10753                 && parameters->options().warn_mismatch())
10754               {
10755                 // Attribute numbers >=64 (mod 128) can be safely ignored.
10756                 if ((i & 127) < 64)
10757                   gold_error(_("%s: unknown mandatory EABI object attribute "
10758                                "%d"),
10759                              err_object, i);
10760                 else
10761                   gold_warning(_("%s: unknown EABI object attribute %d"),
10762                                err_object, i);
10763               }
10764
10765             // Only pass on attributes that match in both inputs.
10766             if (!in_attr[i].matches(out_attr[i]))
10767               {
10768                 out_attr[i].set_int_value(0);
10769                 out_attr[i].set_string_value("");
10770               }
10771           }
10772         }
10773
10774       // If out_attr was copied from in_attr then it won't have a type yet.
10775       if (in_attr[i].type() && !out_attr[i].type())
10776         out_attr[i].set_type(in_attr[i].type());
10777     }
10778
10779   // Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones.
10780   this->attributes_section_data_->merge(name, pasd);
10781
10782   // Check for any attributes not known on ARM.
10783   typedef Vendor_object_attributes::Other_attributes Other_attributes;
10784   const Other_attributes* in_other_attributes = pasd->other_attributes(vendor);
10785   Other_attributes::const_iterator in_iter = in_other_attributes->begin();
10786   Other_attributes* out_other_attributes =
10787     this->attributes_section_data_->other_attributes(vendor);
10788   Other_attributes::iterator out_iter = out_other_attributes->begin();
10789
10790   while (in_iter != in_other_attributes->end()
10791          || out_iter != out_other_attributes->end())
10792     {
10793       const char* err_object = NULL;
10794       int err_tag = 0;
10795
10796       // The tags for each list are in numerical order.
10797       // If the tags are equal, then merge.
10798       if (out_iter != out_other_attributes->end()
10799           && (in_iter == in_other_attributes->end()
10800               || in_iter->first > out_iter->first))
10801         {
10802           // This attribute only exists in output.  We can't merge, and we
10803           // don't know what the tag means, so delete it.
10804           err_object = "output";
10805           err_tag = out_iter->first;
10806           int saved_tag = out_iter->first;
10807           delete out_iter->second;
10808           out_other_attributes->erase(out_iter); 
10809           out_iter = out_other_attributes->upper_bound(saved_tag);
10810         }
10811       else if (in_iter != in_other_attributes->end()
10812                && (out_iter != out_other_attributes->end()
10813                    || in_iter->first < out_iter->first))
10814         {
10815           // This attribute only exists in input. We can't merge, and we
10816           // don't know what the tag means, so ignore it.
10817           err_object = name;
10818           err_tag = in_iter->first;
10819           ++in_iter;
10820         }
10821       else // The tags are equal.
10822         {
10823           // As present, all attributes in the list are unknown, and
10824           // therefore can't be merged meaningfully.
10825           err_object = "output";
10826           err_tag = out_iter->first;
10827
10828           //  Only pass on attributes that match in both inputs.
10829           if (!in_iter->second->matches(*(out_iter->second)))
10830             {
10831               // No match.  Delete the attribute.
10832               int saved_tag = out_iter->first;
10833               delete out_iter->second;
10834               out_other_attributes->erase(out_iter);
10835               out_iter = out_other_attributes->upper_bound(saved_tag);
10836             }
10837           else
10838             {
10839               // Matched.  Keep the attribute and move to the next.
10840               ++out_iter;
10841               ++in_iter;
10842             }
10843         }
10844
10845       if (err_object && parameters->options().warn_mismatch())
10846         {
10847           // Attribute numbers >=64 (mod 128) can be safely ignored.  */
10848           if ((err_tag & 127) < 64)
10849             {
10850               gold_error(_("%s: unknown mandatory EABI object attribute %d"),
10851                          err_object, err_tag);
10852             }
10853           else
10854             {
10855               gold_warning(_("%s: unknown EABI object attribute %d"),
10856                            err_object, err_tag);
10857             }
10858         }
10859     }
10860 }
10861
10862 // Stub-generation methods for Target_arm.
10863
10864 // Make a new Arm_input_section object.
10865
10866 template<bool big_endian>
10867 Arm_input_section<big_endian>*
10868 Target_arm<big_endian>::new_arm_input_section(
10869     Relobj* relobj,
10870     unsigned int shndx)
10871 {
10872   Section_id sid(relobj, shndx);
10873
10874   Arm_input_section<big_endian>* arm_input_section =
10875     new Arm_input_section<big_endian>(relobj, shndx);
10876   arm_input_section->init();
10877
10878   // Register new Arm_input_section in map for look-up.
10879   std::pair<typename Arm_input_section_map::iterator, bool> ins =
10880     this->arm_input_section_map_.insert(std::make_pair(sid, arm_input_section));
10881
10882   // Make sure that it we have not created another Arm_input_section
10883   // for this input section already.
10884   gold_assert(ins.second);
10885
10886   return arm_input_section; 
10887 }
10888
10889 // Find the Arm_input_section object corresponding to the SHNDX-th input
10890 // section of RELOBJ.
10891
10892 template<bool big_endian>
10893 Arm_input_section<big_endian>*
10894 Target_arm<big_endian>::find_arm_input_section(
10895     Relobj* relobj,
10896     unsigned int shndx) const
10897 {
10898   Section_id sid(relobj, shndx);
10899   typename Arm_input_section_map::const_iterator p =
10900     this->arm_input_section_map_.find(sid);
10901   return (p != this->arm_input_section_map_.end()) ? p->second : NULL;
10902 }
10903
10904 // Make a new stub table.
10905
10906 template<bool big_endian>
10907 Stub_table<big_endian>*
10908 Target_arm<big_endian>::new_stub_table(Arm_input_section<big_endian>* owner)
10909 {
10910   Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table =
10911     new Stub_table<big_endian>(owner);
10912   this->stub_tables_.push_back(stub_table);
10913
10914   stub_table->set_address(owner->address() + owner->data_size());
10915   stub_table->set_file_offset(owner->offset() + owner->data_size());
10916   stub_table->finalize_data_size();
10917
10918   return stub_table;
10919 }
10920
10921 // Scan a relocation for stub generation.
10922
10923 template<bool big_endian>
10924 void
10925 Target_arm<big_endian>::scan_reloc_for_stub(
10926     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
10927     unsigned int r_type,
10928     const Sized_symbol<32>* gsym,
10929     unsigned int r_sym,
10930     const Symbol_value<32>* psymval,
10931     elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword addend,
10932     Arm_address address)
10933 {
10934   typedef typename Target_arm<big_endian>::Relocate Relocate;
10935
10936   const Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
10937     Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(relinfo->object);
10938
10939   bool target_is_thumb;
10940   Symbol_value<32> symval;
10941   if (gsym != NULL)
10942     {
10943       // This is a global symbol.  Determine if we use PLT and if the
10944       // final target is THUMB.
10945       if (gsym->use_plt_offset(Scan::get_reference_flags(r_type)))
10946         {
10947           // This uses a PLT, change the symbol value.
10948           symval.set_output_value(this->plt_section()->address()
10949                                   + gsym->plt_offset());
10950           psymval = &symval;
10951           target_is_thumb = false;
10952         }
10953       else if (gsym->is_undefined())
10954         // There is no need to generate a stub symbol is undefined.
10955         return;
10956       else
10957         {
10958           target_is_thumb =
10959             ((gsym->type() == elfcpp::STT_ARM_TFUNC)
10960              || (gsym->type() == elfcpp::STT_FUNC
10961                  && !gsym->is_undefined()
10962                  && ((psymval->value(arm_relobj, 0) & 1) != 0)));
10963         }
10964     }
10965   else
10966     {
10967       // This is a local symbol.  Determine if the final target is THUMB.
10968       target_is_thumb = arm_relobj->local_symbol_is_thumb_function(r_sym);
10969     }
10970
10971   // Strip LSB if this points to a THUMB target.
10972   const Arm_reloc_property* reloc_property =
10973     arm_reloc_property_table->get_implemented_static_reloc_property(r_type);
10974   gold_assert(reloc_property != NULL);
10975   if (target_is_thumb
10976       && reloc_property->uses_thumb_bit()
10977       && ((psymval->value(arm_relobj, 0) & 1) != 0))
10978     {
10979       Arm_address stripped_value =
10980         psymval->value(arm_relobj, 0) & ~static_cast<Arm_address>(1);
10981       symval.set_output_value(stripped_value);
10982       psymval = &symval;
10983     } 
10984
10985   // Get the symbol value.
10986   Symbol_value<32>::Value value = psymval->value(arm_relobj, 0);
10987
10988   // Owing to pipelining, the PC relative branches below actually skip
10989   // two instructions when the branch offset is 0.
10990   Arm_address destination;
10991   switch (r_type)
10992     {
10993     case elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL:
10994     case elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24:
10995     case elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32:
10996       // ARM branches.
10997       destination = value + addend + 8;
10998       break;
10999     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL:
11000     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_XPC22:
11001     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24:
11002     case elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19:
11003       // THUMB branches.
11004       destination = value + addend + 4;
11005       break;
11006     default:
11007       gold_unreachable();
11008     }
11009
11010   Reloc_stub* stub = NULL;
11011   Stub_type stub_type =
11012     Reloc_stub::stub_type_for_reloc(r_type, address, destination,
11013                                     target_is_thumb);
11014   if (stub_type != arm_stub_none)
11015     {
11016       // Try looking up an existing stub from a stub table.
11017       Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table = 
11018         arm_relobj->stub_table(relinfo->data_shndx);
11019       gold_assert(stub_table != NULL);
11020    
11021       // Locate stub by destination.
11022       Reloc_stub::Key stub_key(stub_type, gsym, arm_relobj, r_sym, addend);
11023
11024       // Create a stub if there is not one already
11025       stub = stub_table->find_reloc_stub(stub_key);
11026       if (stub == NULL)
11027         {
11028           // create a new stub and add it to stub table.
11029           stub = this->stub_factory().make_reloc_stub(stub_type);
11030           stub_table->add_reloc_stub(stub, stub_key);
11031         }
11032
11033       // Record the destination address.
11034       stub->set_destination_address(destination
11035                                     | (target_is_thumb ? 1 : 0));
11036     }
11037
11038   // For Cortex-A8, we need to record a relocation at 4K page boundary.
11039   if (this->fix_cortex_a8_
11040       && (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24
11041           || r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19
11042           || r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL
11043           || r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_XPC22)
11044       && (address & 0xfffU) == 0xffeU)
11045     {
11046       // Found a candidate.  Note we haven't checked the destination is
11047       // within 4K here: if we do so (and don't create a record) we can't
11048       // tell that a branch should have been relocated when scanning later.
11049       this->cortex_a8_relocs_info_[address] =
11050         new Cortex_a8_reloc(stub, r_type,
11051                             destination | (target_is_thumb ? 1 : 0));
11052     }
11053 }
11054
11055 // This function scans a relocation sections for stub generation.
11056 // The template parameter Relocate must be a class type which provides
11057 // a single function, relocate(), which implements the machine
11058 // specific part of a relocation.
11059
11060 // BIG_ENDIAN is the endianness of the data.  SH_TYPE is the section type:
11061 // SHT_REL or SHT_RELA.
11062
11063 // PRELOCS points to the relocation data.  RELOC_COUNT is the number
11064 // of relocs.  OUTPUT_SECTION is the output section.
11065 // NEEDS_SPECIAL_OFFSET_HANDLING is true if input offsets need to be
11066 // mapped to output offsets.
11067
11068 // VIEW is the section data, VIEW_ADDRESS is its memory address, and
11069 // VIEW_SIZE is the size.  These refer to the input section, unless
11070 // NEEDS_SPECIAL_OFFSET_HANDLING is true, in which case they refer to
11071 // the output section.
11072
11073 template<bool big_endian>
11074 template<int sh_type>
11075 void inline
11076 Target_arm<big_endian>::scan_reloc_section_for_stubs(
11077     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
11078     const unsigned char* prelocs,
11079     size_t reloc_count,
11080     Output_section* output_section,
11081     bool needs_special_offset_handling,
11082     const unsigned char* view,
11083     elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Addr view_address,
11084     section_size_type)
11085 {
11086   typedef typename Reloc_types<sh_type, 32, big_endian>::Reloc Reltype;
11087   const int reloc_size =
11088     Reloc_types<sh_type, 32, big_endian>::reloc_size;
11089
11090   Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_object =
11091     Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(relinfo->object);
11092   unsigned int local_count = arm_object->local_symbol_count();
11093
11094   Comdat_behavior comdat_behavior = CB_UNDETERMINED;
11095
11096   for (size_t i = 0; i < reloc_count; ++i, prelocs += reloc_size)
11097     {
11098       Reltype reloc(prelocs);
11099
11100       typename elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_WXword r_info = reloc.get_r_info();
11101       unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(r_info);
11102       unsigned int r_type = elfcpp::elf_r_type<32>(r_info);
11103
11104       r_type = this->get_real_reloc_type(r_type);
11105
11106       // Only a few relocation types need stubs.
11107       if ((r_type != elfcpp::R_ARM_CALL)
11108          && (r_type != elfcpp::R_ARM_JUMP24)
11109          && (r_type != elfcpp::R_ARM_PLT32)
11110          && (r_type != elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL)
11111          && (r_type != elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_XPC22)
11112          && (r_type != elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP24)
11113          && (r_type != elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_JUMP19)
11114          && (r_type != elfcpp::R_ARM_V4BX))
11115         continue;
11116
11117       section_offset_type offset =
11118         convert_to_section_size_type(reloc.get_r_offset());
11119
11120       if (needs_special_offset_handling)
11121         {
11122           offset = output_section->output_offset(relinfo->object,
11123                                                  relinfo->data_shndx,
11124                                                  offset);
11125           if (offset == -1)
11126             continue;
11127         }
11128
11129       // Create a v4bx stub if --fix-v4bx-interworking is used.
11130       if (r_type == elfcpp::R_ARM_V4BX)
11131         {
11132           if (this->fix_v4bx() == General_options::FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING)
11133             {
11134               // Get the BX instruction.
11135               typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
11136               const Valtype* wv =
11137                 reinterpret_cast<const Valtype*>(view + offset);
11138               elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword insn =
11139                 elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
11140               const uint32_t reg = (insn & 0xf);
11141
11142               if (reg < 0xf)
11143                 {
11144                   // Try looking up an existing stub from a stub table.
11145                   Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table =
11146                     arm_object->stub_table(relinfo->data_shndx);
11147                   gold_assert(stub_table != NULL);
11148
11149                   if (stub_table->find_arm_v4bx_stub(reg) == NULL)
11150                     {
11151                       // create a new stub and add it to stub table.
11152                       Arm_v4bx_stub* stub =
11153                         this->stub_factory().make_arm_v4bx_stub(reg);
11154                       gold_assert(stub != NULL);
11155                       stub_table->add_arm_v4bx_stub(stub);
11156                     }
11157                 }
11158             }
11159           continue;
11160         }
11161
11162       // Get the addend.
11163       Stub_addend_reader<sh_type, big_endian> stub_addend_reader;
11164       elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword addend =
11165         stub_addend_reader(r_type, view + offset, reloc);
11166
11167       const Sized_symbol<32>* sym;
11168
11169       Symbol_value<32> symval;
11170       const Symbol_value<32> *psymval;
11171       bool is_defined_in_discarded_section;
11172       unsigned int shndx;
11173       if (r_sym < local_count)
11174         {
11175           sym = NULL;
11176           psymval = arm_object->local_symbol(r_sym);
11177
11178           // If the local symbol belongs to a section we are discarding,
11179           // and that section is a debug section, try to find the
11180           // corresponding kept section and map this symbol to its
11181           // counterpart in the kept section.  The symbol must not 
11182           // correspond to a section we are folding.
11183           bool is_ordinary;
11184           shndx = psymval->input_shndx(&is_ordinary);
11185           is_defined_in_discarded_section =
11186             (is_ordinary
11187              && shndx != elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF
11188              && !arm_object->is_section_included(shndx)
11189              && !relinfo->symtab->is_section_folded(arm_object, shndx));
11190
11191           // We need to compute the would-be final value of this local
11192           // symbol.
11193           if (!is_defined_in_discarded_section)
11194             {
11195               typedef Sized_relobj_file<32, big_endian> ObjType;
11196               typename ObjType::Compute_final_local_value_status status =
11197                 arm_object->compute_final_local_value(r_sym, psymval, &symval,
11198                                                       relinfo->symtab); 
11199               if (status == ObjType::CFLV_OK)
11200                 {
11201                   // Currently we cannot handle a branch to a target in
11202                   // a merged section.  If this is the case, issue an error
11203                   // and also free the merge symbol value.
11204                   if (!symval.has_output_value())
11205                     {
11206                       const std::string& section_name =
11207                         arm_object->section_name(shndx);
11208                       arm_object->error(_("cannot handle branch to local %u "
11209                                           "in a merged section %s"),
11210                                         r_sym, section_name.c_str());
11211                     }
11212                   psymval = &symval;
11213                 }
11214               else
11215                 {
11216                   // We cannot determine the final value.
11217                   continue;  
11218                 }
11219             }
11220         }
11221       else
11222         {
11223           const Symbol* gsym;
11224           gsym = arm_object->global_symbol(r_sym);
11225           gold_assert(gsym != NULL);
11226           if (gsym->is_forwarder())
11227             gsym = relinfo->symtab->resolve_forwards(gsym);
11228
11229           sym = static_cast<const Sized_symbol<32>*>(gsym);
11230           if (sym->has_symtab_index() && sym->symtab_index() != -1U)
11231             symval.set_output_symtab_index(sym->symtab_index());
11232           else
11233             symval.set_no_output_symtab_entry();
11234
11235           // We need to compute the would-be final value of this global
11236           // symbol.
11237           const Symbol_table* symtab = relinfo->symtab;
11238           const Sized_symbol<32>* sized_symbol =
11239             symtab->get_sized_symbol<32>(gsym);
11240           Symbol_table::Compute_final_value_status status;
11241           Arm_address value =
11242             symtab->compute_final_value<32>(sized_symbol, &status);
11243
11244           // Skip this if the symbol has not output section.
11245           if (status == Symbol_table::CFVS_NO_OUTPUT_SECTION)
11246             continue;
11247           symval.set_output_value(value);
11248
11249           if (gsym->type() == elfcpp::STT_TLS)
11250             symval.set_is_tls_symbol();
11251           else if (gsym->type() == elfcpp::STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11252             symval.set_is_ifunc_symbol();
11253           psymval = &symval;
11254
11255           is_defined_in_discarded_section =
11256             (gsym->is_defined_in_discarded_section()
11257              && gsym->is_undefined());
11258           shndx = 0;
11259         }
11260
11261       Symbol_value<32> symval2;
11262       if (is_defined_in_discarded_section)
11263         {
11264           if (comdat_behavior == CB_UNDETERMINED)
11265             {
11266               std::string name = arm_object->section_name(relinfo->data_shndx);
11267               comdat_behavior = get_comdat_behavior(name.c_str());
11268             }
11269           if (comdat_behavior == CB_PRETEND)
11270             {
11271               // FIXME: This case does not work for global symbols.
11272               // We have no place to store the original section index.
11273               // Fortunately this does not matter for comdat sections,
11274               // only for sections explicitly discarded by a linker
11275               // script.
11276               bool found;
11277               typename elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Addr value =
11278                 arm_object->map_to_kept_section(shndx, &found);
11279               if (found)
11280                 symval2.set_output_value(value + psymval->input_value());
11281               else
11282                 symval2.set_output_value(0);
11283             }
11284           else
11285             {
11286               if (comdat_behavior == CB_WARNING)
11287                 gold_warning_at_location(relinfo, i, offset,
11288                                          _("relocation refers to discarded "
11289                                            "section"));
11290               symval2.set_output_value(0);
11291             }
11292           symval2.set_no_output_symtab_entry();
11293           psymval = &symval2;
11294         }
11295
11296       // If symbol is a section symbol, we don't know the actual type of
11297       // destination.  Give up.
11298       if (psymval->is_section_symbol())
11299         continue;
11300
11301       this->scan_reloc_for_stub(relinfo, r_type, sym, r_sym, psymval,
11302                                 addend, view_address + offset);
11303     }
11304 }
11305
11306 // Scan an input section for stub generation.
11307
11308 template<bool big_endian>
11309 void
11310 Target_arm<big_endian>::scan_section_for_stubs(
11311     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
11312     unsigned int sh_type,
11313     const unsigned char* prelocs,
11314     size_t reloc_count,
11315     Output_section* output_section,
11316     bool needs_special_offset_handling,
11317     const unsigned char* view,
11318     Arm_address view_address,
11319     section_size_type view_size)
11320 {
11321   if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
11322     this->scan_reloc_section_for_stubs<elfcpp::SHT_REL>(
11323         relinfo,
11324         prelocs,
11325         reloc_count,
11326         output_section,
11327         needs_special_offset_handling,
11328         view,
11329         view_address,
11330         view_size);
11331   else if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
11332     // We do not support RELA type relocations yet.  This is provided for
11333     // completeness.
11334     this->scan_reloc_section_for_stubs<elfcpp::SHT_RELA>(
11335         relinfo,
11336         prelocs,
11337         reloc_count,
11338         output_section,
11339         needs_special_offset_handling,
11340         view,
11341         view_address,
11342         view_size);
11343   else
11344     gold_unreachable();
11345 }
11346
11347 // Group input sections for stub generation.
11348 //
11349 // We group input sections in an output section so that the total size,
11350 // including any padding space due to alignment is smaller than GROUP_SIZE
11351 // unless the only input section in group is bigger than GROUP_SIZE already.
11352 // Then an ARM stub table is created to follow the last input section
11353 // in group.  For each group an ARM stub table is created an is placed
11354 // after the last group.  If STUB_ALWAYS_AFTER_BRANCH is false, we further
11355 // extend the group after the stub table.
11356
11357 template<bool big_endian>
11358 void
11359 Target_arm<big_endian>::group_sections(
11360     Layout* layout,
11361     section_size_type group_size,
11362     bool stubs_always_after_branch,
11363     const Task* task)
11364 {
11365   // Group input sections and insert stub table
11366   Layout::Section_list section_list;
11367   layout->get_allocated_sections(&section_list);
11368   for (Layout::Section_list::const_iterator p = section_list.begin();
11369        p != section_list.end();
11370        ++p)
11371     {
11372       Arm_output_section<big_endian>* output_section =
11373         Arm_output_section<big_endian>::as_arm_output_section(*p);
11374       output_section->group_sections(group_size, stubs_always_after_branch,
11375                                      this, task);
11376     }
11377 }
11378
11379 // Relaxation hook.  This is where we do stub generation.
11380
11381 template<bool big_endian>
11382 bool
11383 Target_arm<big_endian>::do_relax(
11384     int pass,
11385     const Input_objects* input_objects,
11386     Symbol_table* symtab,
11387     Layout* layout,
11388     const Task* task)
11389 {
11390   // No need to generate stubs if this is a relocatable link.
11391   gold_assert(!parameters->options().relocatable());
11392
11393   // If this is the first pass, we need to group input sections into
11394   // stub groups.
11395   bool done_exidx_fixup = false;
11396   typedef typename Stub_table_list::iterator Stub_table_iterator;
11397   if (pass == 1)
11398     {
11399       // Determine the stub group size.  The group size is the absolute
11400       // value of the parameter --stub-group-size.  If --stub-group-size
11401       // is passed a negative value, we restrict stubs to be always after
11402       // the stubbed branches.
11403       int32_t stub_group_size_param =
11404         parameters->options().stub_group_size();
11405       bool stubs_always_after_branch = stub_group_size_param < 0;
11406       section_size_type stub_group_size = abs(stub_group_size_param);
11407
11408       if (stub_group_size == 1)
11409         {
11410           // Default value.
11411           // Thumb branch range is +-4MB has to be used as the default
11412           // maximum size (a given section can contain both ARM and Thumb
11413           // code, so the worst case has to be taken into account).  If we are
11414           // fixing cortex-a8 errata, the branch range has to be even smaller,
11415           // since wide conditional branch has a range of +-1MB only.
11416           //
11417           // This value is 48K less than that, which allows for 4096
11418           // 12-byte stubs.  If we exceed that, then we will fail to link.
11419           // The user will have to relink with an explicit group size
11420           // option.
11421             stub_group_size = 4145152;
11422         }
11423
11424       // The Cortex-A8 erratum fix depends on stubs not being in the same 4K
11425       // page as the first half of a 32-bit branch straddling two 4K pages.
11426       // This is a crude way of enforcing that.  In addition, long conditional
11427       // branches of THUMB-2 have a range of +-1M.  If we are fixing cortex-A8
11428       // erratum, limit the group size to  (1M - 12k) to avoid unreachable
11429       // cortex-A8 stubs from long conditional branches.
11430       if (this->fix_cortex_a8_)
11431         {
11432           stubs_always_after_branch = true;
11433           const section_size_type cortex_a8_group_size = 1024 * (1024 - 12);
11434           stub_group_size = std::max(stub_group_size, cortex_a8_group_size);
11435         }
11436
11437       group_sections(layout, stub_group_size, stubs_always_after_branch, task);
11438      
11439       // Also fix .ARM.exidx section coverage.
11440       Arm_output_section<big_endian>* exidx_output_section = NULL;
11441       for (Layout::Section_list::const_iterator p =
11442              layout->section_list().begin();
11443            p != layout->section_list().end();
11444            ++p)
11445         if ((*p)->type() == elfcpp::SHT_ARM_EXIDX)
11446           {
11447             if (exidx_output_section == NULL)
11448               exidx_output_section =
11449                 Arm_output_section<big_endian>::as_arm_output_section(*p);
11450             else
11451               // We cannot handle this now.
11452               gold_error(_("multiple SHT_ARM_EXIDX sections %s and %s in a "
11453                            "non-relocatable link"),
11454                           exidx_output_section->name(),
11455                           (*p)->name());
11456           }
11457
11458       if (exidx_output_section != NULL)
11459         {
11460           this->fix_exidx_coverage(layout, input_objects, exidx_output_section,
11461                                    symtab, task);
11462           done_exidx_fixup = true;
11463         }
11464     }
11465   else
11466     {
11467       // If this is not the first pass, addresses and file offsets have
11468       // been reset at this point, set them here.
11469       for (Stub_table_iterator sp = this->stub_tables_.begin();
11470            sp != this->stub_tables_.end();
11471            ++sp)
11472         {
11473           Arm_input_section<big_endian>* owner = (*sp)->owner();
11474           off_t off = align_address(owner->original_size(),
11475                                     (*sp)->addralign());
11476           (*sp)->set_address_and_file_offset(owner->address() + off,
11477                                              owner->offset() + off);
11478         }
11479     }
11480
11481   // The Cortex-A8 stubs are sensitive to layout of code sections.  At the
11482   // beginning of each relaxation pass, just blow away all the stubs.
11483   // Alternatively, we could selectively remove only the stubs and reloc
11484   // information for code sections that have moved since the last pass.
11485   // That would require more book-keeping.
11486   if (this->fix_cortex_a8_)
11487     {
11488       // Clear all Cortex-A8 reloc information.
11489       for (typename Cortex_a8_relocs_info::const_iterator p =
11490              this->cortex_a8_relocs_info_.begin();
11491            p != this->cortex_a8_relocs_info_.end();
11492            ++p)
11493         delete p->second;
11494       this->cortex_a8_relocs_info_.clear();
11495
11496       // Remove all Cortex-A8 stubs.
11497       for (Stub_table_iterator sp = this->stub_tables_.begin();
11498            sp != this->stub_tables_.end();
11499            ++sp)
11500         (*sp)->remove_all_cortex_a8_stubs();
11501     }
11502   
11503   // Scan relocs for relocation stubs
11504   for (Input_objects::Relobj_iterator op = input_objects->relobj_begin();
11505        op != input_objects->relobj_end();
11506        ++op)
11507     {
11508       Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
11509         Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(*op);
11510       // Lock the object so we can read from it.  This is only called
11511       // single-threaded from Layout::finalize, so it is OK to lock.
11512       Task_lock_obj<Object> tl(task, arm_relobj);
11513       arm_relobj->scan_sections_for_stubs(this, symtab, layout);
11514     }
11515
11516   // Check all stub tables to see if any of them have their data sizes
11517   // or addresses alignments changed.  These are the only things that
11518   // matter.
11519   bool any_stub_table_changed = false;
11520   Unordered_set<const Output_section*> sections_needing_adjustment;
11521   for (Stub_table_iterator sp = this->stub_tables_.begin();
11522        (sp != this->stub_tables_.end()) && !any_stub_table_changed;
11523        ++sp)
11524     {
11525       if ((*sp)->update_data_size_and_addralign())
11526         {
11527           // Update data size of stub table owner.
11528           Arm_input_section<big_endian>* owner = (*sp)->owner();
11529           uint64_t address = owner->address();
11530           off_t offset = owner->offset();
11531           owner->reset_address_and_file_offset();
11532           owner->set_address_and_file_offset(address, offset);
11533
11534           sections_needing_adjustment.insert(owner->output_section());
11535           any_stub_table_changed = true;
11536         }
11537     }
11538
11539   // Output_section_data::output_section() returns a const pointer but we
11540   // need to update output sections, so we record all output sections needing
11541   // update above and scan the sections here to find out what sections need
11542   // to be updated.
11543   for (Layout::Section_list::const_iterator p = layout->section_list().begin();
11544       p != layout->section_list().end();
11545       ++p)
11546     {
11547       if (sections_needing_adjustment.find(*p)
11548           != sections_needing_adjustment.end())
11549         (*p)->set_section_offsets_need_adjustment();
11550     }
11551
11552   // Stop relaxation if no EXIDX fix-up and no stub table change.
11553   bool continue_relaxation = done_exidx_fixup || any_stub_table_changed;
11554
11555   // Finalize the stubs in the last relaxation pass.
11556   if (!continue_relaxation)
11557     {
11558       for (Stub_table_iterator sp = this->stub_tables_.begin();
11559            (sp != this->stub_tables_.end()) && !any_stub_table_changed;
11560             ++sp)
11561         (*sp)->finalize_stubs();
11562
11563       // Update output local symbol counts of objects if necessary.
11564       for (Input_objects::Relobj_iterator op = input_objects->relobj_begin();
11565            op != input_objects->relobj_end();
11566            ++op)
11567         {
11568           Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
11569             Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(*op);
11570
11571           // Update output local symbol counts.  We need to discard local
11572           // symbols defined in parts of input sections that are discarded by
11573           // relaxation.
11574           if (arm_relobj->output_local_symbol_count_needs_update())
11575             {
11576               // We need to lock the object's file to update it.
11577               Task_lock_obj<Object> tl(task, arm_relobj);
11578               arm_relobj->update_output_local_symbol_count();
11579             }
11580         }
11581     }
11582
11583   return continue_relaxation;
11584 }
11585
11586 // Relocate a stub.
11587
11588 template<bool big_endian>
11589 void
11590 Target_arm<big_endian>::relocate_stub(
11591     Stub* stub,
11592     const Relocate_info<32, big_endian>* relinfo,
11593     Output_section* output_section,
11594     unsigned char* view,
11595     Arm_address address,
11596     section_size_type view_size)
11597 {
11598   Relocate relocate;
11599   const Stub_template* stub_template = stub->stub_template();
11600   for (size_t i = 0; i < stub_template->reloc_count(); i++)
11601     {
11602       size_t reloc_insn_index = stub_template->reloc_insn_index(i);
11603       const Insn_template* insn = &stub_template->insns()[reloc_insn_index];
11604
11605       unsigned int r_type = insn->r_type();
11606       section_size_type reloc_offset = stub_template->reloc_offset(i);
11607       section_size_type reloc_size = insn->size();
11608       gold_assert(reloc_offset + reloc_size <= view_size);
11609
11610       // This is the address of the stub destination.
11611       Arm_address target = stub->reloc_target(i) + insn->reloc_addend();
11612       Symbol_value<32> symval;
11613       symval.set_output_value(target);
11614
11615       // Synthesize a fake reloc just in case.  We don't have a symbol so
11616       // we use 0.
11617       unsigned char reloc_buffer[elfcpp::Elf_sizes<32>::rel_size];
11618       memset(reloc_buffer, 0, sizeof(reloc_buffer));
11619       elfcpp::Rel_write<32, big_endian> reloc_write(reloc_buffer);
11620       reloc_write.put_r_offset(reloc_offset);
11621       reloc_write.put_r_info(elfcpp::elf_r_info<32>(0, r_type));
11622       elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian> rel(reloc_buffer);
11623
11624       relocate.relocate(relinfo, this, output_section,
11625                         this->fake_relnum_for_stubs, rel, r_type,
11626                         NULL, &symval, view + reloc_offset,
11627                         address + reloc_offset, reloc_size);
11628     }
11629 }
11630
11631 // Determine whether an object attribute tag takes an integer, a
11632 // string or both.
11633
11634 template<bool big_endian>
11635 int
11636 Target_arm<big_endian>::do_attribute_arg_type(int tag) const
11637 {
11638   if (tag == Object_attribute::Tag_compatibility)
11639     return (Object_attribute::ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL
11640             | Object_attribute::ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_STR_VAL);
11641   else if (tag == elfcpp::Tag_nodefaults)
11642     return (Object_attribute::ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL
11643             | Object_attribute::ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_NO_DEFAULT);
11644   else if (tag == elfcpp::Tag_CPU_raw_name || tag == elfcpp::Tag_CPU_name)
11645     return Object_attribute::ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_STR_VAL;
11646   else if (tag < 32)
11647     return Object_attribute::ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
11648   else
11649     return ((tag & 1) != 0
11650             ? Object_attribute::ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_STR_VAL
11651             : Object_attribute::ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL);
11652 }
11653
11654 // Reorder attributes.
11655 //
11656 // The ABI defines that Tag_conformance should be emitted first, and that
11657 // Tag_nodefaults should be second (if either is defined).  This sets those
11658 // two positions, and bumps up the position of all the remaining tags to
11659 // compensate.
11660
11661 template<bool big_endian>
11662 int
11663 Target_arm<big_endian>::do_attributes_order(int num) const
11664 {
11665   // Reorder the known object attributes in output.  We want to move
11666   // Tag_conformance to position 4 and Tag_conformance to position 5
11667   // and shift everything between 4 .. Tag_conformance - 1 to make room.
11668   if (num == 4)
11669     return elfcpp::Tag_conformance;
11670   if (num == 5)
11671     return elfcpp::Tag_nodefaults;
11672   if ((num - 2) < elfcpp::Tag_nodefaults)
11673     return num - 2;
11674   if ((num - 1) < elfcpp::Tag_conformance)
11675     return num - 1;
11676   return num;
11677 }
11678
11679 // Scan a span of THUMB code for Cortex-A8 erratum.
11680
11681 template<bool big_endian>
11682 void
11683 Target_arm<big_endian>::scan_span_for_cortex_a8_erratum(
11684     Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj,
11685     unsigned int shndx,
11686     section_size_type span_start,
11687     section_size_type span_end,
11688     const unsigned char* view,
11689     Arm_address address)
11690 {
11691   // Scan for 32-bit Thumb-2 branches which span two 4K regions, where:
11692   //
11693   // The opcode is BLX.W, BL.W, B.W, Bcc.W
11694   // The branch target is in the same 4KB region as the
11695   // first half of the branch.
11696   // The instruction before the branch is a 32-bit
11697   // length non-branch instruction.
11698   section_size_type i = span_start;
11699   bool last_was_32bit = false;
11700   bool last_was_branch = false;
11701   while (i < span_end)
11702     {
11703       typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
11704       const Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<const Valtype*>(view + i);
11705       uint32_t insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
11706       bool is_blx = false, is_b = false;
11707       bool is_bl = false, is_bcc = false;
11708
11709       bool insn_32bit = (insn & 0xe000) == 0xe000 && (insn & 0x1800) != 0x0000;
11710       if (insn_32bit)
11711         {
11712           // Load the rest of the insn (in manual-friendly order).
11713           insn = (insn << 16) | elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv + 1);
11714
11715           // Encoding T4: B<c>.W.
11716           is_b = (insn & 0xf800d000U) == 0xf0009000U;
11717           // Encoding T1: BL<c>.W.
11718           is_bl = (insn & 0xf800d000U) == 0xf000d000U;
11719           // Encoding T2: BLX<c>.W.
11720           is_blx = (insn & 0xf800d000U) == 0xf000c000U;
11721           // Encoding T3: B<c>.W (not permitted in IT block).
11722           is_bcc = ((insn & 0xf800d000U) == 0xf0008000U
11723                     && (insn & 0x07f00000U) != 0x03800000U);
11724         }
11725
11726       bool is_32bit_branch = is_b || is_bl || is_blx || is_bcc;
11727                            
11728       // If this instruction is a 32-bit THUMB branch that crosses a 4K
11729       // page boundary and it follows 32-bit non-branch instruction,
11730       // we need to work around.
11731       if (is_32bit_branch
11732           && ((address + i) & 0xfffU) == 0xffeU
11733           && last_was_32bit
11734           && !last_was_branch)
11735         {
11736           // Check to see if there is a relocation stub for this branch.
11737           bool force_target_arm = false;
11738           bool force_target_thumb = false;
11739           const Cortex_a8_reloc* cortex_a8_reloc = NULL;
11740           Cortex_a8_relocs_info::const_iterator p =
11741             this->cortex_a8_relocs_info_.find(address + i);
11742
11743           if (p != this->cortex_a8_relocs_info_.end())
11744             {
11745               cortex_a8_reloc = p->second;
11746               bool target_is_thumb = (cortex_a8_reloc->destination() & 1) != 0;
11747
11748               if (cortex_a8_reloc->r_type() == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL
11749                   && !target_is_thumb)
11750                 force_target_arm = true;
11751               else if (cortex_a8_reloc->r_type() == elfcpp::R_ARM_THM_CALL
11752                        && target_is_thumb)
11753                 force_target_thumb = true;
11754             }
11755
11756           off_t offset;
11757           Stub_type stub_type = arm_stub_none;
11758
11759           // Check if we have an offending branch instruction.
11760           uint16_t upper_insn = (insn >> 16) & 0xffffU;
11761           uint16_t lower_insn = insn & 0xffffU;
11762           typedef struct Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian> RelocFuncs;
11763
11764           if (cortex_a8_reloc != NULL
11765               && cortex_a8_reloc->reloc_stub() != NULL)
11766             // We've already made a stub for this instruction, e.g.
11767             // it's a long branch or a Thumb->ARM stub.  Assume that
11768             // stub will suffice to work around the A8 erratum (see
11769             // setting of always_after_branch above).
11770             ;
11771           else if (is_bcc)
11772             {
11773               offset = RelocFuncs::thumb32_cond_branch_offset(upper_insn,
11774                                                               lower_insn);
11775               stub_type = arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond;
11776             }
11777           else if (is_b || is_bl || is_blx)
11778             {
11779               offset = RelocFuncs::thumb32_branch_offset(upper_insn,
11780                                                          lower_insn);
11781               if (is_blx)
11782                 offset &= ~3;
11783
11784               stub_type = (is_blx
11785                            ? arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx
11786                            : (is_bl
11787                               ? arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl
11788                               : arm_stub_a8_veneer_b));
11789             }
11790
11791           if (stub_type != arm_stub_none)
11792             {
11793               Arm_address pc_for_insn = address + i + 4;
11794
11795               // The original instruction is a BL, but the target is
11796               // an ARM instruction.  If we were not making a stub,
11797               // the BL would have been converted to a BLX.  Use the
11798               // BLX stub instead in that case.
11799               if (this->may_use_blx() && force_target_arm
11800                   && stub_type == arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl)
11801                 {
11802                   stub_type = arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx;
11803                   is_blx = true;
11804                   is_bl = false;
11805                 }
11806               // Conversely, if the original instruction was
11807               // BLX but the target is Thumb mode, use the BL stub.
11808               else if (force_target_thumb
11809                        && stub_type == arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx)
11810                 {
11811                   stub_type = arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl;
11812                   is_blx = false;
11813                   is_bl = true;
11814                 }
11815
11816               if (is_blx)
11817                 pc_for_insn &= ~3;
11818
11819               // If we found a relocation, use the proper destination,
11820               // not the offset in the (unrelocated) instruction.
11821               // Note this is always done if we switched the stub type above.
11822               if (cortex_a8_reloc != NULL)
11823                 offset = (off_t) (cortex_a8_reloc->destination() - pc_for_insn);
11824
11825               Arm_address target = (pc_for_insn + offset) | (is_blx ? 0 : 1);
11826
11827               // Add a new stub if destination address in in the same page.
11828               if (((address + i) & ~0xfffU) == (target & ~0xfffU))
11829                 {
11830                   Cortex_a8_stub* stub =
11831                     this->stub_factory_.make_cortex_a8_stub(stub_type,
11832                                                             arm_relobj, shndx,
11833                                                             address + i,
11834                                                             target, insn);
11835                   Stub_table<big_endian>* stub_table =
11836                     arm_relobj->stub_table(shndx);
11837                   gold_assert(stub_table != NULL);
11838                   stub_table->add_cortex_a8_stub(address + i, stub);
11839                 }
11840             }
11841         }
11842
11843       i += insn_32bit ? 4 : 2;
11844       last_was_32bit = insn_32bit;
11845       last_was_branch = is_32bit_branch;
11846     }
11847 }
11848
11849 // Apply the Cortex-A8 workaround.
11850
11851 template<bool big_endian>
11852 void
11853 Target_arm<big_endian>::apply_cortex_a8_workaround(
11854     const Cortex_a8_stub* stub,
11855     Arm_address stub_address,
11856     unsigned char* insn_view,
11857     Arm_address insn_address)
11858 {
11859   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
11860   Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(insn_view);
11861   Valtype upper_insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
11862   Valtype lower_insn = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv + 1);
11863   off_t branch_offset = stub_address - (insn_address + 4);
11864
11865   typedef struct Arm_relocate_functions<big_endian> RelocFuncs;
11866   switch (stub->stub_template()->type())
11867     {
11868     case arm_stub_a8_veneer_b_cond:
11869       // For a conditional branch, we re-write it to be an unconditional
11870       // branch to the stub.  We use the THUMB-2 encoding here.
11871       upper_insn = 0xf000U;
11872       lower_insn = 0xb800U;
11873       // Fall through
11874     case arm_stub_a8_veneer_b:
11875     case arm_stub_a8_veneer_bl:
11876     case arm_stub_a8_veneer_blx:
11877       if ((lower_insn & 0x5000U) == 0x4000U)
11878         // For a BLX instruction, make sure that the relocation is
11879         // rounded up to a word boundary.  This follows the semantics of
11880         // the instruction which specifies that bit 1 of the target
11881         // address will come from bit 1 of the base address.
11882         branch_offset = (branch_offset + 2) & ~3;
11883
11884       // Put BRANCH_OFFSET back into the insn.
11885       gold_assert(!utils::has_overflow<25>(branch_offset));
11886       upper_insn = RelocFuncs::thumb32_branch_upper(upper_insn, branch_offset);
11887       lower_insn = RelocFuncs::thumb32_branch_lower(lower_insn, branch_offset);
11888       break;
11889
11890     default:
11891       gold_unreachable();
11892     }
11893
11894   // Put the relocated value back in the object file:
11895   elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, upper_insn);
11896   elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv + 1, lower_insn);
11897 }
11898
11899 template<bool big_endian>
11900 class Target_selector_arm : public Target_selector
11901 {
11902  public:
11903   Target_selector_arm()
11904     : Target_selector(elfcpp::EM_ARM, 32, big_endian,
11905                       (big_endian ? "elf32-bigarm" : "elf32-littlearm"))
11906   { }
11907
11908   Target*
11909   do_instantiate_target()
11910   { return new Target_arm<big_endian>(); }
11911 };
11912
11913 // Fix .ARM.exidx section coverage.
11914
11915 template<bool big_endian>
11916 void
11917 Target_arm<big_endian>::fix_exidx_coverage(
11918     Layout* layout,
11919     const Input_objects* input_objects,
11920     Arm_output_section<big_endian>* exidx_section,
11921     Symbol_table* symtab,
11922     const Task* task)
11923 {
11924   // We need to look at all the input sections in output in ascending
11925   // order of of output address.  We do that by building a sorted list
11926   // of output sections by addresses.  Then we looks at the output sections
11927   // in order.  The input sections in an output section are already sorted
11928   // by addresses within the output section.
11929
11930   typedef std::set<Output_section*, output_section_address_less_than>
11931       Sorted_output_section_list;
11932   Sorted_output_section_list sorted_output_sections;
11933
11934   // Find out all the output sections of input sections pointed by
11935   // EXIDX input sections.
11936   for (Input_objects::Relobj_iterator p = input_objects->relobj_begin();
11937        p != input_objects->relobj_end();
11938        ++p)
11939     {
11940       Arm_relobj<big_endian>* arm_relobj =
11941         Arm_relobj<big_endian>::as_arm_relobj(*p);
11942       std::vector<unsigned int> shndx_list;
11943       arm_relobj->get_exidx_shndx_list(&shndx_list);
11944       for (size_t i = 0; i < shndx_list.size(); ++i)
11945         {
11946           const Arm_exidx_input_section* exidx_input_section =
11947             arm_relobj->exidx_input_section_by_shndx(shndx_list[i]);
11948           gold_assert(exidx_input_section != NULL);
11949           if (!exidx_input_section->has_errors())
11950             {
11951               unsigned int text_shndx = exidx_input_section->link();
11952               Output_section* os = arm_relobj->output_section(text_shndx);
11953               if (os != NULL && (os->flags() & elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
11954                 sorted_output_sections.insert(os);
11955             }
11956         }
11957     }
11958
11959   // Go over the output sections in ascending order of output addresses.
11960   typedef typename Arm_output_section<big_endian>::Text_section_list
11961       Text_section_list;
11962   Text_section_list sorted_text_sections;
11963   for (typename Sorted_output_section_list::iterator p =
11964         sorted_output_sections.begin();
11965       p != sorted_output_sections.end();
11966       ++p)
11967     {
11968       Arm_output_section<big_endian>* arm_output_section =
11969         Arm_output_section<big_endian>::as_arm_output_section(*p);
11970       arm_output_section->append_text_sections_to_list(&sorted_text_sections);
11971     } 
11972
11973   exidx_section->fix_exidx_coverage(layout, sorted_text_sections, symtab,
11974                                     merge_exidx_entries(), task);
11975 }
11976
11977 Target_selector_arm<false> target_selector_arm;
11978 Target_selector_arm<true> target_selector_armbe;
11979
11980 } // End anonymous namespace.